Seat Ibiza 5D 2015 Car

Product's Documents

Below are documents related to this product, you can read online or download:
User Manual Other Documents
  • Rescue Sheet Ibiza - (English) Download
  • Rescue Sheet Ibiza battery luggage - (English) Download
  • Rescue Sheet Ibiza bifuel - (English) Download
IBIZA 5D 2015 photo

OWNER’S MANUAL

This is the main product document for model IBIZA 5D 2015.

The file format is pdf, 248 pages, you can download this manual here .

background
OWNER’S
MANUAL
Ibiza
6P0012720BB
Inglés
6P0012720BB (11.15) (GT9)
Ibiza Inglés (11.15)
SEAT recommends
SEAT GENUINE OIL
SEAT recommends
Castrol EDGE Professional
background
SEAT S.A. is permanently concerned about continuous development of its types and models. For this reason we ask you to under-
stand, that at any given time, changes regarding shape, equipment and technique may take place on the car delivered. For this reason
no right at all may derive based on the data, drawings and descriptions in this current handbook.
All texts, illustrations and standards in this handbook are based on the status of information at the time of printing. Except for error
or omission, the information included in the current handbook is valid as of the date of closing print.
Re-printing, copying or translating, whether total or partial is not allowed unless SEAT allows it in written form.
SEAT reserves all rights in accordance with the “Copyright” Act.
All rights on changes are reserved.
This paper has been manufactured using bleached non-chlorine cellulose.
© SEAT S.A. - Reprint: 15.11.15
About this manual
This manual contains a description of the
equipment supplied with the vehicle at the
time this manual was published. Some of the
units described herein will not be available
until a later date or are only available in cer-
tain markets.
Because this is a general manual for the IBIZA
range, some of the equipment and functions
that are described in this manual are not in-
cluded in all types or variants of the model;
they may vary or be modified depending on
the technical requirements and on the mar-
ket; this is in no way deceptive advertising.
The illustrations are intended as a general
guide and may vary from the equipment fitted
in your vehicle in some details.
The steering indications (left, right, forward,
reverse) appearing in this manual refer to the
normal driving movements of the vehicle ex-
cept when otherwise indicated.
The audiovisual material only is intended to
help users to understand certain car function-
alities better. It does not replace the instruc-
tion manual. Please use the instruction manu-
al to obtain more comprehensive information
and indications.
The equipment marked with an aster-
isk* is fitted as standard only in certain
versions, and is only supplied as op-
tional extras for some versions, or are
only offered in certain countries.
® All registered marks are indicated with
®. Although the copyright symbol does
not appear, it is a copyrighted mark.
>> The section is continued on the follow-
ing page.
Important warnings on a given page
Detailed contents on a given page
General information on a given page
Emergency information on a given page
Audiovisual material on a given page
WARNING
Texts preceded by this symbol contain infor-
mation on safety. They warn you about possi-
ble dangers of accident or injury.
CAUTION
Texts with this symbol draw your attention to
potential sources of damage to your vehicle.
For the sake of the environment
Texts preceded by this symbol contain rele-
vant information concerning environmental
protection.
Note
Texts preceded by this symbol contain additio-
nal information.
This manual is divided into six large parts,
which are:
1. The essentials
2. Safety
3. Emergencies
4. Operation
5. Tips
6. Technical data
At the end of this manual, there is a detailed
alphabetical index that will help you quickly
find the information you require.
background
Foreword
This Instruction Manual and its correspond-
in
g s
up
plements should be read carefully to
familiarise yourself with your vehicle.
Besides the regular care and maintenance of
the vehicle, its correct handling will help pre-
serve its value.
For safety reasons, always note the informa-
tion concerning accessories, modifications
and part replacements.
If selling the vehicle, give all of the on-board
documentation to the new owner, as it
should be kept with the vehicle.
You can access the information in this man-
ual using:
Thematic table of contents that follows the
manual’s general chapter structure.
Visual table of contents that uses graphics
to indicate the pages containing “essential”
information, which is detailed in correspond-
ing chapters.
Alphabetical index with many terms and
synonyms to help you find information.
WARNING
Read and always observe safety informa-
tion concernin
g the passenger's front air-
bag page 72, Important information
regarding the front passenger's airbag.
»
background
Related videos
EcoTSI Engine
Ambient light and natural light
page 124
page 128
Tiredness detection page 175
background
Table of Contents
Table of Contents
The e
s
senti
als . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5
Exterior view . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5
Exterior view . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6
Interior view (left guide) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7
Interior view (right-hand drive) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8
How it works . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9
Opening and closing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9
Before driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12
Airbags . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14
Child seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16
Starting the vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20
Lights and visibility . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21
Easy Connect . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24
Driver information system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25
Journey data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29
Cruise control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34
Warning lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35
Gearbox lever . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37
Air conditioning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39
Level control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40
Emergencies . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44
Fuses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44
Bulbs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45
Action in the event of a puncture . . . . . . . . . . . 45
Changing a wheel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47
Snow chains . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50
Emergency towing of the vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . 51
How to jump start . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52
Changing the windscreen wiper blades . . . . . . 54
Safety . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56
Safe driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56
Safety first! . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56
Advice about driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56
Correct position for passengers . . . . . . . . . . . . 57
Pedal area . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61
Seat belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61
Why wear a seat belt? . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61
How to properly adjust your seatbelt . . . . . . . . 64
Belt pretensioners* . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 65
Airbag system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 66
Brief introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 66
Airbag safety instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69
Deactivating airbags . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70
Transporting children safely . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72
Safety for children . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72
Child seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 73
Emergencies . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75
Self-help . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75
Emergency equipment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75
Tyre repair . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 76
Changing the windscreen wiper blades . . . . . . 78
Towing or tow-starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 79
Fuses and bulbs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 81
Fuses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 81
Changing bulbs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 83
Single headlight bulb change . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 84
Double headlight bulb change . . . . . . . . . . . . . 85
Changing the AFS headlight bulbs . . . . . . . . . . 87
Changing the fog light bulbs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88
Changing the tail light bulbs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 89
Changing the side and interior bulbs . . . . . . . . 91
Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95
Controls and displays . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95
General instrument panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 94
Instruments and warning/control lamps . . . . . 96
Instruments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 96
Warning and indication lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100
Introduction to the Easy Connect system* . . . . 107
System settings (CAR)* . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 107
Communications and multimedia . . . . . . . . . . . 108
Steering wheel controls* . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108
Multimedia . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 112
Opening and closing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 112
Central locking system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 112
Keys . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116
Radio frequency remote control* . . . . . . . . . . . 117
Anti-theft alarm* . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 118
Boot hatch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120
Electric windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120
Tilting panoramic roof* . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122
Lights and visibility . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123
Lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123
Interior lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 128
Visibility . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 128
Windscreen wiper and rear window wiper sys-
tems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 129
Rear view mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 131
Seats and head restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 132
Adjusting the seat and head restraints . . . . . . 132
Seat functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 134
Transport and practical equipment . . . . . . . . . 136
Practical equipment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 136
Luggage compartment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 139
Roof rack/roof luggage rack* . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 142
Air conditioning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 144
Heating, ventilation and cooling . . . . . . . . . . . . 144
Heating and fresh air . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 146
Air conditioning* . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 148
Climatronic* . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 150
Driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 152
Address . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 152
Starting and stopping the engine . . . . . . . . . . . 153
Braking and parking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 156
Manual gearbox . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 159
Automatic gearbox* . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 159
Run-in and economical driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . 165
Driving abroad . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 168
3
background
Table of Contents
Driver assistance systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 169
Braking and stability systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 169
Start-Stop System* . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 173
Tiredness detection (break recommenda-
tion)*
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 175
P
ark
ing aid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 176
Rear Assist “Rear View Camera”* . . . . . . . . . . . 181
Cruise speed* (cruise control - GRA) . . . . . . . . . 184
“SEAT Drive Profile” system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 185
Towing bracket device and trailer . . . . . . . . . . . 187
Driving with a trailer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 187
Retrofitting a towing bracket* . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 188
Advice . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 190
Care and maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 190
Accessories and modifications to the vehi-
cle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 190
Care and cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 191
Care of the vehicle exterior . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 192
Caring for the vehicle interior . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 197
Checking and refilling levels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 199
Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 199
Petrol . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 200
Diesel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 200
Working in the engine compartment . . . . . . . . 201
Engine oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 204
Cooling system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 207
Brake fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 208
Windscreen washer reservoir . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 209
Vehicle battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 209
Wheels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 212
Wheels and tyres . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 212
Winter service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 215
Technical data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 217
Technical specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 217
Important information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 217
Information on fuel consumption . . . . . . . . . . . 218
Driving with a trailer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 219
Wheels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 219
Engine data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 221
Dimensions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 233
Index . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 235
4
background
The essentials
Exterior view
1
page 11
2
page 9
3
page 9
4
page 45
5
page 51
6
page 41
7
page 40
8
page 10
5
background
The essentials
Exterior view
1
page 42
2
page 41
3
page 43
4
page 44
5
page 43
6
page 41
7
page 43
8
page 47
9
page 46
10
page 140
6
background
The essentials
Interior view (left guide)
1
page 13
2
page 21
3
page 22
4
page 34
5
page 35
6
page 23
7
page 25
8
page 24
9
page 39
10
page 22
11
page 14
12
page 20
13
page 37
14
page 11
15
page 10
16
page 44
17
page 12
18
page 12
19
page 13
7
background
The essentials
Interior view (right-hand drive)
1
page 22
2
page 34
3
page 22
4
page 39
5
page 24
6
page 23
7
page 25
8
page 35
9
page 21
10
page 13
11
page 10
12
page 14
13
page 13
14
page 37
15
page 12
16
page 12
17
page 20
18
page 44
19
page 11
8
background
The essentials
How it works
Openin
g and c
lo
sing
Doors
Fig. 1 Remote control key: buttons.
Fig. 2 See position on page 7-8
Locking and unlocking the vehicle using the
k
ey
L
oc
king: press the Fig. 1 button.
Unlocking: press the ›› Fig. 1 button.
Unlocking the rear lid: press the
Fig. 1 button until all the turn signals on
the vehicle briefly light up.
Locking and unlocking with the central lock-
ing switch
Locking: press the ›› Fig. 2 button. None
of the doors can be opened from the outside.
The doors can be opened from the inside by
pulling the inside door handle.
Unlocking: press the ›› Fig. 2 button.
in Description on page 112
page 112
Rear lid
Fig. 3 Rear lid: opening from the outside.
The rear lid opening system operates electri-
c
al
ly
. It is activated by using the handle on
the boot lid.
This system may or may not be operative, de-
pending on the situation of the vehicle.
If the rear lid is locked then it cannot be
opened, however if it is unlocked then the
opening system is operative and the rear lid
may be opened.
To lock/unlock, press the button or button
Fig. 1 on the remote control key.
A warning appears on the instrument panel
display if the rear lid is open or not properly
closed.* An audible warning is also given if
the boot lid is opened while the vehicle is
moving faster than 6 km/h (4 mph)*.
»
9
background
The essentials
Openin
g the r
e
ar lid: Pull on the release
lever and lift it up Fig. 3. The rear lid opens
automatically.
Closing the rear lid: Hold it by one of the
handles on the interior lining and close it by
pushing gently.
in Opening and closing on
page 120
page 10
Unlocking the rear lid manually
Fig. 4 IBIZA/IBIZA SC: Unlocking the rear lid
m
anual
ly
.
Fig. 5 IBIZA ST: Unlocking the rear lid man-
ually.
This allows the vehicle to be opened if the
c
entr
al
locking does not work (for example, if
the battery is flat)
There is a groove in the luggage compart-
ment allowing access to the emergency
opening mechanism.
Opening the rear lid from inside the luggage
compartment
Insert the key in the groove and unlock the
locking system, turning the key from right to
left, as shown by the arrow Fig. 4, Fig. 5.
Bonnet
Fig. 6 See position on page 7-8
Fig. 7 Cam under the bonnet
Opening the bonnet: Pull the lever under
the d
a
shbo
ard Fig. 6
1
.
Lifting up the bonnet: press the release
c
at
c
h under the bonnet upwards Fig. 7
2
.
The arr
e
s
ter hook under the bonnet is re-
leased.
10
background
The essentials
R
el
e
ase the bonnet stay and secure it in
the fixture designed for this in the bonnet.
in safety notes for work in the en-
gine compartment on page 202
page 201
Electric windows*
Fig. 8 See position on page 7-8
Opening the window: Press the b
utt
on.
C
losing the window: Pull the button.
Buttons on the driver door
Window on the front left door
Window on the front right door
Safety switch for deactivating the electric
window buttons on the rear doors (only 5-
door vehicles)
1
2
3
Window on the rear left door (only 5-door
v
ehic
l
es)
Window on the right rear door (only 5-
door vehicles)
in Opening and closing of the elec-
tric windows* on page 121
page 120
Panoramic roof*
Fig. 9 On the interior roof lining: Panoramic
s
u
nr
oof controls
Opening: Press the
Fig. 9
A
button once
on
ly
. If
you keep it pressed down, it will open
to the desired position.
Closing: Press the
Fig. 9
B
button once
on
ly
. If
you keep it pressed down, it will close
to the desired position.
4
5
Restoring one-touch opening and closing
Close the sunroof manually until it is com-
p
l
et
ely closed. Release the button.
Press the closing button again, keeping it
pressed down, until a complete opening and
closing cycle has taken place.
in Opening or closing of the tilting
panoramic roof on page 122
page 122
page 11
Operation of the panoramic sunroof
Fig. 10 Emergency operation of the panoram-
ic/ti
ltin
g s
unroof.
In case of a breakdown, the sunroof may be
c
lo
sed m
anually.
»
11
background
The essentials
R
emo
v
e the plastic cover by inserting a
screwdriver into the rear section.
Insert an Allen key (4 mm) into the opening
as far as possible and close the sunroof.
Before driving
Manually adjusting the front seats
Fig. 11 Front seats: manual seat adjustment.
Forward/back: pull the lever and move
the se
at
f
orwards or backwards.
Raising/lowering: pull/push the lever.
Tilting the backrest: turn the hand wheel.
1
2
3
Folding down the backrest (only 3-door
v
ehic
l
es): pull the lever and push the
backrest forward.
in Adjusting the front seats on
page 132
Adjusting the head restraints
Fig. 12 Front seat: adjustment of the head re-
s
tr
aint
.
Grab the sides of the head restraints with
both h
and
s
and push upwards to the desired
position. To lower it, repeat the same action,
pressing the
1
button on the side.
in Adjusting or disassembling the
head restraints on page 134
page 60, page 133
4
Adjustment of the seat belt
Fig. 13 Positioning and removing the seat
belt
b
uc
kle.
12
background
The essentials
Fig. 14 Correct seat belt and head restraint
position
s, viewed from front and the side.
To adjust the seat belt around your should-
er
s, a
dju
st the height of the seats.
The shoulder part of the seat belt should be
well centred over it, never over the neck. The
seat belt lies flat and fits comfortably on the
upper part of the body.
The lap part of the seat belt lies across the
pelvis, never across the stomach. The seat
belt lies flat and fits comfortably on the pel-
vis.
page 63
page 64
Seat belt tensioners
During a collision, the seat belts on the front
seats ar
e retracted automatically.
The tensioner can be triggered only once.
in Service and disposal of belt ten-
sioners on page 66
page 65
Adjusting the exterior mirrors
Fig. 15 See position on page 7-8
Adjusting the exterior mirrors: Turn the knob
t
o the c
orr
esponding position:
Turning the knob to the desired posi-
tion, adjust the mirrors on the driver
side (L, left) and the passenger side (R,
right) to the direction desired.
L/R
Folding in mirrors.
in Electric exterior mirrors* on
page 132
page 131
Adjusting the steering wheel
Fig. 16 Lever in the lower left side of the
s
t
eerin
g column.
Adjusting the position of the steering
wheel: P
u
l
l the Fig. 16
1
lever down,
mo
v
e the s
teering wheel to the desired posi-
tion and lift the lever back up until it locks.
in Adjusting the steering wheel po-
sition on page 58
13
background
The essentials
Airbags
fr
ont
airb
ags
Fig. 17 Driver airbag located in steering
wheel
.
Fig. 18 Front passenger airbag located in
d
a
sh p
anel.
The front airbag for the driver is located in
the s
t
eerin
g wheel Fig. 17 and the airbag
for the front passenger is located in the dash
panel Fig. 18. Airbags are identified by the
word “AIRBAG”.
When the driver and front passenger airbags
are deployed, the covers remain attached to
the steering wheel and dashboard, respec-
tively Fig. 17 Fig. 18.
In conjunction with the seat belts, the front
airbag system gives the driver and the front
passenger additional protection for the head
and chest in the event of a severe frontal col-
lision.
The special design of the airbag allows the
controlled escape of the propellant gas when
an occupant puts pressure on the bag. Thus,
the head and chest are surrounded and pro-
tected by the airbag. After the collision, the
airbag deflates sufficiently to allow visibility.
page 69
Deactivating the front passenger front
airb
ag
Fig. 19 Front passenger front airbag switch.
To deactivate the front passenger front air-
b
ag:
Open the glo
v
e compartment on the front
passenger side.
14
background
The essentials
In
ser
t
the key into the slot provided in the
deactivation switch.
Approximately ¾ of the length of the key
remains inserted (the maximum).
Turn the key, changing its position to .
Do not force it. If you have difficulty, ensure
that you have inserted the key as far as it will
go.
Finally, check the control lamp on the in-
strument panel where it shows  
  the following should appear .
in Deactivation of front passenger
front airbag* on page 71
page 70
Side airbags*
Fig. 20 Side airbag in driver seat.
Fig. 21 Illustration of completely inflated side
airbag on lef
t side of vehicle.
The side airbags are located in the driver seat
and fr
ont
p
assenger seat backrests
Fig. 20. The locations are identified by the
text “AIRBAG” in the upper region of the
backrests.
In conjunction with the seat belts, the side
airbag system provides additional protection
for the upper body in the event of a severe
side collision.
In a side collision, the side airbags reduce
the risk of injury to passengers to the areas
of the body facing the impact. In addition to
their normal function of protecting the occu-
pants in a collision, the front and rear outer
seat belts also hold the passengers in the
event of a side collision; this is how these air-
bags provide maximum protection.
in Side airbags* on page 69
Head-protection airbags*
Fig. 22 Location and deployment area of the
he
a
d-pr
otection airbag.
There is a head airbag on each side of the in-
t
erior abo
v
e the doors Fig. 22. Airbags are
identified by the word “AIRBAG”.
The area framed in red is covered by the
head-protection airbag when it is deployed
Fig. 22 (deployment area). Therefore, ob-
jects should never be placed or mounted in
this area
in Curtain airbags* on
p
ag
e 70
.
In the event of a side collision the curtain air-
bag is triggered on the impact side of the ve-
hicle.
The head-protection airbags reduce the risk
of injury to passengers in the front and rear
side seats facing the impact.
»
15
background
The essentials
in Curtain airbags* on page 70
Child seats
Important information regarding the
front passenger's airbag
Fig. 23 Passenger's side sun visor: airbag
s
tic
k
er.
Fig. 24 On the rear frame of the passenger
side door: airbag s
ticker.
A sticker with important information about
the p
a
s
senger airbag is located on the pas-
senger's sun visor and/or on the passenger
side door frame.
in Important information regarding
the front passenger's airbag on page 72
page 72
16
background
The essentials
Ways to secure a child seat
Fig. 25 On the rear seats: Possible installations
for the chi
ld seat.
Figure
Fig. 25
A
shows the basic child re-
s
tr
aint
system mounting using lower retain-
ing rings and the upper retaining strap. Fig-
ure Fig. 25
B
shows the child restraint
sy
s
t
em mounting using the vehicle seat belt.
You can secure a child seat to the rear seat or
front passenger seat in the following ways:
Child seats in groups 0 to 3 can be secured
with a seat belt.
Child seats for groups 0, 0+ and 1 can be
fastened without seatbelts, using the “ISO-
FIX” system, using the “ISOFIX” page 18
securing rings.
During installation of some models of
group I, II and III child seats in the rear seat,
difficulty may arise in mounting given that
the seat comes into contact with the head re-
straint. In this case, adjust the height of the
head restraint or remove it from the seat fol-
lowing the instructions in the corresponding
chapter
page 133. Once you remove
the child seat, replace the head restraint in
its original position.
Weight
group
Seating position
Front
passen-
ger seat
Rear side
seat
Rear cen-
tral seat
Group 0
to 10 kg
U* U U
Group 0+
to 13 kg
U* U U
Group I
9 to 18 kg
U* U U
Group II
15 to 25 kg
U* U U
Group III
22 to 36 kg
U* U U
»
17
background
The essentials
Suitable for universal restraint systems
f
or u
se in thi
s weight group.
Move the front passenger seat as far
back as possible, as high as possible
and always disable the airbag.
U:
*:
The systems include the child restraint sys-
tem mounting with an upper retaining strap
(Top Tether) and lower anchoring points on
the seat.
in Safety instructions on page 73
“ISOFIX” and Top Tether child seat mounting system*
Child seats can be secured quickly, easily
and safely
on the rear outer seats with the
“ISOFIX” and Top Tether* system.
Two “ISOFIX” retaining rings are fitted on
each rear seat. In some vehicles, the rings
are secured to the seat frame and, in others,
they are secured to the rear floor. The “ISO-
FIX” rings are located between the rear seat
backrest and the seat cushioning. The Top
Tether* rings are located at the rear of the
backrests of the rear seats (behind the seat
backrest or in the boot).
To understand the compatibility of the "ISO-
FIX" systems in the vehicle, consult the table
below.
The body weight permitted and information
regarding sizes A to F is indicated on the la-
bel on child seats with “universal” or “semi-
universal” certification.
Weight group Size class Electrical equipment Mounting direction
Vehicle Isofix positions
Rear side seats
Baby carrier
F ISO/L1 Backward-facing X
G ISO/L2 Backward-facing X
Group 0 to 10 kg E ISO/R1 Backward-facing IU
Group 0+ to 13 kg
E ISO/R1 Backward-facing IU
D ISO/R2 Backward-facing IU
C ISO/R3 Backward-facing IU
18
background
The essentials
Weight group Size class Electrical equipment Mounting direction
Vehicle Isofix positions
Rear side seats
Group I 9 to 18 kg
D ISO/R2 Backward-facing IU
C ISO/R3 Backward-facing IU
B ISO/F2 Forward-facing IU
B1 ISO/F2X Forward-facing IU
A ISO/F3 Forward-facing IU
Group II 15 to 25 kg --- --- Forward-facing ---
Group III 22 to 36 kg --- --- Forward-facing ---
Suitable for ISOFIX universal child re-
s
tr
aint
systems approved for use in this
weight group.
ISOFIX position not suitable for ISOFIX
child restraint systems for this weight
group or size class.
in Safety instructions on page 73
IU:
X:
Mount the child seat with the “ISOFIX
sy
s
t
ems”
Fig. 26 ISOFIX securing rings.
When removing or fitting the child seat,
p
l
e
ase be sure to follow the manufacturer's
instructions.
Press the child seat onto the “ISOFIX” re-
taining rings until the child seat can be heard
to engage securely. If the child seat is fitted
with any other anti-rotation system, follow
the manufacturer instructions carefully.
Pull on both sides of the child seat to en-
sure that it is secure.
Child seats with the “ISOFIX” and Top Tether*
attachment system are available from Techni-
cal Services.
19
background
The essentials
Top Tether* retainer straps
Fig. 27 Position of the Top Tether rings on the
b
ac
k
of the rear seat.
Child seats with the Top Tether system come
w
ith a s
tr
ap for securing the seat to the vehi-
cle anchor point, located at the back of the
rear seat backrest and provide greater re-
straint.
The objective of this strap is to reduce the
forward movement of the child seat in a
crash, to reduce the risk of injuries to the
head from hitting the inside of the vehicle.
Using the Top Tether in rear-facing mounted
seats
Currently, there are very few rear-facing child
safety seats that have Top Tether. Please
carefully read and follow the seat manufac-
turer instructions to learn the proper way to
install the Top Tether strap.
Securing the Top Tether* of the child
seat to the anchorage point
Fig. 28 Retainer strap: correct adjustment
and fittin
g.
Securing to the anchorage point located on
the r
e
ar of
the backrest
Follow the manufacturer's instructions to
deploy the child seat Top Tether retainer
strap.
Guide the strap under the rear seat head re-
straint Fig. 28 (lift the head restraint where
necessary).
Slide the strap and secure it properly with
the anchorage of the backrest.
Firmly tighten the Top Tether belt following
the manufacturer's instructions.
Releasing the retaining strap
Loosen the strap following the manufactur-
er's instructions.
Push the lock and release it from the an-
choring support.
in Safety instructions on page 73
Starting the vehicle
Ignition lock
Fig. 29 See position on page 7-8
Switch ignition on: Place the key in the igni-
tion and s
t
ar
t the engine.
Locking and unlocking the steering wheel
Engaging the steering wheel lock: Remove
the key from the ignition and turn the wheel
until it locks. In vehicles with an automatic
gearbox, the gear lever must be in the P posi-
tion in order to remove the key. If necessary,
20
background
The essentials
press the locking key on the selector lever
and r
el
e
ase it again.
Unlocking the steering wheel: Put the key
into the ignition and turn it at the same time
as the steering wheel in the direction indica-
ted by the arrow. If it is not possible to turn
the steering wheel, it may be because it is
locked.
Turning on/switching off the ignition, glow
plugs reheating
Switch ignition on: Turn the key to the
2
position.
Switch ignition off. Turn the key to the
1
position.
Diesel vehicles :
The glo
w p
lugs reheat
when the ignition is switched on
Starting the engine
Manual gearbox: press the clutch pedal all
the way down and move the gearbox lever in-
to neutral.
Automatic gearbox: Press the brake pedal
and move the selector lever to the P position
or into N.
Turn the key to the
3
position. The key au-
t
om
atic
ally returns to the
2
position. Do not
pr
e
s
s the accelerator.
Start-Stop System*
When you stop and release the clutch pedal,
the Start-Stop system* turns off the engine.
The ignition remains switched on.
in Ignition key positions on
page 154
page 153
Lights and visibility
He
a
dlight
switch
Fig. 30 See position on page 7-8
Turn the switch to the required position
Fig. 30.
Sym-
bol
Ignition switch-
ed off
Ignition is switch-
ed on
Fog lights, dipped
beam and side
lights off.
Light off or daytime
driving light on.

The “Coming home”
and “Leaving
home” guide lights
may be switched
on.
Automatic control of
dipped beam and day-
time driving light.
Side light on.
Dipped beam head-
light off
Dipped beam switch-
ed on.
Front fog lights: mo
ve the switch to the
first position, from positions ,  or .
Rear fog light: move the switch completely
from positions ,  or .
Switching off fog lights: Push the switch or
turn it to the position.
in Switching lights on and off on
page 123
page 123
21
background
The essentials
Turn signal and main beam lever
Fig. 31 See position on page 7-8
More the lever to the required position:
Right
t
urn s
ignal: Right-hand parking
light (ignition switched off).
Left turn signal: Left-hand parking light
(ignition switched off).
Main beam switched on: Control lamp
lit up on the instrument panel.
Headlight flasher: lit up when the lever is
pushed. Control lamp lit up.
Lever all the way down to switch it off.
in Turn signal and main beam lever
on page 125
page 125
1
2
3
4
Hazard warning lights
Fig. 32 See position on page 7-8
Switched on, for example:
When approaching a traffic jam
In an emergency
The vehicle has broken down
When towing or being towed
in Hazard warning lights
on
page 128
page 127
Interior lights
Fig. 33 Detail of headliner: front interior light-
in
g.
Knob Function
Switches interior lights off.
Switches interior lights on.
Switches door contact control on (central po-
sition).
The interior lights come on automatically
when the vehicle is unlocked, a door is
opened or the key is removed from the igni-
tion.
The lights go off a few seconds after all the
doors are closed, the vehicle is locked or the
ignition is switched on.
Turning the reading light on and off
page 128
22
background
The essentials
Windscreen wipers and window wiper
b
l
a
de
Fig. 34 Operating the windscreen wiper and
r
e
ar w
iper
More the lever to the required position:
0

Windscreen wiper off.
More the lever to the required position:
1
Windscreen wipers interval wipe.
Using the control Fig. 34
A
adjust the
interval (vehicles without rain sensor), or
the sensitivity of the rain sensor.
2

Slow wipe.
3

Continuous wipe.
4
Short wipe. Brief press, short clean. Hold
the lever down for more time to increase
the wipe frequency.
5
Automatic wipe. The windscreen washer
function is activated by pushing the lever
forwards, and simultaneously the wind-
screen wipers start.
More the lever to the required position:
6
Interval wipe for rear window. The wiper
will wipe the window approximately every
six seconds.
7
The rear window wash function is activa-
ted by pressing the lever, and the rear wip-
er starts simultaneously.
in Windscreen wipers on page 129
page 129
page 54
23
background
The essentials
Easy Connect
CAR menu settin
g
s
(Setup)
Fig. 35 See position on page 7-8
Fig. 36 See position on page 7-8
To select the settings menus, press the Easy
C
onnect

button and the
Set
up
function
b
utt
on.
The act
ual number of menus available and
the name of the various options will depend
on the vehicle’s electronics and equipment.
Switch the ignition on.
If the Infotainment System is off, switch it
on.
Press the system's
MENU
button and then
the sy
s
t
em's

Fig. 35
b
utton or

but-
t
on t
o g
o to the CAR menu Fig. 36.
Press the function button
Setup
to open the
menu Vehicle settings
Fig. 36.
To select a function in the menu, press the
desired button.
When you press the menu button, the last se-
lected menu will always be displayed.
When the function button check box is activa-
ted , the function is active.
Any changes made using the settings menus
are automatically saved on closing the
BACK
menus.
Menu Submenu Possible setting Description
ESC system Activation of the Electronic Stability Programme (ESC) page 170
Tyres
Tyre pressure monitoring Tyre pressure storing (Calibration) page 104
Winter tyres Activation and deactivation of the speed warning. Setting the speed warning value page 215
24
background
The essentials
Menu Submenu Possible setting Description
Driver assistance Tiredness detection Activation/deactivation page 175
Parking and ma-
noeuvring
ParkPilot
Automatically activate, front volume, front sound settings, rear volume, rear sound settings,
adjust volume
page 176
Vehicle lights
Vehicle interior lighting Instrument and switch lighting, footrest lighting page 128
Coming home/Leaving home
function
Start time for “Coming home” function, start time for “Leaving home” function page 126
Windscreen wipers Windscreen wipers Automatic windscreen wipers, wipe when reversing page 23
Opening and clos-
ing
Radio-operated remote control Convenience open function page 122
Central locking system Unlocking doors, automatic locking/unlocking, audible confirmation page 112
Multifunction
display
Current consumption, average consumption, volume to fill up, convenience equipment,
ECOAdvice, journey duration, distance travelled, digital speed display, average speed,
speeding warning, oil temperature, coolant temperature, restore data “from start”, restore
data “total calculation”
page 25
Date and time
Time source, set the time, automatic summer time setting, select time zone, time format, set
the date, date format
Measurement units Distance, speed, temperature, volume, consumption
Service Chassis number, date of next SEAT service inspection, date of next oil change service page 33
Factory settings
All settings can be reset: driver assistance, parking and manoeuvring, lights, rear view mir-
rors, opening and closing, multi-function display
in CAR menu (Setup) on page 107
page 107
Driver information system
Intr
oduction
With the ignition switched on, it is possible
to re
ad the different functions of the display
by scrolling through the menus.
In vehicles with multifunction steering wheel,
the multifu
nction display can only be operat-
ed with the steering wheel buttons.
The number of menus displayed on the in-
strument panel will vary according to the ve-
hicle electronics and equipment.
»
25
background
The essentials
A specialised workshop will be able to pro-
gr
amme or modif
y
additional functions, ac-
cording to the vehicle equipment. SEAT rec-
ommends visiting a SEAT Official Service.
Some menu options can only be read when
the vehicle is at a standstill.
As long as a priority 1 warning is displayed, it
will not be possible to read the menus. Some
warning messages can be confirmed and
made to disappear with the windscreen wiper
lever button or the multifunction steering
wheel button.
The information system also provides the fol-
lowing information and displays (depending
on the vehicle's equipment):
Driving data ›› page 29
Vehicle status
MFD from departure
MFD from refuelling
MFD total calculation
Assist systems ›› table on page 27
Reverse (optional)
Navigation Booklet Navigation system
Audio Booklet Radio or ›› Booklet Naviga-
tion system
Telephone Booklet Radio or Book-
let Navigation system
Vehicle table on page 27
WARNING
Any distraction may lead to an accident, with
the risk of
injury.
Do not operate the instrument panel con-
trols when driving.
Operating the instrument panel me-
nus
Fig. 37 Windscreen wiper lever: control but-
t
on
s.
Fig. 38 Right side of multifunction steering
wheel: contro
l buttons.
The driver information system is controlled
w
ith the mu
ltif
unction steering wheel buttons
Fig. 38 or with the windscreen wiper lever
Fig. 37 (if the vehicle is not equipped with
multifunction steering wheel).
Enabling the main menu
Switch the ignition on.
If a message or vehicle pictogram appears,
press button ›› Fig. 37
1
on the windscreen
w
iper l
ev
er or button

on the multifunction
s
t
eerin
g wheel Fig. 38.
If managed from the windscreen wiper lev-
er: to display the main screen page 27 or
to return to the main menu from another
menu hold down the rocker button ›› Fig. 37
2
.
If managed from the multifunction steering
wheel:
the main menu list is not displayed.
To go from point to point in the main menu,
26
background
The essentials
press button
or
several times
Fig. 38.
Select a submenu
Press the rocker switch Fig. 37
2
on the
w
ind
s
creen wiper lever up or down or turn
the thumbwheel of the multifunction steering
wheel Fig. 38 until the desired option ap-
pears marked on the menu.
The selected option is displayed between
two horizontal lines. In addition, a triangle is
displayed on the right:
To consult the submenu option, press but-
ton Fig. 37
1
on the windscreen wiper
l
ev
er or b
utton

on the multifunction steer-
in
g wheel
Fig. 38.
Making changes according to the menu
Make the desired changes with the rocker
switch on the windscreen wiper lever or the
thumbwheel of the multifunction steering
wheel. To increase or decrease the values
more quickly, turn the thumbwheel faster.
Mark or confirm the selection with button
Fig. 37
1
on the windscreen wiper lever
or b
utt
on

on the multifunction steering
wheel
Fig. 38.
Menu
Menu Function
Driving
data
Information and possible configurations
of the multifunction display (MFD)
page 29, page 107.
Assist
systems
Information and possible configurations
of the driver assistance systems
page 107.
Naviga-
tion
Information instructions from the activa-
ted navigation system: when a route guid-
ance is activated, the turning arrows and
proximity bars are displayed. The appear-
ance is similar to the Easy Connect sys-
tem.
If route guidance is not activated, the di-
rection of travel (compass) and the name
of the street along which you are driving
are shown Booklet Navigation system.
Audio
Station display on the radio.
Track name on the CD.
Track name in Media mode ›› Booklet Ra-
dio or Booklet Navigation system.
Tele-
phone
Information and possible configurations
of the mobile phone preinstallation
Booklet Radio or ›› Booklet Navigation
system.
Lap tim-
er*
In a racing circuit, measurement and
memorisation of lap times by the vehicle
and comparison with previously measured
best times page 31.
Menu Function
Vehicle
status
Display of the current warning or informa-
tion texts and other system components,
depending on the equipment
page 107.
Outside temperature display
When the outside temperature is below +4°C
(+39°F), the “ice cr
ystal” symbol (warning of
risk of freezing) is also displayed. At first, this
symbol flashes and then it remains lit until
the outside temperature rises above +6°C
(+43°F)
in Indications on the display on
p
ag
e 98
.
When the vehicle is at a standstill or when
travelling at very low speeds, the tempera-
ture displayed may be higher than the true
outside temperature as a result of the heat
produced by the engine.
The temperatures measured range from
-40°C to +50°C (-40°F to +122°F).
27
background
The essentials
Gear-change indicator
Fig. 39 Instrument panel: gear-change indica-
t
or (m
anual
gearbox).
A gear change will be recommended if the
g
e
ar
you are in is not the most economical
choice. If no gear-change is recommended, it
means that you are already in the most eco-
nomical gear.
Vehicles with a manual gearbox
The following display symbols Fig. 39
mean:
Change to a higher gear: the suggested
g
ear appears to the right of the current gear
when a higher gear is recommended.
Change to a lower gear: the suggested
gear appears to the left of the current gear
when a lower gear is recommended.
The gear recommendation may occasionally
skip a gear (2nd 4th).
Vehicles with an automatic gearbox*
The disp
lay is only visible in tiptronic mode
page 162.
The following display symbols mean:
Shifting up a gear
Shifting down a gear
CAUTION
The gear-change indicator is intended to help
save f
uel, but it is not intended to recom-
mend the right gear for all driving situations.
In certain situations, only the driver can
choose the correct gear (for instance when
overtaking, driving up a steep gradient or
towing a trailer).
Note
The display disappears from the instrument
panel when
you press the clutch pedal.
Bonnet, rear lid and doors open
Fig. 40 A: bonnet open; B: rear lid open; C:
fr
ont
l
eft door open; D: rear right door open
(5-door vehicles only).
When the ignition is switched on or when
driv
in
g, the bonnet, r
ear lid or doors that are
open will be indicated on the instrument pan-
el display, and, as applicable, this will be in-
dicated audibly. The display may vary accord-
ing to the type of instrument panel fitted.
28
background
The essentials
Illustra-
tion
Key to Fig. 40
A
Do not continue driving!
The bonnet is open or is not properly
closed page 201.
B
Do not continue driving!
The rear lid is open or is not properly
closed page 9.
C, D
Do not continue driving!
A vehicle door is open or is not properly
closed page 112.
Warning and information messages
The system runs a check on certain compo-
nents
and f
u
nctions when the ignition is
switched on and while the vehicle is moving.
Faults in the operation are displayed on the
screen using red and yellow symbols and
messages on the instrument panel display
(
page 100, page 35) and, in
some cases, with audible warnings. The dis-
play may vary according to the type of instru-
ment panel fitted.
Priority 1 warning (red symbols)
Symbol flashing or lit; partly combined with audible
warnings.
Stop the vehicle! It is dangerous in Warning
symbols on page 101!
Check the function that is faulty and repair it. If necessa-
ry, request assistance from specialised personnel.
Priority 2 warning (yellow symbols)
Symbol flashing or lit; partly combined with audible
warnings.
A faulty function, or fluids which are below the correct
levels may cause damage to the vehicle!
in Warn-
ing symbols on page 101
Check the faulty function as soon as possible. If neces-
sary, request assistance from specialised personnel.
Informative text
Information relating to different vehicle processes.
Assist systems submenu
Assist
systems
menu
Function
Tiredness
detection*
Switching the tiredness detection on
or off (pause recommendation)
page 175.
Journey data
M
emor
y
The MFD (multifunction display) shows differ-
ent
v
alues for the journey and the consump-
tion.
Changing between display modes on the
MFD
In vehicles without multifunction steering
wheel: Press the rocker switch

on the
w
ind
s
creen wiper lever ›› Fig. 37.
Vehicles with a multifunction steering
wheel: turn the thumbwheel Fig. 38.
Multifunction display memory
The multifunction display is equipped with
three memories that work automatically: MFD
from departure, MFD from refuelling and MFD
total calculation. On the screen display, you
can read which memory is currently dis-
played.
Toggle between memories with the ignition
on and the memory displayed
Press the

button on the windscreen
w
iper l
ev
er or the

button of the multifunc-
tion s
t
eerin
g wheel.
»
29
background
The essentials
Menu Function
MFD from
departure
Display and storage of the values for
the journey and the consumption from
when the ignition is switched on to
when it is switched off.
If the journey is continued in less than
2 hours after the ignition is switched
off, the new data is added to the data
already stored in the memory. The
memory will automatically be deleted if
the journey is interrupted for more than
2 hours.
MFD from
refuelling
Display and storage of the values for
the journey and the consumption. By
refuelling, the memory will be erased
automatically.
MFD total
calcula-
tion
The memory records the values for a
specific number of partial trips, up to a
total of 19 hours and 59 minutes or 99
hours and 59 minutes, or 1999.9 km or
9999 km, depending on the model of
instrument panel. On reaching either of
these limits
a)
, the memory is automati-
cally erased and starts to count from 0
again.
a)
It varies according to the instrument panel version.
Erasing a memory manually
Select the memory that you wish to erase.
Hold the

button of the multifunction
s
t
eerin
g wheel or the

button of the multi-
f
u
nction wheel
pressed down for about 2 sec-
onds.
Personalising the displays
In the Easy Connect system you can adjust
which of the possible displays of the MFD can
be shown on the instrument panel display
with the button

and the function button
Set
up
p
age 107.
Dat
a summary
Menu Function
Current fuel
consumption
The current fuel consumption dis-
play operates throughout the jour-
ney, in litres/100 km; and with the
engine running and the vehicle
stopped, in litres/hour.
Average fuel
consumption
After turning on the ignition, aver-
age fuel consumption in li-
tres/100 km will be displayed after
travelling about 100 metres. Other-
wise horizontal lines are displayed.
The value shown is updated approxi-
mately every 5 seconds.
ACT
®
*: Depending on the equip-
ment, number of active cylinders.
Operating
range
Approximate distance in km that can
still be travelled with the fuel re-
maining in the tank, assuming the
same style of driving is maintained.
This is calculated using the current
fuel consumption.
Menu Function
Journey du-
ration
This indicates the hours (h) and mi-
nutes (min) since the ignition was
switched on.
Distance
covered
Distance covered in km (m) after
switching on the ignition.
Average
speed
The average speed will be shown af-
ter a distance of about 100 metres
has been travelled. Otherwise hori-
zontal lines are displayed. The value
shown is updated approximately ev-
ery 5 seconds.
Digital dis-
play of
speed
Current speed displayed in digital
format.
Speed warn-
ing at ---
km/h or Speed
warning at
--- mph
If the stored speed is exceeded (be-
tween 30 - 250 km/h, or 19 -
155 mph), an audible warning is
given together with a visual warn-
ing.
Oil tempera-
ture
Updated engine oil temperature dig-
ital display
Coolant tem-
perature
gauge
Digital display of the current temper-
ature of the liquid coolant.
Storing a speed with the speed warning
Select the display Speed warning at
---
km/h (---
mph)
30
background
The essentials
Pr
e
s
s the button

on the windscreen
w
iper l
ev
er or the button

on the multifunc-
tion s
t
eerin
g wheel to store the current speed
and activate the warning.
To switch system on: adjust to the desired
speed within 5 seconds using the rocker
switch

on the windscreen wiper lever or
b
y
t
urning the thumbwheel on the multifunc-
tion steering wheel. Next, press the button

or

again or wait several seconds.
The s
peed i
s
stored and the warning activa-
ted.
To switch system off: press the but-
ton

or

. The stored speed is de-
l
et
ed.
En
gine oil temperature display
The engine reaches its operating temperature
when in norm
al
driv
ing conditions, the oil
temperature is between 80°C (180°F) and
120°C (250°F). If the engine is required to
work hard and the outside temperature is
high, the engine oil temperature can in-
crease. This does not present any problem as
long as the warning lamps
table on
page 36 or
table on page 36 do not
appear on the display.
Vehicles without multifunction steering
wheel
Press the rocker switch ›› Fig. 37
2
until
the m
ain menu ap
pe
ars. Enter into Journey
data. With the button
2
move to the oil
t
emper
at
ure gauge.
Vehicles with multifunction steering wheel
Enter the submenu Journey data and
turn the thumbwheel until the oil tempera-
ture display appears.
additional electrical appliances
Operation with the windscreen wiper lever*:
Pr
e
s
s the rocker switch Fig. 37
2
until the
m
ain menu ap
pe
ars. Enter into the section
Journey data. With the rocker switch,
move to the display Convenience appli-
ances.
Operation with the multi-function steering
wheel*: Move with the buttons
1
or
2
to
Journey data and ent
er w
ith
OK. Turn the
thumbwheel to the right until the Conven-
ience appliances display appears.
In addition, a scale will inform you of the cur-
rent sum of all the additional appliances.
Saving tips
Tips on how to save fuel will be displayed in
conditions
that increase fuel consumption.
Follow them to reduce consumption. The indi-
cations appear automatically only with the ef-
ficiency programme. After a time, the tips will
disappear automatically.
If you wish to hide a saving tip immediately
after it appears, press any button on the
windscreen wiper lever*/multifunction steer-
ing wheel*.
Note
If y
ou hide a saving tip, it will reappear af-
ter you switch the ignition on again.
The saving tips do not appear in all situa-
tions, but rather with a large separation of
time.
Timer*
You can access the timer via the selection
menu
page 27.
It allows you to manually time lap times on a
racing circuit, memorise them and compare
them to the vehicle's previous best times.
The following menus can be displayed:
Stop
Lap
»
31
background
The essentials
Pause
Partial time
Statistics
Ch
an
g
e from one menu to another
Vehicles without multifunction steering
wheel: press the rocker switch

in the
w
ind
s
creen wiper lever.
Vehicles with multifunction steering wheel:
press
or
.
Menu “Stop”
Start
The timer starts.
If there are existing laps and they are in-
cluded in the statistics, it will begin with
the number of laps in question.
It is only possible to begin with a new first
lap if the statistics have been reset first in
the Statistics menu.
Since
start
The timer begins when the vehicle sets
off.
If the vehicle is already moving, the timer
begins once the vehicle has stopped.
Statis-
tics
The Statistics menu is displayed on
the screen.
Menu “Lap”
New lap
The timer of the current lap stops and a
new lap starts immediately. The time for
the lap you have just completed is inclu-
ded in the statistics.
Menu “Lap”
Partial
time
For about 5 seconds a partial time is dis-
played. The timer continues in parallel.
Stop
The current lap timer will be interrupted.
The lap does not end. The Pause menu is
displayed.
Menu “Pause”
Continue The interrupted timer continues.
New lap
A new timer starts. The halted lap ends
and is included in the statistics.
Interr.
lap
The timer of the current lap ends and is
cancelled. It is not included in the statis-
tics.
End
The current timer ends. The lap is inclu-
ded in the statistics.
Menu “Partial time”
Partial
time
For about 5 seconds a partial time is dis-
played. The timer continues in parallel.
New lap
The timer of the current lap stops and a
new lap starts immediately. The time for
the lap you have just completed is inclu-
ded in the statistics.
Stop
The current lap timer will be interrupted.
The lap does not end. The Pause menu is
displayed.
Menu “Statistics”
View of the latest lap times:
– total time
– best lap time
– worst lap time
– average lap duration
A maximum of 10 laps is possible, and a
total duration of 99 hours, 59 minutes
and 59 seconds.
If one of the 2 limits is reached, you will
have to reset the statistics in order to be-
gin a new timer.
Back This returns to the previous menu.
Reset-
ting to
zero
All the memorised statistical data are re-
set.
WARNING
Do your best to avoid handling the timer
while driv
ing.
Only set the timer or consult statistics
when the vehicle is stationary.
While driving, do not handle the timer in
complicated driving situations.
Speed warning device
The speed warning device warns the driver
when they
h
av
e exceeded the pre-set speed
limit by 3 km/h. An audible warning is given
and the lamp
can be seen simultaneously
32
background
The essentials
on the instrument panel, as well as a mes-
s
ag
e f
or the driver: speed warning ex-
ceeded! The warning lamp switches off
when reducing speed below the stored maxi-
mum limit.
Speed warning programming is recommen-
ded if you wish to be reminded of a maxi-
mum speed, such as when travelling in a
country with different speed limits or for a
maximum speed for winter tyres.
Setting speed limit warning
You can use the radio or the Easy Connect* to
set, alter or cancel the speed limit warning.
Vehicles with radio: press the button
SETUP
> control button Driver Assistant >
Speed warning.
Vehicles with Easy Connect: pr
e
s
s the but-
ton Systems or else Vehicle systems >
Driver assistant > Speed warning.
The warning limit can be set from 30 to
240 km/h (20 to 150 mph). The adjustment
is done in 10 km/h (mph) intervals.
Note
Plea
se bear in mind that, even with the
speed warning function, it is still important
to keep an eye on the vehicle speed with the
speedometer and to observe the legal speed
limits.
The speed limit w
arning function in the ver-
sion for several countries warns you at a
speed of 120 km/h (80 mph). This is a facto-
ry-set speed limit.
Service intervals
The service interval indication appears on the
instrument
panel display ››
Fig. 121
4
.
SEAT di
stinguishes between services with en-
gine oil change (e.g. Oil change service) and
services without engine oil change (e.g. In-
spection).
In vehicles with Services established by time
or mileage, the service intervals are already
pre-defined.
In vehicles with LongLife Service, the inter-
vals are determined individually. Thanks to
technological progress, maintenance work
has been greatly reduced. Because of the
technology used by SEAT, with this service
you only need to change the oil when the ve-
hicle so requires. To calculate this change
(max. 2 years), the vehicle's conditions of
use and individual driving styles are consid-
ered. The pre-warning first appears 20 days
before the date established for the corre-
sponding service. The kilometres (miles) re-
maining until the next service are always
rounded up to the nearest 100 km (miles)
and the time is given in complete days. The
current service message cannot be viewed
until 500 km after the last service. Prior to
this, only
lines are visible on the display.
Inspection reminder
When the Service date is approaching, when
the ignition is switched on a Service remind-
er is displayed.
Vehicles without text messages: a span-
ner will be displayed on the instrument
panel plus an indication in km.
The kilometres indicated are the maximum
number of kilometres that can be travelled
until the next service. After a few seconds,
the display mode changes. A clock symbol
appears and the number of days until the
next service is due.
Vehicles with text messages: Service in
--- km or --- days will be shown on the
instrument panel display.
Service due
When the service date is due, an audible
warning is given when the ignition is switch-
ed on and the spanner displayed on the
screen flashes for a few seconds.
Vehicles with text messages: Service now
will be shown on the instrument panel dis-
play.
»
33
background
The essentials
Reading a service notification
W
ith the ignition sw
it
ched on, the engine off
and the vehicle at a standstill, the current
service notification can be read:
Press and hold the button
4
for more than 5
sec
ond
s
to consult the service message.
When the service date has passed, a minus
sign is displayed in front of the number of kil-
ometres or days.
Vehicles with text messages: the following
message is displayed: Service --- km
(miles) or --- days ago.
The time can also be set via the

key and
Set
up
function button in the Easy Connect
sy
s
t
em
page 107.
Resetting service interval display
If the service was not carried out by a SEAT
dealership, the display can be reset as fol-
lows:
Switch off the ignition, press and hold but-
ton
Fig. 121
4
.
Switch ignition back on.
Release THE
4
Fig. 121
button and
press it again for the next 20 seconds.
Note
The servic
e message disappears after a few
seconds, when the engine is started or when
OK/RESET
is pressed on the windscreen wiper
lever
, or
OK
on the multifunction steering
wheel.
In v
ehicles with the LongLife system in
which the battery has been disconnected for
a long period of time, it is not possible to cal-
culate the date of the next service. Therefore
the service interval display may not be cor-
rect. In this case, bear in mind the maximum
service intervals permitted in the Book-
let Maintenance Programme.
Cruise control
Oper
atin
g the c
ruise control system
(CCS)*
Fig. 41 See position on page 7-8
Switching on the CCS: Move switch
Fig. 41
1
to .
The system is on. If no
s
peed h
as been programmed, the system will
not control it.
Activating the CCS: Press button Fig. 41
2
in the  ar
e
a.
The current speed is
memorised and controlled.
Temporarily switching off the CCS: Move
switch Fig. 41
1
to 
 or push the
br
ak
e. The cruise control system is switched
off temporarily.
Reactivating the CCS: Press button
Fig. 41
2
in 
. The memorised speed
i
s
saved and controlled again.
Increasing stored speed during CCS regula-
tion: press button
2
in 
. The vehicle ac-
c
elerates until the new stored speed.
Reducing stored speed during CCS regula-
tion: press button
2
in  t
o lower the
s
peed b
y 1 km/h (1 mph). Speed is reduced
until reaching the new stored speed.
Switching off the CCS: Move switch
Fig. 41
1
to .
The system is disconnec-
t
ed and the memori
sed speed is deleted.
in Operation on page 184
page 184
34
background
The essentials
Warning lamps
On the in
s
trument
panel
Fig. 42 See position on page 7-8
Red warning lamps
Central warning lamp: additional
information on the instrument pan-
el display
Parking brake on.
page
156
page
104
Do not continue driving!
The brake fluid level is too low or
there is a fault in the brake system.
Lit up or flashing:
Do not continue driving!
Fault in the steering.
page
105
Driver or passenger has not fas-
tened seat belt.
page
62
Use the foot brake!
Yellow warning lamps
Central warning lamp: additional
information on the instrument pan-
el display
»
35
background
The essentials
Front brake pads worn.
page
169
it lights up: Fault in the ESC, or dis-
connection caused by the system.
flashes: ESC or ASR activated.
ASR manually deactivated.
Or else: ESC in Sport mode.
ABS faulty or does not work.
Rear fog light switched on.
page
21
lights up or flashes: fault in the
emission control system.
page
106
it lights up: pre-ignition of diesel
engine.
page
101
flashes: fault in the diesel engine
management.

fault in the petrol engine manage-
ment.
page
101
lights up or flashes: fault in the
steering system.
page
105
Tyre pressure too low, or fault in
the tyre pressure monitoring sys-
tem.
page
104
Fuel tank almost empty.
page
105
Fault in airbag system and seat
belt tensioners.
page
66
Other warning lamps
Left or right turn signal.
page
22
Hazard warning lights on.
page
127
Trailer turn signals
page
187
it lights up: Press the foot brake!
flashes: the selector lever locking
button has not engaged.
page
159
it lights up: cruise control activated
or speed limiter switched on and
active.
page
34
flashes: the speed set by the
speed limiter has been exceeded.
Main beam on or flasher on.
page
22
On the instrument panel display
Fig. 43 See position on page 7-8
Do not continue driving!
With the corresponding indica-
tion: door(s), rear lid or bonnet
open or not properly closed.
page
112
page 9
page
201
Ignition:
Do not carry on driv-
ing! Engine coolant level too low,
coolant temperature too high
page
207
Flashing: Fault in the engine
coolant system.
Do not continue driving!
Engine oil pressure too low.
page
204
36
background
The essentials
Fault in the battery.
page
209
Driving light totally or partially
faulty.
page
83
Fault in the cornering light sys-
tem.
page
123
Diesel particulate filter blocked
page
101
Level of windscreen washer fluid
too low.
page
209
Flashing: Fault in the oil level de-
tection. Control manually.
page
204
Ignition: Insufficient engine oil.
Fault in the gearbox.
page
164

Immobiliser active.
page
107
Service interval display
page
33
Mobile telephone is connected
via Bluetooth to the original tele-
phone device.
Book-
let Radio
or
Book-
let Navi-
gation
system
Mobile telephone battery charge
meter. Available only for devices
pre-installed in factory.
Freezing warning. The outside
temperature is lower than +4°C
(+39°F).
page
27
Start-Stop system activated.
page
173
Start-Stop system unavailable.

Low consumption driving status
page
27
On the instrument panel
Fig. 44 See position on page 7-8

Front passenger front airbag is
disabled (




).
page
66
in Warning symbols on page 101
page 100
Gearbox lever
M
anua
l
gearbox
Fig. 45 Gear shift pattern of a 5 or 6-speed
m
anual
g
earbox
The position of the gears is indicated on the
g
e
arbo
x lever Fig. 45.
Press the clutch pedal and keep your foot
right down.
Move the gearbox lever to the required po-
sition.
Release the clutch.
Selecting reverse gear
Press the clutch pedal and keep your foot
right down.
With the gearbox lever in neutral, push it
upwards, move it to the left as far as it will go
and then forwards to select reverse Fig. 45
R
.
»
37
background
The essentials
R
el
e
ase the clutch.
in Driving with manual gearbox on
page 159
page 159
Automatic gearbox*
Fig. 46 Automatic gearbox: selector lever po-
s
ition
s.
Parking lock
R
ev
er
se gear
P
R
Neutral (idling)
Drive (forward)
Sport programme: drive (forward)
Tiptronic mode: pull the lever forwards
(+) to go up a gear or backwards () to
go down a gear.
page 159
page 38
Manual release of selector lever
Fig. 47 Manual release of the selector lever.
N
D
S
+/–
If there is a fault in the power system to the
el
ectr
onic
selector lever lock system (flat bat-
tery, blown fuse) or the system itself is faulty,
the selector lever cannot be moved from po-
sition P in the normal manner, which pre-
vents the vehicle from being moved. The se-
lector lever must be unlocked using the man-
ual release.
Apply the handbrake.
Pull gently on both sides at the front of the
selector lever cover.
Also loosen the cover at the rear.
Press the yellow plastic part with your fin-
ger in the direction indicated by the arrow
Fig. 47.
Press the interlock button on the selector
lever knob at the same time and move the se-
lector lever to position N (if the selector lever
is moved back to position P, it will lock
again).
38
background
The essentials
Air conditioning
Ho
w doe
s
Climatronic* work?
Fig. 48 See position on page 7-8
Buttons/controls
Int
erior t
emper
ature setting
Display
Selected interior temperature
Degrees Centigrade or Fahrenheit
Automatic air conditioning mode
Defrost or demist windscreen
Air flow direction
Air recirculation
Air conditioning on/off
Selected blower speed
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
Buttons/controls
Set
b
lo
wer speed
Interior temperature sensors
Defrost or demist windscreen
Automatic mode
Air distribution to windows
Air distribution to upper body
Air distribution to footwells
Air recirculation
Air conditioning on/off
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
in General notes on page 144
page 150
39
background
The essentials
How does the manual air conditioning
w
ork*?
Fig. 49 See position on page 7-8
Temperature
Blo
w
er
Air di
stribution
– Air distribution towards the wind-
screen in order to demist or defrost.
– Air distribution to upper body.
– Air distribution to footwell
– Air distribution to the windscreen
and the footwell.
Air recirculation
A/C: Switching the cooling system on
A
B
C
D
E
in General notes on page 144
page 148
How does the heating and the fresh
air sy
s
t
em work?
Fig. 50 See position on page 7-8
Temperature
Blo
w
er
Air di
stribution
– Air distribution towards the wind-
screen in order to demist or defrost.
– Air distribution to upper body.
– Air distribution to footwell
– Air distribution to the windscreen
and the footwell.
A
B
C
Air recirculation
in General notes on page 144
page 146
Level control
Fi
l
lin
g capacities
Capacities
Fuel tank 45 litres. 7 litre re-
serve.
Windscreen washer fluid con-
tainer in vehicles without head-
light washer
3 litres
Windscreen washer fluid con-
tainer in vehicles with headlight
washer
4.5 litres
D
40
background
The essentials
Fuel
Fig. 51 Fuel tank flap with tank cap attached.
The flap that covers the tank cap is unlocked
and loc
k
ed aut
omatically using the central
locking.
Opening the fuel tank cap
Open the flap.
Unscrew the cap by turning it to the left.
Rest it on the upper part of the fuel tank
flap Fig. 51.
Closing the fuel tank cap
Unscrew the cap by turning it to the right as
far as it will go.
Close the lid.
in Refuelling on page 199
page 199
Oil
Fig. 52 Engine oil dipstick.
Fig. 53 In the engine compartment: Engine
oi
l
fi
ller cap
The level is measured using the dipstick loca-
t
ed in the en
gine c
ompartment
page 204.
The oil should leave a mark between zones
A
and
C
. It should never exceed zone
A
.
Zone
A
: Do not add oil.
Zone
B
: You can add oil but keep the level
in th
at
zone.
Zone
C
: Add oil up to zone
B
.
T
op
pin
g up engine oil
Unscrew cap from oil filler opening.
Add oil slowly.
At the same time, check the level to ensure
you do not add too much.
When the oil level reaches at least zone
B
,
u
n
s
crew the engine oil filler cap carefully.
Oil properties
Engine type Specification
Petrol without flexible serv-
ice interval
VW 502 00/VW 504 00
Petrol with flexible service
interval (LongLife)
VW 504 00
Diesel. Engines without Par-
ticulate filter (DPF)
VW 505 01/VW 506
01/VW 507 00
»
41
background
The essentials
Engine type Specification
Diesel. Particulate Filter En-
gines (DPF).
With or without flexible
service interval (with and
without LongLife)
a)
VW 507 00
a)
Only use recommended oils, otherwise you may damage the
engine.
Engine oil additives
No type of additive should be mixed with the
engine oil. The deterioration caused by these
additives is not covered by the warranty.
in Changing engine oil on page 207
page 204
Coolant
Fig. 54 Engine compartment: coolant expan-
s
ion t
ank
cap.
The coolant tank is located in the engine
c
omp
ar
tment
page 204.
When the engine is cold, replace the coolant
when the level is below .
Coolant specifications
The engine cooling system is supplied from
the factory with a specially treated mixture of
water and at least 40 % of the additive G13
(TL-VW 774 J), purple. This mixture gives the
necessary frost protection down to -25°C
(-13°F) and protects the light alloy parts of
the engine cooling system against corrosion.
It also prevents scaling and considerably rai-
ses the boiling point of the coolant.
To protect the cooling system, the percentage
of additive must always be at least 40 %,
even in warm climates where anti-freeze pro-
tection is not required.
If for weather reasons further protection is
necessary, the proportion of additive may be
increased, but only up to 60 %; otherwise an-
tifreeze protection will diminish and this will
worsen cooling.
When the coolant is topped up, use a mixture
of distilled water and at least 40 % of the
G13 or G12 plus-plus (TL-VW 774 G) additive
(both are purple) to obtain an optimum anti-
corrosion protection
in Topping up cool-
ant on p
ag
e 208
. The mixture of G13 with
G12 plus (TL-VW 774 F), G12 (red) or G11
(green-blue) engine coolants will significant-
ly reduce anti-corrosion protection and
should therefore be avoided ››
in Topping
up c
oo
l
ant on page 208.
in Topping up coolant on page 207
page 207
42
background
The essentials
Brake fluid
Fig. 55 Engine compartment: brake fluid res-
er
v
oir c
ap
The brake fluid reservoir is located in the en-
gine c
omp
ar
tment
page 204.
The level should be between the  and 
marks. If it is below , please visit a Techni-
cal Service.
in Changing the brake fluid on
page 209
page 208
Windscreen washer
Fig. 56 In the engine compartment: wind-
s
c
r
een washer reservoir top.
The windscreen washer reservoir is located in
the en
gine c
omp
artment ››
page 204.
To top up, mix water with a product recom-
mended by SEAT.
In cold temperatures, add anti-freeze for win-
dows.
in Topping up the windscreen wash-
er reservoir water on page 209
page 209
Battery
The battery is located in the engine compart-
ment
page 204. It does not require
maintenance. It is checked as part of the In-
spection Service.
in Symbols and warnings on han-
dling the battery on page 210
page 209
43
background
The essentials
Emergencies
F
u
se
s
Fuse location
Fig. 57 On the driver-side dash panel: fuse
bo
x
c
over
Fig. 58 In the engine compartment: fuse box
c
o
v
er
Opening and closing the fuse box situated
belo
w the d
a
sh panel
Opening: remove the fuse box cover
Fig. 57.
Closing: click the cover back into place.
To open the engine compartment fuse box
Raise the bonnet.
Press the locking tabs to release the fuse
box cover Fig. 58
Then lift the cover out.
To fit the cover, place it on the fuse box.
Push the locking tabs down until they click
audibly into place.
Identifying fuses situated below the dash
panel by colours
Colour Amp rating
Black 1
Purple 3
Light brown 5
Brown 7.5
Red 10
Blue 15
Yellow 20
White or transparent 25
Colour Amp rating
Green 30
Orange 40
in Introduction on page 81
page 81
Replacing a blown fuse
Fig. 59 Image of a blown fuse
Preparation
Switch off the ignition, lights and all elec-
tric
al
equipment
.
Open the corresponding fuse box
page 81.
44
background
The essentials
Identifying a blown fuse
A f
u
se i
s blown if its metal strip is ruptured
Fig. 59.
Point a lamp at the fuse to see if it has
blown.
To replace a fuse
Remove the fuse.
Replace the blown fuse by one with an
identical amperage rating (same colour and
markings) and identical size.
Replace the cover again or close the fuse
box lid.
Bulbs
Bulbs (12 V)
Light source used for each function
Double headlights Type
Dipped beam headlights H7 Long Life
Main beam headlights H7
Side lights W5W Long Life
Turn signal PY 21W
Double headlights Type
DRL (day light) LED
a)
a)
In case of a LED failure, go to an authorised workshop to have
it replaced.
Single headlight Type
Dipped/main beam headlights H4 Long Life
Side lights W5W Long Life
Turn signal PY 21W
DRL (day light) P21W SLL
Xenon/adaptive head-
lights*
Type
Dipped/main beam headlights D1S
a)
Side lights LED
b)
Turn signal PY 21W
DRL (day light) LED
b)
a)
This light should be changed by an Authorised Service.
b)
In case of a LED failure, go to an authorised workshop to have
it replaced.
page 83
Action in the event of a punc-
t
ur
e
Wh
at to do first
Park the vehicle on a horizontal surface
and in a safe p
lace as far away from traffic as
possible.
Apply the handbrake.
Switch on the hazard warning lights.
Manual gearbox: select the 1st gear.
Automatic gearbox: Move the sel
ector lever
to position P.
If you are towing a trailer, unhitch it from
your vehicle.
Have the vehicle tool kit*
page 47 and
the spare wheel
page 76 ready.
Observe the applicable legislation for each
country (reflective vest, warning triangles,
etc.).
All occupants should leave the vehicle and
wait in a safe place (for instance behind the
roadside crash barrier).
WARNING
Alwa
ys observe the above steps and pro-
tect yourself and other road users.
If you change the wheel on a slope, block
the wheel on the opposite side of the car with
a stone or similar to prevent the vehicle from
moving.
45
background
The essentials
Repairing a tyre with the anti-punc-
t
ur
e k
it
Fig. 60 Standard representation: Contents of
the ty
r
e mo
bility system.
The anti-puncture kit is located under the
floor p
anel
in the lug
gage compartment.
Sealing the tyre
Unscrew the tyre valve cap and insert. Use
the Fig. 60
1
tool to remove the insert.
Pl
ac
e it
on a clean surface.
Shake the tyre sealant bottle vigorously
Fig. 60
10
.
Screw the inflator tube
Fig. 60
3
into
the se
al
ant
bottle. The bottle's seal will break
automatically.
Remove the lid from the filling tube
Fig. 60
3
and screw the open end of the
t
ube int
o the ty
re valve.
With the tyre sealant bottle upside down,
fill the tyre with the contents of the sealant
bottle.
Remove the bottle from the valve.
Place the insert back into the tyre valve us-
ing the tool Fig. 60
1
.
Infl
atin
g the ty
re
Screw the compressor tyre inflator tube
Fig. 60
5
into the tyre valve.
Check that the air bleed screw is closed
Fig. 60
7
.
Start the engine and leave it running.
Insert the connector
Fig. 60
9
into the
v
ehic
l
e's 12-volt socket ››
page 138.
Turn the air compressor on with the ON/OFF
switch Fig. 60
8
.
Keep the air compressor running until it
r
e
ac
hes 2.0 to 2.5 bar
(29-36 psi/200-250 kPa). a maximum of 8
minutes.
Disconnect the air compressor.
If it does not reach the pressure indicated,
unscrew the tyre inflator tube from the valve.
Move the vehicle 10m so that the sealant is
distrib
uted throughout the tyre.
Screw the c
ompressor tyre inflator into the
valve.
Repeat the inflation process.
If the indicated pressure still cannot be
reached, the tyre is too badly damaged. Stop
and request assistance from an authorised
technician.
Disconnect the air compressor. Unscrew
the tyre inflator tube from the tyre valve.
When the tyre pressure is between 2.5 and
2.0 bars, continue driving without exceeding
80 km/h (50 mph).
Check the pressure again after 10 minutes
page 78.
in TMS (Tyre Mobility System)* on
page 77
page 76
46
background
The essentials
Changing a wheel
V
ehic
l
e tool kit
Fig. 61 See position on page 8
An adapter for the anti-theft wheel bolts*
T
o
wline anc
horage
Box spanner for wheel bolts*
Jack*
Wire hook for pulling off the wheel cov-
ers*/wheel bolt cap clip.
in Vehicle tools on page 75
page 75
1
2
3
4
5
Wheel covers*
Fig. 62 Remove the wheel cover.
The wheel covers must be removed for access
t
o the wheel
bo
lts.
Removing
Remove the wheel cover using the wire
hook Fig. 62.
Hook this into one of the cut-outs of the
wheel cover.
Fitting
Fit the wheel cover onto the wheel rim by
pressing it firmly.
Put pressure on the point of the cut-out for
the valve.
Next fit the rest of the wheel cover
Wheel bolt caps*
Fig. 63 Wheel: wheel bolts with caps.
Removal
Fit the plastic clip (vehicle tools) over the
c
ap u
nti
l it clicks into place Fig. 63.
Remove the cap with the plastic clip.
47
background
The essentials
Anti-theft wheel bolts*
Fig. 64 Anti-theft wheel bolt with cap and
a
d
apt
er.
A special adapter (vehicle tools) is required
t
o r
emo
ve the anti-theft wheel bolts.
Remove the wheel cover* or the cap*.
Insert the special adapter (vehicle tools)
onto the anti-theft wheel bolt and push it on
as far as it will go.
Insert the wheel brace (vehicle tools) onto
the adapter as far as it will go.
Remove the wheel bolt ›› page 48.
Note
Make a note of the code number of the anti-
theft wheel
bolt and keep it in a safe place,
but not in your vehicle. If you need a new
adapter, you can obtain it from the SEAT Offi-
cial Service, indicating the code number.
Loosening the wheel bolts
Fig. 65 Wheel: loosen the wheel bolts.
Insert the box spanner (vehicle tools) onto
the wheel
bo
lt
as far as it will go. An adapter
is required to unscrew or tighten the anti-
theft wheel bolts page 48.
Turn the wheel bolt approximately one turn
to the left Fig. 65 (arrow). To apply the re-
quired torque, hold the wheel brace at the
end. If it is not possible to loosen a wheel
bolt, carefully apply pressure with one foot
on the end of the box spanner. Hold on to the
vehicle for support and take care not to slip.
WARNING
Slightly loosen the wheel bolts (one turn) be-
fore r
aising the vehicle with the jack*. If not,
an accident may occur.
Raising the vehicle
Fig. 66 Jack position points
Fig. 67 Fitting the jack.
Place the jack* (vehicle tools) on firm
gr
ou
nd. If
necessary use a large, strong
board or similar support. If the surface is slip-
pery (for example tiles) place the jack on a
rubber mat or similar to prevent it from slip-
ping
.
48
background
The essentials
Find the s
up
por
t point on the strut (sunken
area) closest to the wheel to be changed
Fig. 66.
Place the jack under the jacking point and
turn the crank until the arm of the jack is di-
rectly below the vertical rib under the door
sill.
Align the jack so that the arm of the jack
fits around the rib under the door sill and the
movable base plate of the jack is flat on the
ground Fig. 67.
Continue turning the jack* until the wheel
is slightly lifted off the ground.
WARNING
Make s
ure that the jack* remains stable. If
the surface is slippery or soft, the jack* could
slip or sink, respectively, with the resultant
risk of injury.
Only raise the vehicle with the jack* sup-
plied by the manufacturer. Other vehicles
could slip, with the consequent risk of injury.
Only mount the jack* on the support points
designed for this purpose on the strut, and
always align the jack correctly. If you do not,
the jack* could slip as it does not have an ad-
equate grip on the vehicle: risk of injury!
The height of the parked vehicle can
change as a result of variations in tempera-
ture and loading.
CAUTION
The vehicle must not be raised on the cross-
bar. On
ly place the jack* on the points de-
signed for this purpose on the strut. Other-
wise, the vehicle may be damaged.
Removing and fitting the wheel
Change the wheel after loosening the wheel
bolts and r
aising the vehicle with the jack.
Taking off the wheel
Unscrew the wheel bolts using the box
spanner and p
lace them on a clean surface.
Take off the wheel
.
P
uttin
g on the s
pare wheel
When fitting tyres with a compulsory rotation
direction, observe the instructions in
page 49.
Mount the wheel.
Screw on the wheel bolts in position and
tighten them loosely with a box spanner.
Carefully lower the vehicle using the jack*.
Tighten the wheel bolts in diagonal pairs
using the wheel brace.
The wheel bolts should be clean and turn
easily. Before fitting the spare wheel, inspect
the wheel condition and hub mounting surfa-
ces. These surfaces must be clean before fit-
ting the wheel.
CAUTION
When removing/fitting the wheel, the rim
may
hit and damage the brake disc. For this
reason, please take care and get a second
person to assist you.
Tyres with compulsory rotation direc-
tion
A directional tread pattern can be identified
b
y
the arr
ows on the sidewall that point in
the direction of rotation. Always observe the
direction of rotation indicated when fitting
the wheel to guarantee optimum properties
of this type of tyres with regard to grip,
noises, wear and aquaplaning.
If it is absolutely necessary to fit the spare
tyre* against the direction of rotation, drive
with care as this means the tyre does not of-
fer optimum driving properties. This is of par-
ticular importance when the road surface is
wet.
To return to directional tread tires, replace
the punctured tyre as soon as possible and
restore the obligatory direction of rotation of
all tyres.
49
background
The essentials
Subsequent work
Alloy wheels: repl
ace the wheel bolt caps.
Plate wheels: replace the wheel hubcap.
Return all tools to their proper storing loca-
tion.
If the replaced wheel does not fit in the
spare wheel housing, store it safely in the
luggage compartment ››
page 139.
Check the tyre pressure of the newly moun-
ted tyre as soon as possible.
In vehicles fitted with a tyre pressure indi-
cator
, adjust the pressure and store it in
memory
page 104.
Have the tightening torque of the wheel
bolts checked as soon as possible with a tor-
que wrench (it should be 120 Nm). Mean-
while, drive carefully.
Have the flat tyre replaced as quickly as
possible.
Snow chains
Use
Snow chains should only be used on the
fr
on
t
wheels.
Check that they are correctly seated after
driving for a few yards; correct the position if
necessary, in accordance with the manufac-
turer's fitting instructions.
Keep your speed below 50 km/h.
If there is a danger of being trapped de-
spite having mounted the chains, it is best to
disable the driving wheels (ASR) in the ESC
page 170.
Snow chains will improve braking ability as
well as traction in winter conditions.
For technical reasons snow chains may only
be used with the following wheel rim/tyre
combination.
175/70R14
185/60R15
Chains with links not exceeding 15 mm
(including the chain closure)
215/45R16 Chains with links not exceeding 9 mm
(including the chain closure)
215/40R17 Chains with links not exceeding 7 mm
(including the chain closure)
Remove wheel covers and any integral trim
rin
g bef
or
e fitting snow chains.
Remove the chains when roads are free of
snow. Driving characteristics worsen, and the
wheels become damaged quickly and may
even be rendered unusable.
WARNING
Snow chains should be correctly tightened in
accor
dance with the manufacturer's instruc-
tions. This will prevent the chains coming in-
to cont
act with the wheel housing.
50
background
The essentials
Emergency towing of the vehi-
c
l
e
T
owing
Fig. 68 Right side of the front bumper: Tow-
in
g rin
g.
Fig. 69 Right side of the rear bumper: Towing
rin
g.
Towline anchorages
Att
ac
h the b
ar or rope to the towline ancho-
rages.
The towline anchorages are located under
the floor panel in the luggage compartment,
next to the vehicle tools page 47.
Screw the front towline anchorage into the
screw connection ›› Fig. 68 and tighten it
with the wheel brace. The rear towline an-
chorage is under the rear bumper, on the
right.
Tow rope or tow bar
It is easier and safer for the vehicle to be tow-
ed using a tow bar. You should only use a
tow-rope if you do not have a tow-bar.
A tow rope should be slightly elastic to re-
duce the loading on both vehicles. It is advis-
able to use a tow rope made of synthetic fi-
bre or similarly elastic material.
Attach the tow rope or the tow bar only to the
towline anchorages provided or a towing
bracket.
Notes for the driver of the towing vehicle
The tow rope must be taut before you drive
off.
Release the clutch very carefully when start-
ing the vehicle (manual gearbox), or acceler-
ate gently (automatic gearbox).
Driving style
Towing requires some experience, especially
when using a tow rope. Both drivers should
realise how difficult it is to tow a vehicle. In-
experienced drivers should not attempt to
tow.
Do not pull too hard with the towing vehicle
and take care to avoid jerking the tow rope.
When towing on an unpaved road, there is al-
ways a risk of overloading and damaging the
anchorage points.
The ignition of the vehicle being towed must
be switched on to prevent the steering wheel
from locking and also to allow the use of the
turn signals, horn, windscreen wipers and
washers.
Place the gear lever in neutral on vehicles
with a manual gearbox. With an automatic
gearbox, place the lever in N.
The brake servo only works when the engine
is running. When not running, you must ap-
ply considerably more pressure to the brake
pedal.
As the power assisted steering does not work
if the engine is not running, you will need
more strength to steer than you normally
would.
»
51
background
The essentials
in Notes on page 79
page 79
Tow-starting
If the engine will not start, first try starting it
usin
g the battery of another vehicle
page 52. You should only attempt to tow-
start a vehicle if charging the battery does
not work. This is done by leveraging wheel
movement.
When tow-starting a vehicle with a petrol en-
gine, do not tow it more than a short dis-
tance, otherwise unburned fuel can enter the
catalytic converter.
However, if your vehicle has to be tow-star-
ted:
Engage 2
nd
or 3
rd
ge
ar.
Keep the clutch pressed down.
Switch the ignition on.
Once both vehicles are moving, release the
clutch.
As soon as the engine starts, press the
clutch and move the gear lever into neutral.
This helps to prevent driving into the towing
vehicle.
in Notes on page 79
page 79
How to jump start
Jump l
e
a
ds
The jump lead must have a sufficient wire
cro
ss section.
If the engine fails to start because of a dis-
charged battery, the battery can be connec-
ted to the battery of another vehicle to start
the engine.
Jump leads
Jump leads must comply with standard DIN
72553 (see cable manufacturer's instruc-
tions). The wire cross section must be at least
25 mm
2
for petrol engines and at least
35 mm
2
for diesel engines.
Note
The vehic
les must not touch each other,
otherwise electricity could flow as soon as
the positive terminals are connected.
The discharged battery must be properly
connected to the on-board network.
How to jump start: description
Fig. 70 Diagram of connections for vehicles
w
ithout
Start-Stop system.
Fig. 71 Diagram of connections for vehicles
w
ith
St
art-Stop system.
Jump lead terminal connections
1. Switch off the ignition of both vehicles
.
52
background
The essentials
2. Connect one end of the r
e
d
jump lead to
the positive
+
terminal of the vehicle
w
ith the fl
at
battery
A
Fig. 70
.
3.
Connect the other end of the red jump
lead to the positive terminal
+
in the ve-
hic
l
e pr
oviding assistance
B
.
4. For vehicles without Start-Stop system:
c
onnect
one end of
the black jump lead to
the negative terminal
of the vehicle
pr
o
v
iding the current
B
Fig. 70
.
F
or vehicles with Start-Stop system: con-
nect one end of the black jump lead
X
to a
s
uit
ab
le ground terminal, to a solid piece of
metal in the engine block, or to the engine
block itself Fig. 71.
5. Connect the other end of the black jump
lead
X
to a solid metal component bolted
t
o the en
gine b
lock or to the engine block
itself of the vehicle with the flat battery.
Do not connect it to a point near the bat-
tery
A
.
6. Position the leads in such a way that they
c
annot
c
ome into contact with any moving
parts in the engine compartment.
Starting
7. Start the engine of the vehicle with the
boosting battery and let it run at idling
speed.
8. Start the engine of the vehicle with the flat
battery and wait for 2 or 3 minutes until
the engine is running.
Removing the jump leads
9. Before you remove the jump leads, switch
off the dipped beam headlights if they are
switched on.
10.Turn on the heater blower and heated rear
window in the vehicle with the flat battery.
This helps minimise voltage peaks which
are generated when the leads are discon-
nected.
11.When the engine is running, disconnect
the leads in reverse order to the details
given above.
Make sure the battery clamps have sufficient
metal-to-metal contact with the battery termi-
nals.
If the engine fails to start, switch off the start-
er after about 10 seconds and try again after
about a minute.
WARNING
Plea
se note the safety warnings referring to
working in the engine compartment
page 201, Working in the engine
compartment.
The battery providing assistance must have
the same voltage as the flat battery (12 V)
and approximately the same capacity (see
imprint on battery). Failure to comply could
res
ult in an explosion.
Never use jump leads when one of the bat-
teries is frozen. Danger of explosion! Even af-
ter the battery has thawed, battery acid could
leak and cause chemical burns. If a battery
freezes, it should be replaced.
Keep sparks, flames and lighted cigarettes
away from batteries, danger of explosion.
Failure to comply could result in an explo-
sion.
Observe the instructions provided by the
manufacturer of the jump leads.
Do not connect the negative cable from the
other vehicle directly to the negative terminal
of the flat battery. The gas emitted from the
battery could be ignited by sparks. Danger of
explosion.
Do not attach the negative cable from the
other vehicle to parts of the fuel system or to
the brake line.
The non-insulated parts of the battery
clamps must not be allowed to touch. The
jump lead attached to the positive battery
terminal must not touch metal parts of the ve-
hicle, this can cause a short circuit.
Position the leads in such a way that they
cannot come into contact with any moving
parts in the engine compartment.
Do not lean on the batteries. This could re-
sult in chemical burns.
»
53
background
The essentials
Note
The vehicles must not touch each other, oth-
erwi
se electricity could flow as soon as the
positive terminals are connected.
Changing the windscreen wiper
bla
des
Changing the wiper blades
Fig. 72 Wipers in service position
Fig. 73 Changing the windscreen wiper
bla
de.
To change the blades it is necessary to move
the w
iper
s
from the rest position into the
service position.
Do not change the windscreen wipers when
out of the service position, as it could cause
paint to flake off the bonnet due to friction
with the windscreen wiper arm.
Service position (for changing wiper blades)
Ensure that the wiper blades are not frozen.
Turn the ignition on and off and then (with-
in approximately 9 seconds) push the wind-
screen wiper lever down (short wipe). The
windscreen wipers will move to the service
position Fig. 72.
Removing the wiper blade
Lift the windscreen wiper arm.
Press the securing tab down
1
Fig. 73
.
Extract the wiper blade from the wiper arm.
Fitting the wiper blade
Insert the wiper blade onto the windscreen
wiper arm until it clicks into place.
Place the windscreen wiper arms to their in-
itial position.
in Changing the windscreen and
rear window wiper blades on page 79
page 78
Changing the rear window wiper blade
Fig. 74 Removing and fitting the rear window
w
iper b
l
ade.
Removing the wiper blade
Lift the wiper arm away from the glass
54
background
The essentials
Slide the b
l
a
de adapter in the direction of
the arrow and remove the blade Fig. 74 A.
Fitting the wiper blade
With one hand, hold the top end of the wip-
er arm.
Place the blade as shown in ›› Fig. 74 B
and slide the adapter along until it engages.
in Changing the windscreen and
rear window wiper blades on page 79
page 78
55
background
Safety
Safety
Saf
e driv
in
g
Safety first!
This chapter contains important information,
tips, sug
gestions and warnings that you
should read and consider for both your own
safety and for your passengers' safety.
WARNING
This m
anual contains important informa-
tion about the operation of the vehicle, both
for the driver and the passengers. The other
sections of the on-board documentation also
contain further information that you should
be aware of for your own safety and for the
safety of your passengers.
Ensure that the on-board documentation is
kept in the vehicle at all times. This is espe-
cially important when lending or selling the
vehicle to another person.
Advice about driving
B
ef
or
e setting off
For your own safety and the safety of your
p
a
s
sengers, always note the following points
before every trip:
Make sure that the vehicle's lights and turn
signals are working properly.
Check tyre pressure.
Ensure that all windows provide a clear and
good view of the surroundings.
Ensure that all luggage is correctly secured
page 139.
Make sure that no objects can interfere
with the pedals.
Adjust front seat, head restraint and rear vi-
sion mirrors properly according to your
size.
Ensure that the passenger in the central
rear seat always has the head restraint in
the correct position for use.
Instruct passengers to adjust the head re-
straints according to their height.
Protect children with appropriate child
seats and properly applied seat belts
page 72.
Assume the correct sitting position. Instruct
your passengers also to assume a proper
sitting position. ›› page 57.
Fasten your seat belt securely. Instruct your
passengers also to fasten their seat belts
properly.
page 61.
What affects driving safety?
As a driver, you are responsible for yourself
and your p
assengers. When your concentra-
tion or driving safety is affected by any cir-
cumstance, you endanger yourself as well as
others on the road
, for this reason:
Always pay attention to traffic and do not
get di
stracted by passengers or telephone
calls.
Never drive when your driving ability is im-
paired (e.g. by medication, alcohol, drugs).
Observe traffic laws and speed limits.
Always reduce your speed as appropriate
for ro
ad, traffic and weather conditions.
When travelling long distances, take
breaks regularly - at least every two hours.
If possible, avoid driving when you are tired
or stressed.
WARNING
When driving safety is impaired during a trip,
the risk of
injury and accidents increases.
Safety equipment
Never put your safety or the safety of your
p
a
s
sengers in danger. In the event of an acci-
dent, the safety equipment may reduce the
56
background
Safe driving
risk of injury. The following list includes most
of
the s
af
ety equipment in your SEAT:
Three-point seat belts
Belt tension limiter for the front and rear
side seats
Belt tensioners for the front seats
Front airbags
Side airbags in the front seat backrests,
with chest and head protection
“ISOFIX” anchor points for “ISOFIX” rear
child seat system
Height-adjustable front head restraints
Rear-centre head restraints with in-use po-
sition and non-use position
Adjustable steering column
The safety equipment mentioned above
works together to provide you and your pas-
sengers with the best possible protection in
the event of an accident. However, these
safety systems can only be effective if you
and your passengers are sitting in a correct
position and use this equipment properly.
Safety is everyone's business!
Correct position for passengers
Correct sitting position for driver
Fig. 75 The proper distance between driver
and s
t
eerin
g wheel
Fig. 76 Correct head restraint position for the
driv
er
.
For your own safety and to reduce the risk of
injur
y
in the ev
ent of an accident, we recom-
mend the following adjustments for the driv-
er:
Adjust the steering wheel so that there is a
distance of at least 25 cm between the
steering wheel and the centre of your chest
Fig. 75.
Move the driver seat forwards or backwards
so that you are able to press the accelera-
tor, brake and clutch pedals to the floor
with your knees still slightly angled
.
Ensure that you can reach the highest point
of
the s
t
eering wheel.
Adjust the head restraint so that its upper
edge is at the same level as the top of your
head, or as close as possible to the same
level as the top of your head ›› Fig. 76.
Move the seat backrest to an upright posi-
tion so that your back rests completely
against it.
Fasten your seat belt securely page 61.
Keep both feet in the footwell so that you
have the vehicle under control at all times.
Adjustment of the driver seat ›› page 132.
WARNING
An incorrect
sitting position of the driver
can lead to severe injuries.
Adjust the driver seat so that there is at
least 25 cm distance between the centre of
»
57
Technical dataAdviceOperationEmergenciesSafety
background
Safety
the chest and the centre of the steering
wheel ››
Fig. 75. If distance is less than 25
cm, the airbag system may not protect you
properly.
If your physical constitution prevents you
from maintaining the minimum distance of 25
cm, contact a specialised workshop. The
workshop will help you decide if special spe-
cific modifications are necessary.
When driving, always hold the steering
wheel with both hands on the outside of the
ring at the 9 o'clock and 3 o'clock positions.
This reduces the risk of injury when the driver
airbag is triggered.
Never hold the steering wheel at the 12
o'clock position, or in any other manner (e.g.
in the centre of the steering wheel). In such
cases, if the airbag is triggered, you may sus-
tain injuries to the arms, hands and head.
To reduce the risk of injury to the driver
during sudden braking manoeuvres or an ac-
cident, never drive with the backrest tilted far
back! The airbag system and seat belts can
only provide optimal protection when the
backrest is in an upright position and the
driver is wearing his or her seat belt correct-
ly.
Adjust the head restraint properly to ach-
ieve optimal protection.
Adjusting the steering wheel position
Read the additional information carefully
page 13
WARNING
Never adju
st the position of the steering
wheel when the vehicle is moving, as this
could cause an accident.
Move the lever up firmly so the steering
wheel position does not accidentally change
during driving. risk of accident!
Make sure you are capable of reaching and
firmly holding the upper part of the steering
wheel: risk of accident!
If you adjust the steering wheel so that it
points towards your face, the driver airbag
will not protect you properly in the event of
an accident. Make sure that the steering
wheel points towards your chest.
Correct sitting position for front pas-
sen
g
er
For your own safety and to reduce the risk of
injur
y
in the ev
ent of an accident, we recom-
mend the following adjustments for the front
passenger:
Move the front passenger seat back as far
as possible
.
Mo
v
e the se
at backrest to an upright posi-
tion so that your back rests completely
against it.
Adjust the head restraint so that its upper
edge is at the same level as the top of your
head, or as close as possible to the same
level as the top of your head ›› page 60.
Always keep both feet in the footwell in
front of the front passenger seat.
Fasten your seat belt securely page 61.
It is possible to deactivate the front passen-
ger airbag in exceptional circumstances
page 70.
Adjusting the front passenger seat
page 12.
WARNING
An incorrect
sitting position of the front
passenger can lead to severe injuries.
Adjust the front passenger seat so that
there is at least 25 cm between your chest
and the dash panel. If distance is less than
25 cm, the airbag system may not protect you
properly.
If your physical constitution prevents you
from maintaining the minimum distance of 25
cm, contact a specialised workshop. The
workshop will help you decide if special spe-
cific modifications are necessary.
Always keep your feet in the footwell when
the vehicle is moving; never rest them on the
58
background
Safe driving
dash panel, out the window or on the seat. An
incorrect
sitting position exposes you to an
increased risk of injury in case of a sudden
braking or an accident. If the airbag is trig-
gered, you could sustain severe injuries due
to an incorrect sitting position.
To reduce the risk of injury to the front pas-
senger in events such as sudden braking ma-
noeuvres or an accident, never travel with the
backrest tilted far back! The airbag system
and seat belts can only provide optimal pro-
tection when the backrest is in an upright po-
sition and the front passenger is wearing his
or her seat belt properly. The further the seat
backrests are tilted to the rear, the greater
the risk of injury due to incorrect positioning
of the belt web or to the incorrect sitting po-
sition!
Adjust the head restraint correctly in order
to achieve maximum protection.
Correct sitting position for rear seat
p
a
s
sengers
To reduce the risk of injury in the event of a
s
ud
den br
aking manoeuvre or an accident,
passengers on the rear seat bench must con-
sider the following:
Sit up straight.
Adjust the head restraint to the correct po-
sition page 60.
Always keep both feet in the footwell in
front of the rear seat.
Fasten your seat belt securely page 61.
Use an appropriate child restraint system
when you take children in the vehicle
page 72.
WARNING
If the pa
ssengers in the rear seats are not
sitting properly, they could sustain severe in-
juries.
Adjust the head restraint correctly in order
to achieve maximum protection.
Seat belts can only provide optimal protec-
tion when seat backrests are in an upright
position and the vehicle occupants are wear-
ing their seat belts correctly. If passengers In
the rear seats are not sitting in an upright po-
sition, the risk of injury due to incorrect posi-
tioning of the seat belt increases.
Examples of incorrect sitting posi-
tion
s
Seat belts can provide optimal protection on-
ly
when the belt
w
ebs are properly posi-
tioned. Incorrect sitting positions substan-
tially reduce the protective function of seat
belts and increase the risk of injury due to in-
correct seat belt position. As the driver, you
are responsible for all passengers, especially
children.
Never allow anyone to assume an incorrect
sitting position in the vehicle while travel-
ling
.
The f
o
l
lowing list contains examples of sit-
ting positions that could be dangerous for all
vehicle occupants. The list is not complete,
but we would like to make you aware of this
issue.
Therefore, whenever the vehicle is in motion:
Never stand in the vehicle.
Never stand on the seats.
Never kneel on the seats.
Never tilt your seat backrest far to the rear.
Never lean against the dash panel.
Never lie on the rear bench.
Never sit on the front edge of a seat.
Never sit sideways.
Never lean out of a window.
Never put your feet out of a window.
Never put your feet on the dash panel.
Never put your feet on the surface of a seat.
Do not allow anyone to travel in the foot-
well.
Never travel without wearing the seat belt.
Do not allow anyone to travel in the lug-
gage compartment.
»
59
Technical dataAdviceOperationEmergenciesSafety
background
Safety
WARNING
Any inc
orrect sitting position increases the
risk of severe injuries.
Sitting in an incorrect position exposes the
vehicle occupants to severe injuries if airbags
are triggered, by striking a vehicle occupant
who has assumed an incorrect sitting posi-
tion.
Before the vehicle moves, assume the prop-
er sitting position and maintain it throughout
the trip. Before every trip, instruct your pas-
sengers to sit properly and to stay in this po-
sition during the trip page 57, Correct posi-
tion for passengers.
Correct adjustment of front head re-
s
tr
aint
s
Fig. 77 Correctly adjusted head restraint as
v
iew
ed fr
om the front and the side.
Properly adjusted head restraints are an im-
por
t
ant
part of passenger protection and can
reduce the risk of injuries in most accident
situations.
Adjust the head restraint so that its upper
edge is, as far as possible, at the same lev-
el as the top of your head, or at the very
least, at eye level Fig. 77.
WARNING
Trav
elling with the head restraints removed
or improperly adjusted increases the risk of
severe injuries. An improper adjustment of
the head restraints may cause death in an ac-
cident and increase the risk of suffering inju-
ries during abrupt braking actions or unex-
pected manoeuvres.
The head restraints must always be adjus-
ted according to the height of the passenger.
Correct adjustment of rear head re-
s
tr
aint
s
Fig. 78 Rear head restraint adjustment.
The rear head restraints have 2 positions:
Raised position or position for use
A
Fig. 78. In this po
sition, the head restraint
is used normally, protecting the occupant of
the rear seats, along with the rear seat belts.
Rest position, not in use
B
Fig. 78
. This
position improves the driver's rear visibility.
To fit the head restraint in position for use
A
, pull on the edges with both hands in the
dir
ection of
the arr
ow. To place it in rest posi-
tion
B
, lower the head restraint.
WARNING
Whenever a pa
ssenger is seated on the rear
seats, the head restraint should be placed in
the position for use
A
.
60
background
Seat belts
Do not swap the c
entre rear head restraint
with either of the outer seat rear head re-
straints. Risk of injury in case of an accident!
Note
Note the instructions on the head restraints
a
djus
tment.
Pedal area
P
ed
a
ls
Ensure that you can always press the accel-
er
at
or
, brake and clutch pedals unimpaired
to the floor.
Ensure that the pedals can return unim-
paired to their initial positions.
Ensure that the floor mats are securely fas-
tened during the trip and do not obstruct
the pedals
.
On
ly
u
se floor mats which leave the pedals
clear and which are secured to prevent them
from slipping. You can obtain suitable floor
mats from a specialised dealership.
If a brake circuit fails, the brake pedal must
be pressed down thoroughly in order to stop
the vehicle.
Wear suitable footwear
Always wear shoes which support your feet
properly and give you a good feeling for the
pedals.
WARNING
If the peda
ls are obstructed, an accident
may occur. Risk of serious injuries.
Never lay or fit floor mats or other floor cov-
erings over the original floor mats. This
would reduce the pedal area and could ob-
struct the pedals. Risk of accident.
Never place objects in the driver footwell.
An object could move into the pedal area and
impair pedal operation. In the event of a sud-
den driving or braking manoeuvre, you will
not be able to operate the brake, clutch or ac-
celerator pedal. Risk of accident!
Seat belts
Wh
y
w
ear a seat belt?
Number of seats
Your vehicle has five se
ats, two in the front
and three in the rear. Each seat is equipped
with a three-point seat belt.
In some versions, your vehicle is approved
only for four seats. Two front seats and two
rear seats.
WARNING
Never tran
sport more than the permitted
amount of people in your vehicle.
Every vehicle occupant must properly fas-
ten and wear the seat belt belonging to his or
her seat. Children must be protected with an
appropriate child restraint system.
61
Technical dataAdviceOperationEmergenciesSafety
background
Safety
Seat belt lamp*
Fig. 79 Warning lamp on the instrument pan-
el
.
The control lamp illuminates to remind the
driv
er t
o f
asten his seat belt.
Before starting the vehicle:
Fasten your seat belt securely.
Instruct your passengers to fasten their
seat belts properly before driving off.
Protect children by using a child seat ac-
cording to the child's height and weight.
When the ignition is switched on, the control
lamp in the instrument panel lights up* if
the driver or passenger* have not fastened
their seat belts.
An audible warning signal will sound for a
few seconds if the seat belts are not fastened
as the vehicle drives off and reaches a speed
of more than approximately 25 km/h
(15 mph) or if the seat belts are unfastened
while the vehicle is in motion. The warning
lamp will also flash .
The lamp goes out when the driver and
passenger seat belts are fastened with the ig-
nition switched on.
The protective function of seat belts
Fig. 80 Drivers with properly worn seat belts
w
i
l
l not be thrown forward in the event of sud-
den braking
Properly worn seat belts hold the occupants
in the pr
oper po
s
ition. These also help pre-
vent uncontrolled movements that may result
in serious injury and reduce the risk of being
thrown out of the vehicle.
Vehicle occupants wearing their seat belts
correctly benefit greatly from the ability of the
belts to absorb kinetic energy. In addition,
the front part of your vehicle and other pas-
sive safety features (such as the airbag sys-
tem) are designed to absorb the kinetic ener-
gy released in a collision. Taken together, all
these features reduce the releasing kinetic
energy and consequently, the risk of injury.
This is why it is so important to fasten seat
belts before every trip, even when "just driv-
ing around the corner".
Ensure that your passengers wear their seat
belts as well. Accident statistics have shown
that wearing seat belts is an effective means
of substantially reducing the risk of injury
and improving the chances of survival when
involved in a serious accident. Furthermore,
properly worn seat belts improve the protec-
tion provided by airbags in the event of an
accident. For this reason, wearing a seat belt
is required by law in most countries.
Although your vehicle is equipped with air-
bags, the seat belts must be fastened and
worn. The front airbags, for example, are only
triggered in some cases of head-on collision.
The front airbags will not be triggered during
minor frontal or side collisions, rear-end colli-
sions, rollovers or accidents in which the air-
bag trigger threshold value in the control unit
is not exceeded.
Therefore, you should always wear your seat
belt and ensure that all vehicle occupants
have fastened their seat belts properly before
you drive off!
62
background
Seat belts
Safety instructions on using seat
belt
s
Always wear the seat belt as described in
this section.
En
sure that the seat belts can be fastened
at all times and are not damaged.
WARNING
If seat
belts are worn incorrectly or not at
all, the risk of severe injuries increases. The
optimal protection from seat belts can be
achieved only if you use them properly.
Fasten your seat belt before every trip -
even when driving in town. Other vehicle oc-
cupants must also wear the seat belts at all
times, otherwise they run the risk of being in-
jured.
The seat belt cannot offer its full protection
if the seat belt is not positioned correctly.
Never allow two passengers (even children)
to share the same seat belt.
Always keep both feet in the footwell in
front of your seat as long as the vehicle is in
motion.
Never unbuckle a seat belt while the vehi-
cle is in motion. Risk of fatal injury.
The seat belt must never be twisted while it
is being worn.
The seat belt should never lie on hard or
fragile objects (such as glasses or pens, etc.)
because this can cause injuries.
Do not al
low the seat belt to be damaged or
jammed, or to rub on any sharp edges.
Never wear the seat belt under the arm or
in any other incorrect position.
Loose, bulky clothing (such as an overcoat
over a jacket) impairs the proper fit and func-
tion of the seat belts, reducing their capacity
to protect.
The slot in the seat belt buckle must not be
blocked with paper or other objects, as this
can prevent the latch plate from engaging se-
curely.
Never use seat belt clips, fastening rings or
similar items to alter the position of the belt
webbing.
Frayed or torn seat belts or damage to the
connections, belt retractors or parts of the
buckle could cause severe injuries in the
event of an accident. Therefore, you must
check the condition of all seat belts at regular
intervals.
Seat belts which have been worn in an acci-
dent and stretched must be replaced by a
specialised workshop. Renewal may be nec-
essary even if there is no apparent damage.
The belt anchorage should also be checked.
Do not attempt to repair a damaged seat
belt yourself. The seat belts must not be re-
moved or modified in any way.
The belts must be kept clean, otherwise the
retractors may not work properly.
Head-on collisions and the laws of
ph
y
s
ics
Fig. 81 A driver not wearing a seat belt is
thr
o
wn f
orward violently
Fig. 82 The unbelted passenger in the rear
se
at
i
s thrown forward violently, hitting the
driver who is wearing a seat belt.
It is easy to explain how the laws of physics
w
ork
in the c
ase of a head-on collision: when
a vehicle starts moving, a type of energy
»
63
Technical dataAdviceOperationEmergenciesSafety
background
Safety
called “kinetic energy” is created both in the
p
a
s
sengers and inside the vehicle.
The amount of “kinetic energy” depends on
the speed of the vehicle and the weight of
the vehicle and its passengers. The higher
the speed and the greater the weight, the
more energy there is to be “absorbed” in an
accident.
The most significant factor, however, is the
speed of the vehicle. If the speed doubles
from 25 km/h (15 mph) to 50 km/h
(30 mph), for example, the corresponding ki-
netic energy is multiplied by four.
Because the vehicle occupants in our exam-
ple are not restrained by seat belts, in the
event of crashing against a wall, all of the oc-
cupants' kinetic energy will be absorbed
solely by said impact.
Even at speeds of 30 km/h (19 mph) to
50 km/h (30 mph), the forces acting on bod-
ies in a collision can easily exceed one tonne
(1000 kg). At greater speed these forces are
even higher.
Vehicle occupants not wearing seat belts are
not “attached” to the vehicle. In a head-on
collision, they will move forward at the same
speed their vehicle was travelling just before
the impact. This example applies not only to
head-on collisions, but to all accidents and
collisions.
Even at low speeds the forces acting on the
body in a collision are so great that it is not
possible to brace oneself with one's hands.
In a frontal collision, unbelted passengers
are thrown forward and will make violent con-
tact with the steering wheel, dash panel,
windscreen or whatever else is in the way
Fig. 81.
It is also important for rear passengers to
wear seat belts properly, as they could other-
wise be thrown forward violently through the
vehicle interior in an accident. Passengers in
the rear seats who do not use seat belts en-
danger not only themselves but also the front
occupants ›› Fig. 82.
How to properly adjust your
seatbelt
Fastening and unfastening the seat
belt
Fig. 83 Positioning and removing the seat
belt
b
uc
kle.
64
background
Seat belts
Fig. 84 Position of seat belt during pregnan-
cy
.
Fasten your seat belt
The se
at
belt
cannot offer its full protection if
the seat belt is not positioned correctly.
Adjust the seat and head restraint correctly.
To fasten the belt, take hold of the latch
plate and pull it slowly across your chest and
lap.
Insert the latch plate into the buckle for the
appropriate seat and push it down until it is
securely locked with an audible click
Fig. 83.
Pull the belt to ensure that the latch plate is
securely engaged in the buckle.
The seat belts are equipped with an automat-
ic retractor on the shoulder strap. Full free-
dom of movement is permitted when the
shoulder belt is pulled slowly. However, dur-
ing sudden braking, during travel in steep
areas or bends and during acceleration, the
automatic retractor on the shoulder belt is
locked.
The automatic belt retractors on the front
seats are fitted with seat belt tensioners
page 65.
Releasing the seat belt
Press the red button on the belt buckle
Fig. 83. The latch plate is released and
springs out
.
Guide the belt back by hand so that it rolls
up e
a
s
ily and the trim is not damaged.
Positioning seat belts
Seat belts offer their maximum protection on-
ly when they are properly positioned.
WARNING
The seat belt
s offer best protection only
when the backrests are in an upright position
and the seat belts have been fastened prop-
erly.
Never put the latch plate in the buckle of
another seat. If you do this, the seat belt will
not protect you properly and the risk of injury
is increased.
Never unbuckle a seat belt while the vehi-
cle is in motion. If you do, you increase the
risk of sustaining severe or fatal injuries.
An incorrectly
worn seat belt can cause se-
vere injuries in the event of an accident.
The shoulder part of the seat belt must lie
on the centre of the shoulder, never across
the neck. The seat belt must lie flat and fit
comfortably on the torso
The lap part of the seat belt must lie across
the pelvis, never across the stomach. The
seat belt must lie flat and fit comfortably on
the pelvis Pull the belt tight if necessary to
take up any slack.
For pregnant women, the lap part of the
seat belt must lie as low as possible over the
pelvis, never across the stomach, and always
lie flat so that no pressure is exerted on the
abdomen ›› Fig. 84.
Always engage the retractor lock when you
are securing a child seat in group 0, 0+ or 1
page 72.
Read and observe the warnings ›› page 63.
Belt pretensioners*
Ho
w the se
at
belt tensioner works
Read the additional information carefully
page 13
The seat belts for the occupants in the front
seats are equipped with belt tensioners. Sen-
sors will trigger the belt pretensioners during
severe head-on, lateral and rear collisions
»
65
Technical dataAdviceOperationEmergenciesSafety
background
Safety
only if the seat belt is being worn. This re-
tr
acts
and tight
ens the seat belts, reducing
the forward motion of the occupants.
The belt tensioners will not be triggered in
the event of minor collisions, if the vehicle
overturns, or in accidents where no major
forces act on the vehicle.
Note
If the seat
belt tensioners are triggered, a
fine dust is produced. This is normal and it is
not an indication of fire in the vehicle.
The relevant safety requirements must be
observed when the vehicle or components of
the system are scrapped. Specialised work-
shops are familiar with these regulations,
which are also available to you.
Service and disposal of belt tension-
er
s
The belt tensioners are components of the
se
at
belts
that are installed in the seats of
your vehicle. If you work on the belt tension-
ers or remove and install parts of the system
when performing other repair work, the seat
belt may be damaged. The consequence may
be that, in the event of an accident, the belt
tensioners function incorrectly or may not
function at all.
So that the effectiveness of the seat belt ten-
sioner is not reduced and that removed parts
do not cause any injuries or environmental
pollution, regulations, which are known to
the specialised workshops, must be ob-
served.
WARNING
Improper use or r
epairs not carried out by
qualified mechanics increase the risk of se-
vere or fatal injuries. The belt tensioners may
fail to trigger or may trigger in the wrong cir-
cumstances.
Never attempt to repair, adjust, remove or
install parts of the belt tensioners or seat
belts.
The seat belt tensioner, seat belt and auto-
matic retractor cannot be repaired.
Any work on the belt tensioners and seat
belts, including the removal and refitting of
system parts in conjunction with other repair
work, must be performed by a specialised
workshop only.
The belt tensioners will only provide pro-
tection for one accident and must be changed
if they have been activated.
Airbag system
Brief
intr
oduction
Wh
y is it so important to wear a seat
belt and to sit correctly?
For the inflating airbags to achieve the best
protection, the se
at belt must always be worn
properly and the correct sitting position must
be assumed.
The airbag system is not a substitute for seat
belts, but it is an integral part of the vehicle's
overall passive safety system. Please bear in
mind that the airbag system can only work ef-
fectively when the vehicle occupants are
wearing their seat belts correctly and have
adjusted the head restraints properly. There-
fore, it is most important to properly wear the
seat belts at all times, not only because this
is required by law in most countries, but also
for your safety
page 61, Why wear a seat
belt?.
The airbag inflates in a matter of seconds, so
if you are not properly seated when the air-
bag is triggered, you may sustain fatal inju-
ries. Therefore, it is essential that all vehicle
occupants assume a correct sitting position
while travelling.
Sharp braking before an accident may cause
a passenger not wearing a seat belt to be
thrown forward into the area of the deploying
66
background
Airbag system
airbag. In this case, the inflating airbag may
inflict
c
ritic
al or fatal injuries on the occu-
pant. This also applies to children.
Always maintain the greatest possible dis-
tance between yourself and the front airbag.
This way, the front airbags can completely
deploy when triggered, providing their maxi-
mum protection.
The most important factors that will trigger
an airbag are: the type of accident, the angle
of collision and the speed of the vehicle.
Whether or not the airbags are triggered de-
pends primarily on the vehicle deceleration
rate resulting from the collision and detected
by the control unit. If the vehicle deceleration
occurring during the collision and measured
by the control unit remains below the speci-
fied reference values, the front, side and/or
curtain airbags will not be triggered. Take in-
to account that the visible damage in a vehi-
cle involved in an accident, no matter how
serious, is not a determining factor for the
airbags to have been triggered.
WARNING
Wearin
g the seat belt incorrectly or assum-
ing an incorrect sitting position can lead to
critical or fatal injuries.
All vehicle occupants, including children,
who are not properly belted can sustain criti-
cal or fatal injuries if the airbag is triggered.
Children up to 12 years old should always
travel on the rear seat. Never transport chil-
dren in the v
ehicle if they are not restrained
or the restraint system is not appropriate for
their age, size or weight.
If you are not wearing a seat belt, or if you
lean forward or to the side while travelling or
assume an incorrect sitting position, there is
a substantially increased risk of injury. This
increased risk of injury will be further in-
creased if you are struck by an inflating air-
bag.
To reduce the risk of injury from an inflating
airbag, always wear the seat belt properly.
Always adjust the front seats properly.
Description of airbag system
The airbag system mainly comprises (as per
v
ehic
l
e equipment):
an electronic control and monitoring sys-
tem (control unit)
frontal airbags for driver and passenger,
side airbags,
curtain airbags,
a control lamp on the dash panel
page 68.
key-operated switch for front passenger air-
bag,
a control lamp for disabling/enabling the
front passenger airbag.
The airbag system operation is monitored
electronically. The airbag control lamp will il-
luminate for a few seconds every time the ig-
nition is switched on (self-diagnosis).
There is a fault in the system if the control
lamp :
does not light up when the ignition is
switched on page 68,
turns off after 4 seconds after the ignition
is switched on
turns off and then lights up again after the
ignition is switched on
illuminates or flashes while the vehicle is
moving.
The airbag system is not triggered if:
the ignition is switched off
there is a minor frontal collision
there is a minor side collision
there is a rear-end collision
the vehicle turns over.
WARNING
The seat belt
s and airbags can only provide
maximum protection if the occupants are
seated correctly page 57, Correct position
for passengers.
If a fault has occurred in the airbag system,
have the system checked immediately by a
specialised workshop. Otherwise, during a
»
67
Technical dataAdviceOperationEmergenciesSafety
background
Safety
frontal collision the system might not trigger
correctly
or may fail to trigger at all.
Airbag activation
The airbags deploy extremely rapidly, within
thousandths
of a second, to provide addi-
tional protection in the event of an accident.
A fine dust may develop when the airbag de-
ploys. This is normal and it is not an indica-
tion of fire in the vehicle.
The airbag system is only ready to function
when the ignition is on.
In special accidents instances, several air-
bags may activate at the same time.
In the event of minor head-on and side colli-
sions, rear-end collisions, overturning or roll-
over of the vehicle, airbags do not activate.
Activation factors
The conditions that lead to the airbag system
activating in each situation cannot be gener-
alised. Some factors play an important role,
such as the properties of the object the vehi-
cle hits (hard/soft), angle of impact, vehicle
speed, etc.
Deceleration trajectory is key for airbag acti-
vation.
The control unit analyses the collision trajec-
tory
and activates the respective restraint
system.
If the deceleration rate is below the prede-
fined reference value in the control unit the
airbags will not be triggered, even though
the accident may cause extensive damage to
the car.
The following airbags are triggered in seri-
ous head-on collisions
Driver airbag.
Front passenger front airbag
The following airbags are triggered in seri-
ous side-on collisions
Front side airbag on the side of the acci-
dent.
Rear side airbag on the side of the acci-
dent.
Curtain (head) airbag on the side of the ac-
cident.
In an accident with airbag activation:
the interior lights switch on (if the interior
light switch is in the courtesy light position);
the hazard warning lights switch on;
all doors are unlocked;
the fuel supply to the engine is cut.
Airbag control lamp and seat belt ten-
sioner
The control lamp monitors all airbags and
seat belt
tensioners in the vehicle, including
control units and wiring connections.
Monitoring of airbag and belt tensioner sys-
tem
Both the airbag and belt tensioner systems
operation is constantly monitored electroni-
cally. The control lamp will light up for a
few seconds every time the ignition is switch-
ed on (self-diagnosis).
The system must be checked when the con-
trol lamp :
does not light up when the ignition is
switc
hed on,
turns off after 4 seconds after the ignition
is switched on
turns off and then lights up again after the
ignition is switched on
illuminates or flashes while the vehicle is
moving.
In the event of a malfunction, the warning
lamp remains on continuously. Have the air-
bag system inspected immediately by a spe-
cialised workshop.
68
background
Airbag system
If any of the airbags are disabled by a Techni-
c
al
Service, the warning lamp flashes for sev-
eral more seconds after verification and will
turn off if there is no fault.
WARNING
If there i
s a malfunction, the airbag and
belt tensioner system cannot properly per-
form its protective function.
If a malfunction occurs, have the system
checked immediately by a specialised work-
shop. Otherwise, in the event of an accident,
the airbag system and belt tensioners may
not be triggered, or may not be triggered cor-
rectly.
Airbag safety instructions
Fr
ont
airb
ags
Read the additional information carefully
page 14.
WARNING
The seat belt
s and airbags can only provide
maximum protection if the occupants are
seated correctly page 57, Correct position
for passengers.
The deployment space between the front
passengers and the airbags must not in any
case be occupied by other passenger, pets
and objects.
The airbags
provide protection for just one
accident; replace them once they have de-
ployed.
It is also important not to attach any ob-
jects such as cup holders or telephone
mountings to the surfaces covering the air-
bag units.
Do not attempt to modify components of
the airbag system in any way.
Side airbags*
Read the additional information carefully
page 15.
WARNING
If y
ou do not wear a seat belt, if you lean
forward, or are not seated correctly while the
vehicle is in motion, you are at a greater risk
of injury if the side airbag system is triggered
in an accident.
In order for the side airbags to provide their
maximum protection, the prescribed sitting
position must always be maintained with
seat belts fastened while travelling.
Occupants of the outer seats must never
carry any objects or pets in the deployment
space between them and the airbags, or al-
low children or other passengers to travel in
this position. It is also important not to at-
tach any accessories (such as cup holders) to
the doors. This would impair the protection
offered b
y the side airbags.
The built-in coat hooks should be used only
for lightweight clothing. Do not leave any
heavy or sharp-edged objects in the pockets.
Great forces, such as hard blows or kicks,
must not be exerted upon the backrest bol-
ster because the system may be damaged. In
this case, the side airbags would not be trig-
gered.
Under no circumstances should protective
covers be fitted over seats with side airbags
unless the covers have been approved for use
in your vehicle. Because the airbag deploys
from the side of the backrest, the use of con-
ventional seat covers would obstruct the side
airbag, seriously reducing the airbag's effec-
tiveness.
Any damage to the original seat upholstery
or around the seams of the side airbag units
must be repaired immediately by a special-
ised workshop.
The airbags provide protection for just one
accident; replace them once they have de-
ployed.
Any work on the side airbag system or re-
moval and installation of the airbag compo-
nents for other repairs (such as removal of
the front seat) should only be performed by a
specialised workshop. Otherwise, faults may
occur during the airbag system operation.
Do not attempt to modify components of
the airbag system in any way.
»
69
Technical dataAdviceOperationEmergenciesSafety
background
Safety
The side and hea
d airbags are managed
through sensors located in the interior of the
front doors. To ensure the correct operation of
the side and curtain (head) airbags neither
the doors nor the door panels should be
modified in any way (e.g. fitting loudspeak-
ers). If the front door is damaged, the airbag
system may not work correctly. All work car-
ried out on the front door must be done in a
specialised workshop.
In a side-on collision the side airbags will
not work if the sensors do not correctly meas-
ure the pressure increase on the interior of
the doors, due to air escaping through the
areas with holes or openings in the door pan-
el.
Never drive if the interior door panels have
been removed or if the panels have not been
correctly fitted.
Never drive the vehicle if the loudspeakers
in the door panels have been removed, un-
less the holes left by the loudspeakers have
been closed properly.
Always check that the openings are closed
or covered if additional loudspeakers or other
equipment are fitted inside the door panels.
Any work carried out to the doors should be
made in an authorised specialised workshop.
Curtain airbags*
Read the additional information carefully
page 15.
WARNING
The airbag is deployed at high speed in frac-
tions of
a second.
Do not obstruct the head-protection airbag
deployment areas.
Never secure objects over the curtain air-
bag cover or in its deployment area.
Occupants of the front seats and rear side
seats must never carry any other people, ani-
mals or objects in the deployment space be-
tween them and the airbags. Make sure that
all the vehicle occupants, including children,
observe this.
The clothes hangers are intended only for
light articles of clothing. Do not leave any
heavy or sharp-edged objects in the pockets.
Do not mount accessories on the doors.
Use only sun blinds which have been ex-
pressly approved for use in your vehicle.
Do not turn the sun blinds towards the win-
dows if there are objects, e.g. pens or garage
remote controls, secured to them.
Deactivating airbags
D
e
activ
ation of front passenger front
airbag*
Fig. 85 In the glove compartment: Switch for
activ
atin
g and de
activating the front passen-
ger airbag
Fig. 86 Centre side of dash panel: control
l
amp f
or de
activated front passenger airbag
in centre console
70
background
Airbag system
Read the additional information carefully
page 14
If you fit a rear-facing child seat to the front
passenger seat, the front passenger front air-
bag must be de-activated.
When the front passenger airbag is deactiva-
ted, this means that only the front passenger
front airbag is deactivated. All the other air-
bags in the vehicle remain activated.
Activating the front passenger front airbag
Switch the ignition off.
Open the glove compartment on the front
passenger side.
Insert the key into the slot of the switch for
deactivating the front passenger airbag
Fig. 85. About 3/4 of the key should en-
ter, as far as it will go.
Then turn the key gently to the  position.
Do not force it if you feel resistance, and
make sure you have inserted the key fully.
When the ignition is switched on, check
whether the control lamp   
 on the dash panel does ›› Fig. 86 not
light up
.
WARNING
It is
the driver's responsibility to ensure
that the key-operated switch is set to the cor-
rect position.
You shoul
d deactivate the front passenger
front airbag only if you have to use a rear-fac-
ing child seat in exceptional cases
page 72, Transporting children safely.
Never install a child seat facing backwards
on the front passenger seat unless the front
passenger front airbag has been disabled.
Otherwise, there is a risk of death.
As soon as the child seat is no longer nee-
ded on the front passenger seat, enable the
front passenger front airbag again.
Only deactivate the front passenger front
airbag when the ignition is off, otherwise a
fault may occur in the airbag system, which
could cause the airbag to not deploy properly
or not deploy at all in case of an accident.
Never leave the key in the airbag disabling
switch as it could get damaged or enable or
disable the airbag during driving.
When the passenger airbag is deactivated,
if the control lamp     is not
continuously lit up when the front passenger
airbag is disabled, there may be a fault in the
airbag system:
Have the airbag system inspected imme-
diately by a specialised workshop.
Do not use a child seat on the front pas-
senger seat! The front passenger front
airbag could be triggered in the event of
an accident, even if there is a fault in the
system and, as a result, a child could sus-
tain serious or fatal injuries.
It is unpredictable whether the front pas-
senger airbag will deploy in the event of
an accident. Warn all your passengers of
this.
71
Technical dataAdviceOperationEmergenciesSafety
background
Safety
Transporting children safely
Saf
ety
f
or children
Introduction
For safety reasons, as we have learned from
accident
statistics, we recommend that chil-
dren under 12 years of age travel in the rear
seats. Depending on their age, height and
weight, children travelling in rear seats must
use a child seat or a seat belt. For safety rea-
sons, the child seat should be installed in the
rear seat, behind the front passenger seat or
in the centre back seat.
The physical laws involved and the forces
acting in a collision apply also to children
page 63. But unlike adults, children do not
have fully developed muscle and bone struc-
tures. This means that children are subject to
a greater risk of injury.
To reduce the risk of injuries, children must
always use special child restraint systems
when travelling in the vehicle.
We recommend the use of child safety prod-
ucts from the SEAT Original Accessories Pro-
gramme, which includes systems for all ages
made by “Peke” (not for all countries).
These systems have been especially de-
signed and approved, complying with the
ECE-R44. regulation.
Follow the manufacturer's instructions and
obser
ve any statutory requirements when in-
stalling and using child seats. Always read
and note page 72.
We recommend you always carry the manu-
facturer's Child Seat Instruction Manual to-
gether with the on-board documentation.
Important information regarding the
front passenger's airbag
Read the additional information carefully
page 16.
Read and always observe the safety informa-
tion included in the following chapters:
Safety distance with respect to the passen-
ger airbag page 66.
Objects between the passenger and the
passenger side airbag
in Front airbags
on p
ag
e 69
.
The passenger side front airbag, when ena-
bled, is a serious risk for a child that is facing
backward since the airbag can strike the seat
with such force that it can cause serious or
fatal injuries. Children up to 12 years old
should always travel on the rear seat.
Therefore we strongly recommend you to
transport children on the rear seats. This is
the safest location in the vehicle. Alternative-
ly, the front passenger airbag can be disa-
bled with a key-operated switch ›› page 70.
When transporting children, use a child seat
appropriate to the age and size of each child.
WARNING
If a chi
ld seat is secured to the front pas-
senger seat, the risk to the child of sustain-
ing critical or fatal injuries in the event of an
accident increases.
An inflating front passenger airbag can
strike the rear-facing child seat and project it
with great force against the door, the roof or
the backrest.
Never install a child seat facing backwards
on the front passenger seat unless the front
passenger front airbag has been disabled.
Risk of potentially fatal injuries to the child!
However, if it is necessary, in exceptional ca-
ses, to transport a child in the front passen-
ger seat, the front passenger front airbag
must always be disabled ››page 70, Deacti-
vation of front passenger front airbag*. If the
front passenger seat has a height adjustment
option, move it to the highest position.
For those vehicles that do not include a key
lock switch to deactivate the airbag, the vehi-
cle must be taken to a technical service.
All vehicle occupants, especially children,
must assume the proper sitting position and
be properly belted in while travelling.
Never hold children or babies on your lap,
this can result in potentially fatal injuries to
the child!
72
background
Transporting children safely
Never al
low a child to be transported in a
vehicle without being properly secured, or to
stand up or kneel on a seat while travelling.
In an accident, the child could be flung
through the vehicle, causing possibly fatal in-
juries to themselves and to the other vehicle
occupants.
If children assume an improper sitting posi-
tion when the vehicle is moving, they expose
themselves to greater risk of injury in the
event of a sudden braking manoeuvre or in an
accident. This is particularly important if the
child is travelling on the front passenger seat
and the airbag system is triggered in an acci-
dent; as this could cause serious injury or
even death.
A suitable child seat can protect your child!
Never leave a child alone in the child seat
or inside the vehicle because depending on
the season, very high temperatures may be
reached inside a parked vehicle, which could
be fatal.
Children who are less than 1.5 metres tall
must not wear a normal seat belt without a
child seat, as this could cause injuries to the
abdominal and neck areas during a sudden
braking manoeuvre or in an accident.
Do not allow the seat belt to become twis-
ted and the seat belt should be properly in
place page 61.
Only one child may occupy a child seat
page 73, Child seats.
When a chil
d seat is mounted in the rear
seats, the door child-proof lock should be ac-
tivated page 115.
Child seats
Safety in
structions
Read the additional information carefully
page 16.
WARNING
When travelling, children must be secured in
the vehic
le with a restraint system suitable
for age, weight and size.
Read and always observe information and
warnings concerning the use of child seats
page 72.
WARNING
The retaining rings are designed only for use
with “ISOFIX” and Top
Tether* system child
seats.
Never secure other child seats that do not
have the “ISOFIX” or Top Tether* system, or
retaining belts or objects to the fastening
rings - this can result in potentially fatal inju-
ries to the child.
Ensure that the child seat is secured cor-
rectly using the “ISOFIX” and Top Tether* se-
curing rings.
WARNING
An undue installation of the safety seat will
incre
ase the risk of injury in the event of a
crash.
Never tie the retainer strap to a hook in the
luggage compartment.
Never secure or tie luggage or other items
to the lower anchorages (ISOFIX) or the upper
ones (Top Tether).
Categorisation of child seats into
gr
oup
s
Only use child seats that are officially ap-
pr
o
v
ed and suitable for the child.
Child seats are subject to the regulation ECE-
R 44. ECE-R stands for: Economic Commis-
sion for Europe Regulation.
The child seats are grouped into 5 catego-
ries:
Group 0: Up to 10 kg (up to around 9
months)
Group 0+: Up to 13 kg (up to around 18
months)
Group 1: from 9 to 18 kg (up to approx. 4
years old)
Group 2: from 15 to 25 kg (up to approx. 7
years old)
»
73
Technical dataAdviceOperationEmergenciesSafety
background
Safety
Group 3: Fr
om 22 to 36 kg (over around 7
y
e
ars old)
Child seats that have been tested and ap-
proved under the ECE R44 standard bear the
test mark on the seat (the letter E in a circle
with the test number below it).
Follow the manufacturer's instructions and
observe any statutory requirements when in-
stalling and using child seats.
We recommend you to always include the
manufacturer's Child Seat Instruction Manual
together with the on-board documentation.
SEAT recommends you use child seats from
the Original Accessories Catalogue. These
child seats have been designed and tested
for use in SEAT vehicles. You can find the
right child seat for your model and age group
at SEAT dealers.
WARNING
Read and always observe information and
warning
s concerning the use of child seats
page 72.
74
background
Self-help
Emergencies
Self
-help
Emer
g
ency equipment
Emergency warning triangle*
Fig. 87 IBIZA ST model: Housing for the emer-
g
ency
w
arning triangle in the luggage com-
partment.
The use of reflective warning triangles is
o
b
lig
atory in emergencies in some countries.
As are the first aid kit and a set of spare light
bulbs.
The warning triangle is under the storage
compartment which is located under the lug-
gage compartment floor.
Note
The warning tri
angle is not part of the vehi-
cle's standard equipment.
The warning triangle should meet legal re-
quirements.
First-aid kit and fire extinguisher*
Fig. 88 IBIZA ST model: Housing for the first-
aid k
it
in the lug
gage compartment.
The first-aid kit can go in the storage com-
p
ar
tment
which is located under the luggage
compartment floor.
The fire extinguisher* is attached to the lug-
gage compartment carpet with Velcro.
Note
The first
-aid kit and the fire extinguisher
are not part of the vehicle's standard equip-
ment.
The first
aid kit must comply with legal re-
quirements.
Observe the expiry date of the contents of
the first aid kit. After it has expired you
should purchase a new one.
The fire extinguisher must comply with le-
gal requirements.
Ensure that the fire extinguisher is fully
functional. The fire extinguisher should,
therefore, be checked regularly. The sticker
on the fire extinguisher will inform you of the
next date for checking.
Before acquiring accessories and emergen-
cy equipment see the instructions in “Acces-
sories and spares” ››page 190.
Vehicle tools
Read the additional information carefully
page 47
Some of the items listed are only provided in
certain model versions, or are optional ex-
tras.
WARNING
The factor
y-supplied jack is only designed
for changing wheels on this model. On no ac-
count attempt to use it for lifting heavier ve-
hicles or other loads. Risk of injury.
Use the jack only on a firm, level ground.
»
75
Technical dataAdviceOperationEmergenciesSafety
background
Emergencies
Never st
art the engine when the vehicle is
on the jack. Risk of accident.
If work is to be carried out underneath the
vehicle, this must be secured by suitable
means. Otherwise, there is a risk of injury.
Note
The jack does not generally require any main-
t
enanc
e. If required, it should be greased us-
ing universal type grease.
Spare wheel (temporary spare
wheel)*
The temporary spare wheel is stored under
the floor p
anel
in the lug
gage compartment
and is attached by a thumbnut.
How to use the temporary spare wheel
If you ever have a punctured tyre or loss of
pressure, the temporary spare wheel is only
intended for temporary use until you reach a
workshop. Change it for a duty wheel as soon
as possible.
Please note the following restrictions when
using the temporary spare wheel. This tem-
porary spare wheel has been specially de-
signed for your vehicle, thus, it cannot be
changed with the temporary spare wheel
from another vehicle.
No other type of tyre (normal summer or win-
ter tyre) may be fitted on the compact tempo-
rary spare wheel rim.
Snow chains
For technical reasons, snow chains must not
be used on the temporary spare wheel.
If you have a puncture on one of the front
wheels when using snow chains, fit the tem-
porary spare wheel in place of one of the rear
wheels. Fit the snow chains on the rear wheel
that you have removed and replace the punc-
tured front wheel with this wheel.
Extraction of the spare wheel in vehicles
with SEAT SOUND 6 speakers (with subwoof-
er)*
Disassemble the subwoofer's floor panel
(carpet) as follows:
Pull the carpet upwards to remove it.
Disconnect the subwoofer's speaker cable.
Turn the securing wheel anti-clockwise.
Remove the subwoofer speaker and the
spare wheel.
When replacing the spare wheel, place the
subwoofer speaker in the direction indicated
by the arrow and with the word “FRONT” fac-
ing forward.
Reconnect the speaker cable and firmly ro-
tate the sec
uring wheel clockwise so that the
subwoofer syst
em and wheel are firmly in
place.
WARNING
After fittin
g the temporary spare wheel,
check the tyre pressures as soon as possible.
Failure to do so may cause an accident. The
tyre pressures are listed on the inside of the
fuel tank flap.
Do not drive at over 80 km/h (50 mph)
when the temporary spare wheel is fitted on
the vehicle: risk of accident!
Avoid heavy acceleration, hard braking and
fast cornering: risk of accident!
Never use more than one temporary spare
wheel at the same time, risk of accident.
No other type of tyre (normal summer or
winter tyre) may be fitted on the compact
temporary spare wheel rim.
Tyre repair
TM
S
(T
yre Mobility System)*
Read the additional information carefully
page 46
The Anti-puncture kit* (Tyre Mobility System)
will reliably seal punctures caused by the
penetration of a foreign body of up to about
4 mm in diameter. Do not remove foreign ob-
jects, e.g. screws or nails, from the tyre.
76
background
Self-help
After inserting the sealant residue in the tyre,
y
ou mu
s
t again check the tyre pressure about
10 minutes after starting the engine.
You should only use the tire mobility set if
the vehicle is parked in a safe place, you are
familiar with the procedure and you have the
necessary tire mobility set! Otherwise, you
should seek professional assistance.
Do not use the tyre sealant in the following
cases:
If the wheel rim has been damaged.
In outside temperatures below -20°C (-4°F).
In the event of cuts or perforations in the
tyre greater than 4 mm.
If you have been driving with very low pres-
sure or a completely flat tyre.
If the sealant bottle has passed its use by
date.
WARNING
Using the tyre mobility system can be dan-
gerou
s, especially when filling the tyre at the
roadside. Please observe the following rules
to minimise the risk of injury:
Stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible.
Park it at a safe distance from surrounding
traffic to fill the tyre.
Ensure the ground on which you park is flat
and solid.
All
passengers and particularly children
must keep a safe distance from the work area.
Turn on the hazard warning lights to warn
other road users.
Use the tyre mobility system only if you are
familiar with the necessary procedures. Oth-
erwise, you should seek professional assis-
tance.
The tyre mobility set is intended for tempo-
rary emergency use only until you can reach
the nearest specialised workshop.
Replace the repaired tyre with the tyre mo-
bility set as soon as possible.
The sealant is a health hazard and must be
cleaned immediately if it comes into contact
with the skin.
Always keep the tyre mobility set out of the
reach of small children.
Never use a jack, even if it has been ap-
proved for your vehicle.
Always stop the engine, apply the hand-
brake lever firmly and engage gear if using a
manual gearbox, in order to reduce the risk of
vehicle involuntary movement.
WARNING
A tyre filled with sealant does not have the
same perf
ormance properties as a conven-
tional tyre.
Never drive faster than 80 km/h (50 mph).
Avoid heavy acceleration, hard braking and
fast cornering.
Drive for on
ly 10 minutes at a maximum
speed of 80 km/h (50 mph) and then check
the tyre.
For the sake of the environment
Dispose of used or expired sealant observing
an
y l
egal requirements.
Note
A new bottle of se
alant can be purchased at
SEAT dealerships.
Take into account the separate instruction
manual of the tyre mobility set* manufactur-
er.
Contents of the tyre mobility set*
Fig. 89 Standard representation: Contents of
the ty
r
e mo
bility system.
»
77
Technical dataAdviceOperationEmergenciesSafety
background
Emergencies
The tyre mobility set is located underneath
the floor c
o
v
ering in the luggage compart-
ment. It includes the following components
Fig. 89:
Tyre valve remover
Sticker indicating maximum speed “max.
80 km/h” or “max. 50 mph”
Filler tube with cap
Air compressor
Tube for inflating tyres
Warning provided by tyre pressure moni-
toring system (it can also be integrated in
the compressor).
Air bleed screw (in its place, the compres-
sor may have a button).
ON/OFF switch
12 volt connector
Bottle of sealant
Spare tyre valve
The valve insert remover
1
has a gap at the
lo
w
er end f
or a valve insert. The valve insert
can only be screwed or unscrewed in this
way. This also applies to its replacement part
11
.
WARNING
When inflating the wheel, the air compressor
and the inflator t
ube may become hot.
Protect hands and skin from hot parts.
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
Do not pl
ace the hot flexible inflator tube or
hot air compressor on flammable material.
Allow them to cool before storing the de-
vice.
If it is not possible to inflate the tyre to at
least 2.0 bars (29 psi / 200 kPa), the tyre is
too badly damaged. The sealant is not in a
good condition to seal the tyre. Do not con-
tinue driving. Seek specialist assistance.
CAUTION
Switch off the air compressor after a maxi-
mum of
8 operation
al minutes to avoid over-
heating! Before switching on the air compres-
sor again, let it cool for several minutes.
Check after 10 minutes of driving
Screw in the inflator tube
Fig. 89
5
again
and c
hec
k
the pressure on the gauge
6
.
1.3 b
ar (19 p
s
i / 130 kPa) and lower:
Stop the vehicle! The tyre cannot be sealed
sufficiently with the tyre mobility set.
You should obtain professional assistance
.
1.4 b
ar (20 p
s
i / 140 kPa) and higher:
Set the tyre pressure to the correct value
again.
Carefully resume your journey, without ex-
ceeding 80 km/h (50 mph), until you reach
the nearest specialised workshop and re-
place the tyre.
WARNING
Driving with an unsealed tyre is dangerous
and can cau
se accidents and serious injury.
Do not continue driving if the tyre pressure
is 1.3 bar (19 psi / 130 kPa) and lower.
Seek specialist assistance.
Changing the windscreen wiper
b
l
a
des
Changing the windscreen and rear
window wiper blades
Read the additional information carefully
page 54.
Perfect wiper blade condition is essential for
clear vision. Damaged wiper blades should
be replaced immediately.
The windscreen wiper blades are supplied as
standard with a layer of graphite. This layer is
responsible for ensuring that the wipe is si-
lent. If the graphite layer is damaged, the
noise of the water as it is wiped across the
windscreen will be louder.
78
background
Self-help
Check the condition of the wiper blades regu-
l
arly
.
If the wipers scrape across the glass,
they should be changed if they are damaged,
or cleaned if they are dirty ››
.
If
thi
s
does not produce the desired results,
the setting angle of the windscreen wiper
arms might be incorrect. They should be
checked by a specialised workshop and cor-
rected if necessary.
WARNING
Do not drive unless you have good visibility
through al
l windows!
Clean the windscreen wiper blades and all
windows regularly.
The wiper blades should be changed once
or twice a year.
CAUTION
Damaged or dir
ty windscreen wipers could
scratch the glass.
Never use fuel, nail varnish remover, paint
thinner or similar products to clean the win-
dows. This could damage the windscreen
wiper blades.
Never move any windscreen wiper by hand.
This could cause damage.
To prevent damage to the bonnet and the
windscreen wiper arms, the latter should only
be lifted off the windscreen when in service
position.
Note
The winds
creen wiper arms can be moved
to the service position only when the bonnet
is properly closed.
You can also use the service position, for
example, if you want to fix a cover over the
windscreen in the winter to keep it clear of
ice.
Towing or tow-starting
Notes
Read the additional information carefully
page 51
Please observe the following points if you
use a tow rope:
Notes for the driver of the towing vehicle
Move the vehicle slowly until the cable is
taut. Then accelerate gradually.
Begin and change gears cautiously. If you
are driving an automatic vehicle, accelerate
gently.
Remember that the brake servo and power
steering are not working in the vehicle you
are towing. Brake sooner than normal and
pressing the pedal gently.
Notes for the driver of the towed vehicle
Ensure that the tow rope remains taut at all
times when towing.
Towing vehicles with an automatic gearbox
Put the selector lever into position “N”.
Do not drive faster than 50 km/h (31 mph).
Do not tow further than 50 km.
If a breakdown vehicle is used, the vehicle
must be towed with the front wheels raised.
WARNING
If the vehicle has no electrical power, the
brake light
s, turn signals and all other lights
will no longer function. Do not have the vehi-
cle towed away. Failure to follow this instruc-
tion could result in an accident.
WARNING
Vehicle handling and braking capacity
chan
ge considerably during towing. Please
observe the following instructions to mini-
mise the risk of serious accidents and injury:
As the driver of the vehicle being towed:
You should depress the brake much hard-
er as the brake servo does not operate.
Pay the utmost attention to avoid crash-
ing into the towing vehicle.
More strength is required at the steering
wheel as the power steering does not op-
erate when the engine is switched off.
»
79
Technical dataAdviceOperationEmergenciesSafety
background
Emergencies
As the driver of
the towing vehicle:
Accelerate with particular care and cau-
tion.
Avoid sudden braking and manoeuvres.
Brake earlier than usual and more
smoothly.
CAUTION
When tow-starting, fuel could enter the cata-
lytic
con
verter and damage it.
Note
Obser
ve legal requirements when towing or
tow-starting.
Switch on the hazard warning lights of both
vehicles. However, observe any regulations
to the contrary.
For technical reasons, vehicles with an au-
tomatic gearbox must not be tow-started.
If there is no lubricant in the gearbox as the
result of a fault, you must raise the driven
wheels while the vehicle is being towed.
If the vehicle has to be towed more than
50 km (30 miles), the front wheels should be
raised during towing, and towing should be
carried out by a qualified person.
The steering wheel is locked when the vehi-
cle has no electrical power. The vehicle must
then be towed with the front wheels raised.
Towing should be carried out by a qualified
person.
The towline anc
horage should always be
kept in the vehicle.
Towline anchorages
Fig. 90 Towline anchorage at the front of the
v
ehic
l
e
Read the additional information carefully
page 51
Fitting the front towline anchorage
Take the towline anchorage from the on-
board tool set.
Remove the front cover by pressing down
on its left-hand side. For FR finishes, press
down and pull outwards. For the rest of the
Sport finishes, remove the cover by insert-
ing a screwdriver into the lower slot and
levering gently.
Bolt the anchorage to its limit to the left, in
the direction of the arrow Fig. 90.
Rear towline anchorage
There is a towline anchorage at the rear on
the right below the rear bumper.
80
background
Fuses and bulbs
Fuses and bulbs
F
u
se
s
Introduction
Due to the constant updating of vehicles,
fuse a
ssignments based on equipment and
the use of the same fuse for various electrical
components, it is not possible to provide an
up-to-date summary of the fuse positions for
the electrical components at the time this
manual was printed. For detailed information
about the fuse positions, please consult a
technical service.
In general, a fuse can be assigned to various
electrical components. Likewise, an electrical
component can be protected by several
fuses.
Only replace fuses when the cause of the
problem has been solved. If a newly inserted
fuse blows after a short time, you must have
the electrical system checked by a special-
ised workshop as soon as possible.
WARNING
The high voltages in the electrical system can
give serious
electrical shocks, causing burns
and even death!
Never touch the electrical wiring of the igni-
tion system.
Take c
are not to cause short circuits in the
electrical system.
WARNING
Using unsuitable fuses, repairing fuses or
bridgin
g a curr
ent circuit without fuses can
cause a fire and serious injury.
Never use a fuse with a higher value. Only
replace fuses with a fuse of the same amper-
age (same colour and markings) and size.
Never repair a fuse.
Never replace a fuse by a metal strip, staple
or similar.
CAUTION
To prev
ent damage to the vehicle's electric
system, before replacing a fuse always turn
off the ignition, the lights and all electrical
elements and remove the key from the igni-
tion.
If you replace a fuse with higher-rating
fuse, you could cause damage to another part
of the electrical system.
Protect the fuse boxes when open to pre-
vent the entry of dust or humidity as they can
damage the electrical system.
Always carefully remove the fuse box cov-
ers and refit them correctly to avoid problems
with your vehicle.
Note
One component m
ay have more than one
fuse.
Several components may run on a single
fuse.
In the vehicle, there are more fuses than
those indicated in this chapter. These should
only be changed by a specialised workshop.
Positions not containing a fuse do not ap-
pear in the following tables.
Some of the equipment listed in the tables
below pertain only to certain versions of the
model or are optional extras.
Please note that the above lists, while cor-
rect at the time of printing, are subject to
change.
Fuses to the left of the instrument
p
anel
Read the additional information carefully
page 44
Only replace fuses with a fuse of the same
amperage (same colour and markings) and
size.
Control box 1
No. Consumer/Amps
1 Left lights 40
2 Central locking 40
»
81
Technical dataAdviceOperationEmergenciesSafety
background
Emergencies
No. Consumer/Amps
3 Power C63 (30 Power) 30
4 PTC Relay (Engine glow) 50
5
Left pillar connector A pin 22 (motor
for closing window on driver's side)
30
6 For closing back left window (motor) 30
7 Horn 20
9 Panoramic roof 30
10 Active suspension 7.5
11 Headlight washer system relay 30
12 MIB display 5
13
(RL-15) SIDO Kl.15 supply (inputs 29
and 55)
30
14
Removing ignition key, diagnostics,
headlight lever (flashers), switching
on dipped /side beams (rotating
lights)
7.5
15
Air and heat control (supply)
7.5
Automatic gearbox lever
16 Instrument panel 5
17 Dwa Sensor, Alarm horn 7.5
23 Dual windscreen cleaner pump 7.5
24
Engine heater, heating control box
(supply)
30
26 12V Relay socket 5
No. Consumer/Amps
27 Rear window wiper motor 15
28 Lighter 20
29
Airbag control unit, airbag deactiva-
tion warning lamp
10
30
Reverse, Mirror joysticks, RKA, switch-
ing on heated seats, int. pressure A.C,
heating A.C. controls (supply), electro-
chromic mirror, PDC control, switching
on front and rear fog lights (rotating
lights).
7.5
31 Petrol gauge 5
32
AFS headlights, headlight regulator
(signal and adjustment), LWR Cent, di-
agnostics, front headlight lever
(switch on), Dimmer (headlight adjust-
ment)
7.5
33 Start-Stop relay, clutch sensor 5
34 Heated jets 5
35 Additional diagnostics 10
36 Heated seats 10
37
Soundaktor control feed, GRA feed,
Kühlerlüfter central feed
5
38 Right hand lights A/66 feed 40
39 ABS Pump (rear battery) 40
41 Heated rear window 30
42 Passenger side window controls 30
No. Consumer/Amps
43 Rear right window control 30
44 Reversing camera 10
45
Windscreen wiper feed lever, diagnos-
tics
10
46
Additional electric socket for luggage
compartment
20
47 ABS Ventil (rear battery) 25
49
EKP TDI relay (fuel pump feed) 30
EKP MPI relay (fuel pump feed) 20
TFSI pump gauge control 15
50 Multimedia Radio (power supply) 20
51 Heated mirrors 10
53 Rain sensor 5
54 30 ZAS (ignition switch) 5
55 Heated seats 10
Control box 2
No. Consumer/Amps
1 Lambda sensors 15
2
Vacuum pump motor 20
Pre-wired motor (coolant pump, varia-
ble valve distributor, active carbon
solenoid valve filter, pressure valve,
secondary air inlet valve)
10
82
background
Fuses and bulbs
Fuse arrangement in engine compart-
ment
Read the additional information carefully
page 44
Only replace fuses with a fuse of the same
amperage (same colour and markings) and
size.
No. Consumer/Amps
1
Fan, condenser 40
TK8 fan, condenser 50
2 Glow plugs 50
3
ABS Pump 40
EMBOX2-13 (TA8) 20
4 PTC glow phase 2 50
5 PTC glow phase 3 50
6 BDM, 30 ReF 5
7 MSG (KL30) 7.5
8 Windscreen wipers 30
9
Automatic gear box control, AQ 160
Control box
30
10
ABS Ventil 25
EMBOX2-11 (TA8) 5
No. Consumer/Amps
12
Injectors
10
TDI fuel metering adjuster, TA8 ex-
haust temperature sensor
13 Servo sensor 5
14
coolant pump high/low temperature,
gauge (relay EKP)
10
15 50 controls motor diag 5
16 Starter motor 30
17 Controls motor (MSG KL87) 20
18
PTC Relays, TOG sensor, engine
valves, PWM fan
10
19 Interior AUX Fuses 30
20
Glow plug relay, Heizrohr 5
Ignition coil 20
Changing bulbs
Gener
a
l
notes
Read the additional information carefully
page 45
Before changing any bulb, first turn off the
failed device.
Do not touch the glass part of the bulb with
your bare hands. The fingerprints left on the
glass will vaporise as a result of the heat gen-
erated by the bulb, reducing bulb life and
causing condensation on the reflector sur-
face, thus reducing effectiveness.
A bulb must only be replaced by one of the
same type. The type is indicated on the bulb,
either on the glass part or on the base.
Xenon headlights
With this type of headlight, the user can re-
place the turn signal bulb. Replacement of
the dipped/main beam bulb must be done by
Technical Services, given that complex ele-
ments must be removed from the vehicle and
the automatic control system that incorpo-
rates it must be reset.
The Xenon bulbs discharge 2.5 times the
light flux and have an average lifespan of 5
times more than that of halogen bulbs, this
means that, except due to unusual circum-
stances, there is no need to change the bulbs
for the whole life of the vehicle.
WARNING
Take p
articular care when working on com-
ponents in the engine compartment if the en-
gine is warm, there is a risk of burns.
Bulbs are highly sensitive to pressure. The
glass can break when you touch the bulb,
causing injury.
»
83
Technical dataAdviceOperationEmergenciesSafety
background
Emergencies
The high vo
ltage element of gas discharge
bulbs* (xenon light) must be handled correct-
ly. Otherwise, there is a risk of death.
When changing bulbs, please take care not
to injure yourself on sharp parts in the head-
light housing.
CAUTION
R
emov
e the ignition key before working on
the electric system. Otherwise, a short circuit
could occur.
Switch off the lights or parking lights be-
fore you change a bulb.
For the sake of the environment
Please ask your specialist retailer how to dis-
pose of u
sed bulbs in the proper manner.
Note
Depending on w
eather conditions (cold or
wet), the front lights, the fog lights, the tail
lights and the turn signals may be temporari-
ly misted. This has no influence on the useful
life of the lighting system. By switching on
the lights, the area through which the beam
of light is projected will quickly be demisted.
However, the edges may continue to be mis-
ted.
Please check at regular intervals that all
lighting (especially the exterior lighting) on
your vehicle is functioning properly. This is
not only in the interest of your own safety,
but a
lso that of all other road users.
Before changing a bulb, make sure you
have the correct new bulb.
Do not touch the glass part of the bulb with
your bare hands, use a cloth or paper towel
instead. The residue left by the fingerprints
would vaporise as a result of the heat gener-
ated by the bulb, they will be deposited on
the reflector and will impair its surface.
Single headlight bulb change
P
o
s
ition of the bulbs
Fig. 91 Single headlight.
Side lights - Dipped beam/main beam.
T
urn s
ign
al light.
DRL (day light)
A
B
C
Turn signal and DRL (day light) light
Fig. 92 Single headlight DRL light (day light).
Fig. 93 Single turn signal lamp.
Raise the bonnet.
Turn the bulb holder
Fig. 92
1
or
Fig. 93
2
to the left and pull.
Remove the bulb by pressing on the bulb
ho
l
der and t
urning it anti-clockwise at the
same time.
84
background
Fuses and bulbs
In
s
t
allation involves all of the above steps
in reverse sequence.
Dipped/main beam headlights and
side light
Fig. 94 Single headlight.
Fig. 95 Dipped beam/main beam and side
light
of
the s
ingle headlight.
Remove the cover
Raise the bonnet.
Move the loop
Fig. 94
1
in the direction
of
the arr
o
w and remove the cover.
Changing the dipped/main beam headlight
Remove connector Fig. 95
3
from the
b
u
l
b.
Unclip the retainer spring ›› Fig. 95
2
pressing inwards to the right.
Extract the bulb and fit the replacement so
th
at
the lug on the b
ase fits into the recess
on the reflector.
Fit the connector.
Fit the cover and close the strap. Make sure
that the gasket sits well on the casing cover
during the operation.
Check whether the new bulb is working.
Changing the side light
Extract the bulb holder Fig. 95
4
out-
w
ar
d
s.
Remove the bulb by pulling it out and fit-
ting the new one.
Installation involves all of the above steps
in reverse sequence.
Fit the cover and close the strap. Make sure
that the gasket sits well on the casing cover
during the operation.
Check whether the new bulb is working.
Double headlight bulb change
Position of the bulbs
Fig. 96 Double headlight.
Side lights
M
ain be
am he
adlights
Dipped beam headlights
Turn signal
DRL (LED day light)
A
B
C
D
E
85
Technical dataAdviceOperationEmergenciesSafety
background
Emergencies
Side light and main beam
Fig. 97 Double headlight.
Fig. 98 Side light and main beam headlights.
Remove the cover
Raise the bonnet.
Move the loop
1
in the direction of the ar-
r
o
w and r
emove the cover Fig. 97.
Changing the side light
Remove connector Fig. 98
2
by pulling
outw
ar
d.
R
emove the bulb by pulling it out and fit-
ting the new one.
Installation involves all of the above steps
in reverse sequence.
Fit the cover and close the strap. Make sure
that the gasket sits well on the casing cover
during the operation.
Check whether the new bulb is working.
Changing the main beam bulb
Remove connector Fig. 98
3
by pulling
outw
ar
d.
Extr
act the bulb and fit the replacement so
that it sits correctly into the cut-out on the
reflector.
Installation involves all of the above steps
in reverse sequence.
Fit the cover and close the strap. Make sure
that the gasket sits well on the casing cover
during the operation.
Check whether the new bulb is working.
Dipped beam headlight
Fig. 99 Double headlight.
Fig. 100 Dipped beam headlights.
Raise the bonnet.
Move the loop
Fig. 99
1
in the direction
of
the arr
o
w and remove the cover.
Remove connector Fig. 100
2
from the
b
u
l
b.
86
background
Fuses and bulbs
Unc
lip the r
et
ainer spring Fig. 100
3
pressing inwards to the right.
Extract the bulb and fit the replacement so
th
at
the lug on the b
ase fits into the recess
on the reflector.
Fit the connector.
Fit the cover and close the strap. Make sure
that the gasket sits well on the casing cover
during the operation.
Check whether the new bulb is working.
Turn signal light
Fig. 101 Turn signal light.
Raise the bonnet.
Turn the bulb holder
Fig. 101
1
to the
l
ef
t
and pull.
Remove the bulb by pressing on the bulb
holder and turning it anti-clockwise at the
same time.
Installation involves all of the above steps
in reverse sequence.
Changing the AFS headlight
bulbs
Position of the bulbs
Fig. 102 AFS headlight bulbs.
Turn signal
X
enon he
a
dlight (dipped beam/main
beam)
A
B
Changing the xenon bulb
The procedure for changing the bulb is the
same on both side
s of the vehicle.
WARNING
This type of bulb should be changed at a spe-
cia
lised workshop.
Turn signal bulb
Fig. 103 Turn signal light.
Raise the bonnet.
Turn bulb holder
Fig. 103
A
to the left
and p
u
l
l.
Remove the bulb by pressing on the bulb
holder and turning it anti-clockwise at the
same time.
Installation involves all of the above steps
in reverse sequence.
87
Technical dataAdviceOperationEmergenciesSafety
background
Emergencies
Changing the fog light bulbs
Fr
ont
f
og light bulb
Fig. 104 Front fog light.
Fig. 105 Front fog light.
Remove the bolt
Fig. 104
1
from the fog
light
gri
l
le with a screwdriver.
Subsequently, remove the clips located on
the edge of the grill with gentle leverage.
Remove the 3 bolts ›› Fig. 105
2
to re-
mo
v
e the f
og light.
Remove the metal clip situated on the up-
per part of the fog light by pulling towards
the exterior of the vehicle ›› Fig. 105
3
.
FR version fog-light bulb
Fig. 106 Fog light: access to the connector
and t
o the light
b
ulb holder.
Remove the 4 bolts
A
Fig. 106
from the
inside of the wheel housing and the 2 bot-
tom bolts
B
Fig. 106
from the bumper
with a screwdriver.
Pull the bumper to release it from its an-
chorages to access the connector and the
light bulb holder.
Note
Due to the difficulty of accessing fog light
bul
bs, have them replaced at a Technical
Service or specialised workshop.
Remove the bulb holder
Fig. 107 Front fog light.
Remove connector
Fig. 107
1
from the
b
u
l
b.
Turn the bulb holder Fig. 107
2
to the
l
ef
t
and pull.
Remove the bulb by pressing on the bulb
holder and turning it counter-clockwise at
the same time.
Installation involves all of the above steps
in reverse sequence.
Check that the bulb works properly.
88
background
Fuses and bulbs
Changing the tail light bulbs
S
umm
ar
y of LED tail lights
3 Applies to the model: IBIZA/IBIZA SC
LED
Brak
e lights
Side lights
Bulbs
Retro fog light
Reverse lights
Turn signal
Tail light summary
3 Applies to the model: IBIZA ST
T
ail lights on side panel Bulb lamps
Brake lights
Side lights
Turn signal
Lights on the r
ear lid Bulb lamps
Reverse lights
Side lights
Fog lights
Tail lights on side panel LED lamps
Brake light (LED)
Side light (LED)
Turn signal
Lights on the rear lid LED lamps
Reverse lights
Side light (LED)
Fog lights
Access to tail lights
3 Applies to the model: IBIZA/IBIZA SC
Fig. 108 Access to tail lights.
Open the rear lid.
Turn the bolt in the direction of the arrow,
b
y
h
and or with a screwdriver Fig. 108.
Remove the tail light, by pulling it out-
wards.
Changing tail lights
3 Applies to the model: IBIZA/IBIZA SC
Fig. 109 Changing the tail light bulbs
Fig. 110 Changing the tail light bulbs
Remove the connector from housing
A
Fig. 108.
»
89
Technical dataAdviceOperationEmergenciesSafety
background
Emergencies
R
emo
v
e the bulb holder, separating it from
the casing. To do this, press tabs
B
in the
dir
ection of
the arr
ows Fig. 109.
When the bulb holder has been removed,
press in the direction of the arrow
1
and at
the s
ame time, t
urn in the dir
ection of the ar-
row
2
Fig. 110
Ch
an
ging bulbs. LED lamps
Carry out the same operations as in lights fit-
ted with bulbs.
If necessary, remove the socket, as if it were
a bulb.
If the brake light and/or side light with LEDs
have to be replaced, the tail light must be re-
placed.
Changing the tail light bulbs (on the
side panel)
3 Applies to the model: IBIZA ST
Fig. 111 Lights on the side.
Fig. 112 Removing the bulb holder.
Accessing the side light bulbs
Open the rear lid.
Look for a lid with a grill behind the side
lights.
R
emo
v
e the lid with a flat screwdriver, plac-
ing it in notch
A
Fig. 111
.
Ch
anging bulbs
Remove the bulb holder by pressing the
fastening clip
B
Fig. 112
and p
ulling it
outwards.
Replace the faulty bulb, rotating it to the
left and outwards.
To refit follow the steps in reverse order,
taking special care when fitting the bulb
holder.
Changing bulbs. LED lamps
Carry out the same operations as in lights fit-
ted with bulbs.
If necessary, remove the socket, as if it were
a bulb.
If the brake light and/or side light with LEDs
have to be replaced, the tail light must be re-
placed.
90
background
Fuses and bulbs
Changing the tail light bulbs (on the
r
e
ar lid)
3 Applies to the model: IBIZA ST
Fig. 113 Lights on the boot.
Fig. 114 Removing the bulb holder.
Accessing the rear lid lights
Open the rear lid.
On the rear lid lining there is a lid behind
e
ac
h light
.
Remove the lid with a flat screwdriver, plac-
ing it in notch
A
Fig. 113
.
Ch
anging bulbs
Remove the bulb holder by pressing the
fastening clips
B
Fig. 114
and p
ulling
outwards.
Replace the faulty bulb, rotating it to the
left and outwards.
To refit follow the steps in reverse order,
taking special care when fitting the bulb
holder.
Changing bulbs. LED lamps
Carry out the same operations as in lights fit-
ted with bulbs.
If necessary, remove the socket, as if it were
a bulb.
If the brake light and/or side light with LEDs
have to be replaced, the tail light must be re-
placed.
Changing the side and interior
bulbs
Turn signals
Fig. 115 Turn signals.
Press the turn signal to the left or to the
right
t
o r
emove the bulb.
Remove the bulb holder from the turn sig-
nal.
Remove the failed bulb and replace with a
new bulb.
Insert the bulb holder in the turn signal
guide until it clicks into place.
First fit the turn signal in the opening in the
chassis, fastening the tabs
1
Fig. 115
,
and then fit in the bulb as shown by the ar-
row
2
Fig. 115
.
91
Technical dataAdviceOperationEmergenciesSafety
background
Emergencies
Number plate light
3 Applies to the model: IBIZA/IBIZA SC
Inser
t the flat part of a screwdriver into the
special slot and remove the bulb.
Remove the bulb holder, by turning it until
it is free.
Change the bulb.
Replace the bulb holder, by turning it until
it fits fully.
Fit the light into the space and press until
you hear a “c
lick”.
Number plate light
3 Applies to the model: IBIZA ST
Fig. 116 Remove the number plate light.
Insert the flat part of a screwdriver into the
s
pec
i
al slot and remove the number plate
light from its moulding.
Remove the connector and extract the bulb.
After changing the bulb, fit the connector
again.
Place the light in its moulding, pressing the
left side. Once it is fitted into place, press
the right side until you hear a “click”.
Additional brake light*
Given the difficulty involved in the replace-
ment of thi
s light it should be done by Tech-
nical Services.
Interior light and front reading lights
Fig. 117 Front reading light.
To remove the glass
Insert a fine screwdriver between the cas-
in
g and the gl
a
ss Fig. 117.
Carefully remove the glass, levering it to
avoid possible damage.
To replace the bulbs
Pull the bulbs outwards.
To remove the central bulb, hold and press
to one side.
Assembly
Proceed in the reverse order, pressing gen-
tly on the outer edge of the side light.
First fit the glass with the fastening tabs
over the frame of the switch. Next press the
front part until the two long tabs click on
the support.
92
background
Fuses and bulbs
Luggage compartment light*
Fig. 118 Boot light.
Fig. 119 Boot light.
Extract the bulb by pressing on its inside
edg
e -
arr
ow- using the flat side of a screw-
driver Fig. 118.
Press the bulb sideways and remove it from
its housing Fig. 119.
93
Technical dataAdviceOperationEmergenciesSafety
background
Operation
Fig. 120 Dash panel.
94
background
Controls and displays
Operation
C
ontr
o
ls and displays
General instrument panel
Door release lever
Light swit
ch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123
Headlight range control* . . . . . . . . . . 125
Air vents
Lever for:
Turn signals/main beam head-
lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125
Cruise c
ontrol* . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 184
Instrument panel and warning
lamps:
In
struments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 96
Warning and indic
ation lamps . . . 35
Steering wheel with horn and
Driver airbag . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 66
On-board computer controls . . . . 25
Controls for radio, telephone,
navigation and speech dialogue
system
Booklet Radio
Paddle levers for tiptronic gear-
shift (automatic gearbox) . . . . . . . 162
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
Steering and starter lock . . . . . . . . . . 153
Lever for:
W
ind
s
creen wipers and washer . . 129
Window washer-wiper system* . . 129
Multi-function display control* . . 25
Infotainment system:
Depending on the equipment,
glove compartment with: . . . . . . . . . 136
CD player* and/or SD card*
Booklet Radio
Passenger airbag* . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14
Switches for:
Heating and ventilation . . . . . . . . . 146
Air conditioning* . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 148
C
limatronic* . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 150
Depending on the equipment, but-
tons
for:
SEAT Drive Profile . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 185
Park a
ssist system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 176
Hazard warning lights . . . . . . . . . . 127
Airbag off warning lamp* . . . . . . .68, 70
Depending on the equipment:
USB/AUX-IN inp
ut . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 112
Cigar
ette lighter/Power socket . . 138
Drink holder/Ashtray . . . . . . . . . . . . . 137
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
Controls in the centre console:
St
ar
t
-Stop operation button . . . . . 173
Tyre pressure monitoring* . . . . . . . 104
Heated rear window . . . . . . . . . . . . 128
Heated seats* . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 134
Central locking* . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 115
Handbrake lever . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 156
Gear lever
Automatic* . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 159
Manual . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 159
Storage space
Pedals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61
Steering column control lever* . . . . 13
Bonnet release lever . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 203
Fuse housing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 81
Control for adjusting electric exteri-
or mirrors* . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 131
Electric window controls* . . . . . . . . . 120
Note
Some of the items of equipment listed here
are fitted on
ly on certain model versions or
are optional extras.
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
95
Technical dataAdviceOperationEmergenciesSafety
background
Operation
Instruments and warning/control lamps
In
s
trument
s
General instrument panel
Fig. 121 Instrument panel, on dash panel
The layout of the instruments depends upon
the model
and the en
gine.
R
ev counter (with the engine running, in
hundreds of revolutions per minute)
page 97.
The beginning of the red zone of the rev
counter indicates the maximum speed in
any gear after running-in and with the en-
gine hot. However, it is advisable to
1
change up a gear or move the selector
l
ev
er t
o D (or lift your foot off the acceler-
ator) before the needle reaches the red
zone
.
En
gine c
oo
lant temperature display
page 99.
Displays on the screen page 97.
Adjuster button and display
page 99.
2
3
4
Speedometer.
F
uel
g
auge page 100.
WARNING
Any distraction may lead to an accident, with
the risk of
injury.
Do not operate the instrument panel con-
trols when driving.
5
6
96
background
Instruments and warning/control lamps
CAUTION
To prev
ent damage to the engine, the rev
counter needle should only remain in the red
zone for a short period of time.
When the engine is cold, avoid high revs
and heavy acceleration and do not make the
engine work hard.
For the sake of the environment
Changing up a gear in time reduces fuel con-
sumption and noise.
Rev counter
The rev counter indicates the number of en-
gine r
ev
o
lutions per minute
Fig. 121
1
.
T
og
ether w
ith the gear-change indicator, the
rev counter offers you the possibility of using
the engine of your vehicle at a suitable
speed.
The start of the red zone on the dial indicates
the maximum engine speed which may be
used briefly when the engine is warm and af-
ter it has been run in properly. Before reach-
ing this range, you should change to a higher
gear for vehicles with a manual gearbox or for
automatic gearboxes put the selector lever in
“D” or take your foot off the accelerator ped-
al.
We recommend that you avoid high revs and
that you follow the recommendations on the
gear-change indicator. Consult the additional
information in
page 28, Gear-change
indicator.
CAUTION
Never allow the rev counter needle
1
Fig. 121 to go int
o the red zone on the
scale for more than a very brief period, other-
wise there is a risk of engine damage.
For the sake of the environment
Changing up a gear early will help you to save
fuel and minimi
se emissions and engine
noise.
Indications on the display
A variety of information can be viewed on the
in
s
trument
panel display
Fig. 121
3
de-
pendin
g on the
v
ehicle equipment:
Bonnet, rear lid and doors open
page 28.
Information and warning texts.
Mileage.
Time.
Navigation instructions.
Outside temperature.
Compass.
Shift lever position page 159.
Recommended gear (manual gearbox)
page 28.
Multifunction display (MFD) and menus
with different setting options
page 25.
Service interval display
page 33.
Second speed display
page 25.
Speed warning function ››
page 32.
Start-Stop system status display
page 173.
Low consumption driving status (ECO)
page 98
Identifying letters on engine (MKB).
Active cylinder management display
(ACT
®
)* page 167
Distance travelled
The odometer registers the total distance
travelled by the car.
The odometer (trip) shows the distance
travelled since the last odometer reset. The
last digit of the trip recorder indicates distan-
ces of 100 metres or one tenths of a mile.
Briefly press the button ›› Fig. 121
4
to re-
set
the trip r
ec
order to 0.
Keep the button
4
pressed for about 3
sec
ond
s
and the previous value will be dis-
played.
»
97
Technical dataAdviceOperationEmergenciesSafety
background
Operation
Time
To set the time, keep the button
Fig. 121
4
pressed for more than 3 seconds to select
the hour or minut
e di
s
play.
To continue setting the time, press the up-
per or lower part of the button
4
. Hold but-
t
on do
wn t
o scroll through the numbers
quickly.
Press the button
4
again in order to finish
settin
g the time.
The time c
an al
so be set via the

key and
Set
up
function button in the Easy Connect
sy
s
t
em page 107.
Compass
With the ignition on and the navigation sys-
tem on, the cardinal point corresponding to
the direction of travel of the vehicle is dis-
played on the instrument panel.
Selector lever position
The selected gear is displayed on the side of
the selector lever and on the instrument pan-
el display. In positions D and S, and with the
Tiptronic, the corresponding gear is also dis-
played.
Recommended gear (manual gearbox)
The recommended gear in order to save fuel
is displayed on the instrument panel while
you are driving ››
page 28.
Second speed display (mph or km/h)
In addition to the speedometer, the speed
can also be displayed in a different unit of
measurement (in miles or in km per hour).
This option cannot be deactivated in models
destined for countries in which the second
speed must always be visible.
The second speed display can be adjusted in
the Easy Connect system via the

key and
the
Set
up
function button
page 107.
Speed warning
When the speed setting is exceeded, this will
be indicated on the instrument panel display.
This is very useful, for example when using
winter tyres that are not designed for driving
at the maximum speed of the vehicle
page 32.
The speed warning settings can be adjusted
in the Easy Connect system via the

key
and the
Set
up
function button
page 107.
Start-Stop operating display
Updated information relating to the status is
displayed on the instrument panel
page 173.
Low consumption driving status (ECO)*
Depending on the equipment, when driving,
the “ECO” display appears on the instrument
panel when the vehicle is in low consump-
tion status due to active cylinder manage-
ment (ACT
®
)*
page 30.
Identifying letters on engine (MKB)
Hold the button Fig. 121
4
down for more
th
an 15 sec
ond
s to display the identifying
letters of the vehicle engine (MKB). To do
this, the ignition must be switched on and
the engine switched off.
WARNING
Observe the safety warnings ››
in Warning
symbols on p
age 101.
WARNING
Even though outside temperatures are above
freezin
g, some roads and bridges may be icy.
At outside temperatures above +4°C
(+39°F), even when the “ice crystal symbol”
is not visible, there may still be patches of ice
on the road.
Never rely on the outside temperature indi-
cator!
Note
Different
versions of the instrument panel
are available and therefore the versions and
instructions on the display may vary. In the
case of displays without warning or informa-
tion texts, faults are indicated exclusively by
the warning lamps.
98
background
Instruments and warning/control lamps
Depending on the equipment, some set
-
tings and instructions can also be carried out
in the Easy Connect system.
When several warnings are active at the
same time, the symbols are shown succes-
sively for a few seconds and will stay on until
the fault is rectified.
Odometer
Fig. 122 Instrument panel: odometer and re-
set
b
utt
on.
The distance covered is displayed in “kilome-
tr
e
s” or mi
les “m”. It is possible to change
the measurement units (kilometres
“km”/miles “m”) in the radio/Easy Connect*.
Please refer to the Easy Connect* Instructions
Manual for more details.
Odometer/trip recorder
The odometer shows the total distance cov-
ered by the vehicle.
The trip recorder shows the distance that has
been travelled since it was last reset. It is
used to measure short trips. The last digit of
the trip recorder indicates distances of 100
metres or tenths of a mile.
The trip recorder can be set to zero by press-
ing
0.0/SET
Fig. 122
.
F
ault display
If there is a fault in the instrument panel, the
letters DEF will appear in the trip recorder
display. Have the fault repaired immediately,
as far as is possible.
Coolant temperature gauge
For vehicles with no coolant temperature
g
aug
e, a c
ontrol lamp appears for high
coolant temperatures
page 207. Please
note
.
The c
oo
l
ant temperature gauge
2
Fig. 121 only w
orks when the ignition is
switched on. In order to avoid engine dam-
age, please read the following notes for the
different temperature ranges.
Engine cold
If only
the diodes in the lower part of the
scale light up, this indicates that the engine
has not yet reached operating temperature.
Avoid high revs and heavy acceleration and
do not make the engine work hard.
Normal temperature
If in normal operations, the diodes light up
until the central zone, it means that the en-
gine has reached operating temperature. At
high outside temperatures and when making
the engine work hard, the diodes may contin-
ue lighting up and reach the upper zone. This
is no cause for concern, provided the control
lamp does not light up on the instrument
panel digital display.
Heat range
When the diodes light up in the upper area of
the display and the control lamp appears
on the instrument panel display, the coolant
temperature is excessive ›› page 207.
CAUTION
To ens
ure a long useful life for the engine,
avoid high revs, driving at high speed and
making the engine work hard for approxi-
mately the first 15 minutes when the engine
is cold. The phase until the engine is warm al-
so depends on the outside temperature. If
necessary, use the engine oil temperature*
page 31 as a guide.
»
99
Technical dataAdviceOperationEmergenciesSafety
background
Operation
Additiona
l lights and other accessories in
front of the air inlet reduce the cooling effect
of the coolant. At high outside temperatures
and high engine loads, there is a risk of the
engine overheating.
The front spoiler also ensures proper distri-
bution of the cooling air when the vehicle is
moving. If the spoiler is damaged this can re-
duce the cooling effect, which could cause
the engine to overheat. Seek specialist assis-
tance.
Fuel level
Fig. 123 Fuel gauge.
The display
6
Fig. 121
only works when
the ignition is switched on. When the display
reaches the reserve mark, the lower diode
lights up in red and the control lamp ap-
pears page 96. When the fuel level is very
low, the lower diode flashes in red.
The distance to empty fuel level is displayed
on the instrument panel
3
Fig. 121
.
Y
ou can consult the tank capacity of your ve-
hicle in the
page 40 section.
CAUTION
Never run the fuel tank completely dry. An ir-
regu
lar fuel supply could cause misfiring. In
this way the unburned fuel can reach the ex-
haust system, which could cause the catalytic
converter to overheat resulting in damage.
Warning and indication lamps
W
arnin
g symbo
ls
Read the additional information carefully
page 35
There are red warning symbols (priority 1)
and yellow warning symbols (priority 2).
Warning messages, Priority 1 (red)
If one of these faults occurs, the warning
lamp will light up or flash and will be accom-
panied by three audible warnings. This is a
danger warning. Stop the vehicle and switch
off the engine. Check the fault and correct it.
Obtain professional assistance if necessary.
If several priority 1 faults are detected at the
same time, the symbols will be displayed one
after the other for about 2 seconds at a time
and will continue until the fault is corrected.
No menus will be shown in the display for the
duration of a priority 1 warning message.
Examples of priority 1 warning messages
(red)
Brake system symbol with the warning
message STOP BRAKE FLUID INSTRUC-
TION MANUAL or STOP BRAKE FAULT IN-
STRUCTION MANUAL.
Coolant symbol with the warning mes-
sage STOP SEE COOLANT INSTRUCTION
MANUAL.
Engine oil pressure symbol with the
warning message STOP ENGINE OIL
PRESSURE LOW! INSTRUCTION MANUAL.
Warning messages, Priority 2 (yellow)
If one of these faults occurs, the correspond-
ing warning lamp lights up and is accompa-
nied by an audible warning. Check the corre-
sponding function as soon as possible al-
though the vehicle may be used without risk.
If several priority 2 warning messages are de-
tected at the same time, the symbols are dis-
played one after the other for about 2 sec-
onds at a time. After a set time, the informa-
tion text will disappear and the symbol will
be shown as a reminder at the side of the
display.
100
background
Instruments and warning/control lamps
Priority 2 w
arning messages will not be
sho
wn u
ntil all Priority 1 warning messages
have been dealt with!
Examples of priority 2 warning reports (yel-
low):*
Fuel warning light with the information text
PLEASE REFUEL.
WARNING
If the warning lamps and messages are ignor-
ed, the vehic
le may stall in traffic, or may
cause accidents and severe injuries.
Never ignore the warning lamps or text
messages.
Stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible.
Park the vehicle away from traffic and en-
sure that there are no highly flammable ma-
terials under the vehicle that could come into
contact with the exhaust system (e.g. dry
grass, fuel).
A faulty vehicle represents a risk of acci-
dent for the driver and for other road users. If
necessary, switch on the hazard warning
lamps and put out the warning triangle to ad-
vise other drivers.
Before opening the bonnet, switch off the
engine and allow it to cool.
In any vehicle, the engine compartment is a
hazardous area and could cause severe inju-
ries page 201.
CAUTION
Failure to heed the control lamps and text
mess
ages when they appear may result in
faults in the vehicle.
Engine management*
This warning lamp monitors the engine man-
agement sy
stem for petrol engines.
The warning lamp  (Electronic Power Con-
trol) lights up when the ignition is switched
on while system operation is being verified. It
should go out once the engine is started.
If there is a fault in the electronic engine
management system while you are driving,
this warning lamp will light up. Stop the vehi-
cle and seek technical assistance.
Engine pre-heating/fault system*
The warning lamp lights up to show that the
glo
w p
lug
s are preheating the diesel engine.
The control lamp lights up
If the control lamp lights up when the en-
gine is started it means that the glow plugs
are preheating. When the warning lamp goes
off, the engine should be started straight
away.
Control lamp flashes
If a fault develops in the engine management
system while you are driving, the glow plug
system lamp will flash . Take the vehicle to
a specialised workshop as soon as possible
and have the engine checked.
Accumulation of soot in the diesel en-
gine particulate filter*
If the control lamp lights
up
y
ou should
help the filter clean itself by driving in the ap-
propriate manner.
To do this, drive about 15 minutes in fourth
or fifth gear (automatic gearbox: S gear
range) at a minimum speed of 60 km/h
(37 mph), with the engine running at approxi-
mately 2,000 rpm. In this way, the soot build
up in the filter is burned. When cleaning is
successful, the control lamp turns off.
If the lamp does not turn off, or the three
lamps turn on (particulate filter , fault in
the emission control system and glow
plugs ), drive the vehicle to a specialised
workshop and have the fault repaired at the
earliest opportunity.
»
101
Technical dataAdviceOperationEmergenciesSafety
background
Operation
WARNING
Alwa
ys drive according to the road weather
conditions, the terrain and traffic. Driving rec-
ommendations should never lead to illegal
manoeuvres in surrounding traffic.
The diesel engine particulate filter may
reach extremely high temperatures; in this
case the vehicle should be parked so that it
does not enter into contact with highly flam-
mable materials underneath the vehicle. Oth-
erwise there is a risk of fire.
Engine oil pressure
If this warning lamp i
s
r
ed it indicates
that the engine oil pressure is too low.
If this warning symbol starts to flash, and is
accompanied by three audible warnings,
switch off the engine and check the oil level.
If necessary, add more oil
page 206.
If the warning lamp flashes although the oil
level is correct, stop driving. Do not even run
the engine at idle speed! Obtain technical as-
sistance.
Checking the oil level
If the warning lamp is yellow the engine
oil level should be checked as soon as possi-
ble. Top up the oil
page 206 at the next
opportunity.
Oil level sensor faulty*
If the yellow warning lamp flashes, take
the vehicle to a specialised workshop to have
the oil level sensor checked. Until then it is
advisable to check the oil level every time
you refuel.
Lamp fault*
The warning lamp lights up when there is
a fau
lt on the turn signals, headlights, side
lights and fog lights.
Windscreen washer fluid*
This warning lamp lights up to indicate that
the w
ind
s
creen washer level is very low.
This serves as a reminder to fill up the reser-
voir at the earliest opportunity
page 209.
Rear fog light*
The warning lamp lights
up when the r
e
ar
fog light is switched on. For further informa-
tion see
page 123.
Anti-lock brake system (ABS)*
The control lamp lights up for a f
ew sec-
onds when the ignition is switched on. It
goes out again after the system has run
through an automatic test sequence.
There is a fault in the ABS if:
The control lamp does not light up when
the ignition is switched on.
The control lamp does not go out again af-
ter a few seconds.
The control lamp lights up when the vehicle
is mo
ving.
The vehicle can still be braked in the normal
way, without the ABS function. Take the vehi-
cle to a specialised workshop as soon as
possible. For further information on the ABS
see the
page 171.
If there is a fault in the ABS, the ESC* and the
tyre pressure control lamp will also light up.
Brake system fault
If the ABS warning lamp lights up together
with the brake warning lamp , there is a
fault in the ABS function and in the brake
system
.
102
background
Instruments and warning/control lamps
WARNING
Befor
e opening the bonnet, read and ob-
serve the warnings page 201, Working in
the engine compartment.
If the brake system warning lamp should
light up together with the ABS warning lamp
, stop the vehicle immediately and check
the brake fluid level in the reservoir
page 208, Brake fluid. If the brake fluid
level has dropped below the “MIN” mark you
must not drive on. Risk of accident. Obtain
technical assistance.
If the brake fluid level is correct, the fault in
the brake system may have been caused by a
failure of the ABS system. This could cause
the rear wheels to lock quickly when you
brake. This could cause the rear to break
away. Risk of skidding. Stop the vehicle and
seek technical assistance.
Differential lock fault (EDS)*
The EDL operates along with the ABS in vehi-
c
l
e
s equipped with Electronic Stability Con-
trol (ESC)*.
A malfunction in the EDL is indicated by the
ABS control lamp . Take the vehicle to a
specialised workshop as soon as possible.
For further information on the EDL see
page 170, Electronic differential lock
(EDS)*.
Traction control system (ASR)* /
The traction control system prevents the driv-
en wheels fr
om spinning when the vehicle is
accelerating.
There are two control lamps for the traction
control system: and . Both control lamps
light up together when the ignition is switch-
ed on and should turn off after approximately
2 seconds. This is the time taken for the func-
tion check.
The lamp has the following function:
It flashes when the ASR is working if the ve-
hicle i
s moving.
If the system is deactivated or if it has any
fault, the warning lamp will remain lit. The
warning lamp will also light up if a fault
should occur in the ABS because the ASR op-
erates in conjunction with the ABS. For fur-
ther information, see
page 172.
The lamp provides information about the
disconnection status of the system:
It stays lit when the ASR is disconnected
via Easy Connect.
By means of Easy Connect, the ASR function
is reactivated and the warning lamp switched
off.
Electronic Stability Control (ESC)*
/
There are two control lamps for the electronic
stab
ility control. The lamp provides infor-
mation concerning function and disconnec-
tion status.
Both control lamps light up together when
the ignition is switched on and should turn
off after approximately 2 seconds. This is the
time taken for the function check.
This programme includes the ABS, EDL and
ASR. It also includes emergency braking as-
sistance (BAS).
The control lamp has the following func-
tions:
It flashes whilst driving when the ASR/ESC
is activ
ated.
It will light up if there is a fault in the ESC.
As the ESC operates in conjunction with the
ABS, the ESC light will also come on if a fault
should occur in the ABS.
If the ESC control lamp lights up and stays
on after the engine is started, this may mean
that the control system has temporarily
switched off the ESC. In this case the ESC can
be reactivated by switching the ignition off
and then on again. If the control lamp goes
out, this means the system is fully functional.
»
103
Technical dataAdviceOperationEmergenciesSafety
background
Operation
The l
amp provides information about the
di
s
connection status of the system:
It stays lit when the ASR is disconnected on
pressing the switch or if we select ESC
Sport mode, only by means of Easy Connect.
Brake system*
Situations in which the warning lamp lights
up
the brake fluid level is too low
page 208.
there is a fault in the brake system.
This warning lamp can light up together with
the ABS system warning lamp.
WARNING
If the brak
e warning lamp does not go out
or if it lights up when driving, the brake fluid
level in the reservoir is too low so there is a
risk of an accident page 208, Brake fluid.
Stop the vehicle and do not drive on. Obtain
technical assistance.
If the brake warning lamp lights up to-
gether with the ABS lamp this could be
due to an ABS fault. This could cause the rear
wheels to lock quickly when you brake. This
could cause the rear to break away. Risk of
skidding. Stop the vehicle and seek technical
assistance.
Cruise speed (cruise control system)*
The warning lamp comes
on when the
cruise control system is switched on. For fur-
ther information on the cruise control system
please see ››
page 34.
Tyre pressure
Fig. 124 Centre console: tyre monitoring sys-
t
em b
utt
on.
The tyre monitoring lamp* compares wheel
r
ev
o
lutions and with it, using the ESC, the
wheel diameter of each wheel. If the diame-
ter of a wheel changes, the tyre control lamp
lights up. The wheel diameter changes
when:
Tyre pressure is insufficient.
The tyre structure is damaged.
The vehicle is unbalanced because of a
load.
The wheels of one axle are under more
pressure (for example, driving with a trailer or
on steep slopes).
The vehicle is fitted with snow chains.
The temporary spare wheel is fitted.
The wheel on one axle is changed.
Tyre pressure adjustment
On adjusting tyre pressure or changing one
or more wheels, the Fig. 124 button must
be kept pressed down, with the ignition on,
until an acoustic signal is heard.
Store the new tyre pressure in the Easy Con-
nect system with the button

and the func-
tion b
utt
on
Set
up
p
age 24.
If the wheels are under excessive load (for ex-
ample, driving with a trailer or heavy load),
the tyre pressure must be increased to the
recommended value for a full load (see the
sticker on the inside of the fuel flap). If the
tyre monitor system button is pressed down,
the new tyre pressures are confirmed.
The tyre pressure control lamp lights up
If the tyre pressure of a wheel is much lower
than the value set by the driver, then the tyre
pressure control lamp
will light up.
104
background
Instruments and warning/control lamps
WARNING
When the tyre pr
essure control lamp lights
up, reduce speed immediately and avoid any
sudden turning or braking manoeuvre. Stop
when possible, and check the tyre pressure
and status.
The driver is responsible for maintaining
correct tyre pressures. For this reason, tyre
pressure must be regularly checked.
Under certain circumstances (e.g. when
driving in a sporty manner, in winter condi-
tions or on a dirt track) the tyre control lamp
may light up belatedly or may function incor-
rectly.
Note
If the battery is disconnected, the yellow
warning l
amp lights up after turning the
ignition on. This should turn off after a brief
journey.
Speed selector lever lock*
The brake pedal must be depressed when
thi
s
w
arning lamp lights up. This is necessary
when the automatic gearbox* selector lever
is moved out of the positions P or N.
Fuel Reserve/Level
It lights up when only 7 litres of fuel remain
in the tank, and an ac
oustic signal* also
sounds. It reminds you to fuel up the fuel
tank as soon as possible page 199.
Main beam headlights
The control lamp lights up when the main
be
ams are on or when the headlight flasher
is operated.
For further information see
page 125.
Electromechanical steering*
The control lamp should light up for a few
sec
ond
s
when the ignition is switched on. It
should go out once the engine is started.
For further information on steering see
page 152.
It lights up red
The electromechani-
cal steering is dam-
aged.
Have the steering checked im-
mediately by a specialised work-
shop.
It lights up yellow
Electromechanical
steering operation
is limited.
Have the steering checked im-
mediately by a specialised work-
shop.
If the yellow warning lamp does
not light up again after the en-
gine is restarted and the vehicle
has travelled a short distance,
you do not need to take it to a
specialised workshop.
The 12-volt battery
was disconnected
and has been recon-
nected.
Take the vehicle for a short run
at 15-20 km/h (9-12 mph).
It flashes yellow
The steering column
is tight.
Turn the wheel a little to both
sides.
The steering column
does not unlock or
lock.
Remove the key from the ignition
and switch the ignition back on.
If necessary, check the messag-
es displayed on the instrument
panel display.
Do not drive on if the steering
column remains locked after the
ignition has been switched on.
Seek specialist assistance.
WARNING
If the warning lamps and the corresponding
mess
ages are ignored when they light up, the
vehicle may stall in traffic and cause acci-
dents and severe injuries.
»
105
Technical dataAdviceOperationEmergenciesSafety
background
Operation
Never ignore the w
arning lamps or messag-
es.
Stop the vehicle at the next opportunity
and in a safe place.
Note
Failure to heed the control lamps and corre-
s
ponding t
ext messages when they light up
may result in damage to the vehicle.
Emission control system*
Control lamp fl
a
she
s:
When there is misfiring that can damage the
catalytic converter. Reduce speed and drive
carefully to the nearest specialised workshop
to have the engine checked.
The control lamp lights up:
If a fault has developed during driving which
has reduced the quality of the exhaust gas
(e.g. lambda probe fault). Reduce speed and
drive carefully to the nearest specialised
workshop to have the engine checked.
Coolant Level*/Temperature
There is a fault if:
The warning symbol does not go out again
af
t
er a f
ew seconds.
The control lamp lights up or flashes while
the vehicle is moving, and three acoustic
warning signals
are emitted.
Thi
s
me
ans that either the coolant level is too
low or the coolant temperature is too high.
Coolant temperature too high
If the control lamp comes on, stop the vehi-
cle, turn off the engine and wait for it to cool
down. Check the coolant level.
If the coolant level is correct, the overheating
may be caused by a malfunction of the radia-
tor fan. Check the radiator fan fuse and have
it replaced if necessary page 81.
If the control lamp lights up again after driv-
ing on for a short distance, stop the vehicle
and switch the engine off. Contact a Techni-
cal Service or a specialised workshop.
Coolant level too low
If the control lamp comes on , stop the vehi-
cle, turn off the engine and wait for it to cool
down. First check the coolant level. If the lev-
el of the coolant is below the “MIN” mark,
top up with coolant liquid
.
WARNING
If y
our vehicle is immobilised for technical
reasons, move it to a safe distance from traf-
fic. Turn the engine off, turn the hazard lights
on and place the warning triangle.
Never open the bonnet if
you can see or
hear steam or coolant escaping from the en-
gine compartment. Risk of scalding. Wait un-
til you can no longer see or hear escaping
steam or coolant.
The engine compartment is a dangerous
area. Before carrying out any work in the en-
gine compartment, switch off the engine and
allow it to cool down. Always note the corre-
sponding warnings ››page 201.
Alternator
This control lamp signals a fault in the alter-
n
at
or
.
The control lamp lights up when the igni-
tion is switched on. It should go out when the
engine has started running.
If the control lamp lights up while driving,
the alternator is no longer charging the bat-
tery. You should immediately drive to the
nearest specialised workshop.
You should avoid using electrical equipment
that is not absolutely necessary because this
will drain the battery.
Turn signals
Depending on which turn signal is operating,
either the l
ef
t
or right turn signal lamp
flashes. Both control lamps will flash at the
106
background
Introduction to the Easy Connect system*
same time when the hazard warning lights
ar
e sw
it
ched on.
If any of both turn signals fails, the warning
lamp will start flashing twice faster than nor-
mal.
For further information on the turn signals,
please see ›› page 125.
Electronic immobiliser “SAFE”*
This warning lamp flashes if an unauthorised
k
ey
i
s used.
Inside the key there is a chip that deactivates
the electronic immobiliser automatically
when the key is inserted into the ignition.
The electronic immobiliser will be activated
again automatically as soon as you pull the
key out of the ignition lock.
If the following message* is shown on the in-
strument panel display: SAFE, the vehicle
cannot be started.
The engine can, however, be started if the
appropriate coded SEAT genuine key is used.
Note
The vehicle cannot operate properly if you do
not hav
e a genuine SEAT key.
Introduction to the Easy
C
onnect
sy
stem*
System settings (CAR)*
CAR menu (Setup)
Read the additional information carefully
page 24
To select the settings menus, press the Easy
Connect

button and the
Set
up
function
b
utt
on.
The act
ual number of menus available and
the name of the various options in these me-
nus will depend on the vehicle’s electronics
and equipment.
Pressing the menu button will always take
you to the last menu used.
When the function button check box is activa-
ted , the function is active.
Pressing the menu button
will always take
y
ou t
o the l
ast menu used.
Any changes made using the settings menus
are automatically saved on closing those me-
nus.
Function buttons in the
vehicle’s settings
menu
Page
ESC system page 169
Tyres ››page 104
Driver assistance table on page 24
Parking and manoeuvring page 176
Vehicle lights table on page 24
Rear vision mirrors and wind-
screen wipers
table on page 24
Opening and closing table on page 24
Multifunction display table on page 24
Date and time table on page 24
Units ›› table on page 24
Service page 97
Factory settings table on page 24
WARNING
Any distraction may lead to an accident, with
the risk of
injury. Operating the Easy Connect
system while driving could distract you from
traffic.
107
Technical dataAdviceOperationEmergenciesSafety
background
Operation
Communications and multi-
medi
a
St
eerin
g wheel controls*
General information
The vehicle includes a multifunction module
from where it
is possible to control the audio,
telephone and radio/navigation functions
without needing to distract the driver.
There are two versions of the multifunction
module:
Audio version, to control the available au-
dio function
s from the steering wheel (Radio,
audio CD, MP3 CD, iPod
®1)
, USB
1)
).
Audio + telephone versions o control the
available audio functions from the steering
wheel (Radio, audio CD, MP3 CD, iPod
®1)
,
USB
1)
, SD
1)
) and the Bluetooth system.
1)
Depending on the vehicle equipment.
108
background
Communications and multimedia
Operating the audio system
Fig. 125 Controls on the steering wheel.
Button Radio Media (except AUX) AUX
A
Turn Up/down volume Up/down volume Up/down volume
A
Press No function No function No function
B
Mute Pause Mute
C
Search for last station
Short press: switch to the previous song
Hold down: quick rewind
No function
D
Search for the next station
Short press: switch to the next song
Hold down: fast forward
No function
E
Previous preset Previous folder No function
F
Next preset station Next folder No function
G
Change source Change source Change source
H
Turn Switch MFA function Switch MFA function Switch MFA function
H
Press Acts on the MFA Acts on the MFA Acts on the MFA
109
Technical dataAdviceOperationEmergenciesSafety
background
Operation
Operating the audio system + telephone
Fig. 126 Controls on the steering wheel.
Button Radio Media (except AUX) AUX Telephone
a)
Navigation
a)
A
Turn Up/down volume Up/down volume Up/down volume Up/down volume Up/down volume
A
Press Mute Pause Mute Mute Mute
B
Short press: access to the tele-
phone menu on the dash pan-
el
a)
.
Hold down: redial
a)
Short press: access to the tele-
phone menu on the dash pan-
el
a)
.
Hold down: redial
a)
Short press: access to the tele-
phone menu on the dash pan-
el
a)
.
Hold down: redial
a)
Short press: answer/hang up
calls, enable/open the tele-
phone menu.
Hold down: reject an incoming
call/switch to private/redial
mode
Short press: access to the tele-
phone menu on the dash pan-
el
a)
.
Hold down: redial
a)
C
Search for last station
Short press: switch to the pre-
vious song
Hold down: quick rewind
No function No function
b)
Radio/media functionality (ex-
cept AUX )
D
Search for the next station
Short press: switch to the next
song
Hold down: fast forward
No function No function
b)
Radio/media functionality (ex-
cept AUX )
E
Change menu on instrument
panel
Change menu on instrument
panel
Change menu on instrument
panel
Change menu on instrument
panel
Change menu on instrument
panel
110
background
Communications and multimedia
Button Radio Media (except AUX) AUX Telephone
a)
Navigation
a)
F
Change menu on instrument
panel
Change menu on instrument
panel
Change menu on instrument
panel
Change menu on instrument
panel
Change menu on instrument
panel
G
Enable/disable voice control
a)
Enable/disable voice control
a)
Enable/disable voice control
a)
No function
b)
Enable/disable voice control
H
Turn Next/previous preset station
c)
Next/previous song
c)
Acts upon the dash panel
menu depending on where it is
located
Acts upon the dash panel
menu depending on where it
is located
Acts upon the dash panel
menu depending on where it
is located
H
Press
Acts on the MFA or confirms
the menu option of the dash
panel depending on the menu
option
Acts on the MFA or confirms
the menu option of the dash
panel depending on the menu
option
Acts on the MFA or confirms
the menu option of the dash
panel depending on the menu
option
Acts on the MFA or confirms
the menu option of the dash
panel depending on the menu
option
Acts on the MFA or confirms
the menu option of the dash
panel depending on the menu
option
a)
According to the vehicle's equipment package.
b)
When a call is being made, radio/media functionality (except AUX).
c)
Only if the dash panel is in audio menu.
111
Technical dataAdviceOperationEmergenciesSafety
background
Operation
Multimedia
USB/A
UX
-IN inp
ut
Fig. 127 USB/AUX-IN input.
Depending on the features and the country,
the
v
ehic
le may have a USB/AUX-IN connec-
tion.
The USB/AUX-IN input is located above the
storage compartment in the front centre con-
sole Fig. 127.
The operating description is located in the re-
spective Instruction Manuals of the audio
system or the navigation system.
Opening and closing
C
entr
a
l locking system
Description
Read the additional information carefully
page 9.
The central locking system enables you to
lock and unlock all doors and the rear lid by
just pushing the button.
Central locking can be activated by using any
of the following options:
the key, by inserting it into the driver door
cylinder and rot
ating it in the opening direc-
tion. Depending on the vehicle version, ei-
ther all doors will be unlocked or only the
driver door will be unlocked. All doors will be
locked on locking the vehicle using the key.
the interior central lock button
page 115.
the radio frequency remote control, using
the buttons on the key
page 117.
Various functions are available to improve
the vehicle safety:
Locking system “Safe*”
Selective* unlocking system
Self-locking system to prevent involunta-
ry unlocking
Automatic speed dependent locking and
unlocking system*
Emergency unlocking system
Unlocking the vehicle*
Press button
Fig. 131
on r
emote
control to unlock all the doors and rear
lid.
Locking the vehicle*
Press button
Fig. 131
on the r
e-
mote control to lock all doors and the
rear lid or turn the key in the door to lock
all doors and the rear lid.
WARNING
Lock
ing from the outside carelessly or with-
out good visibility may lead to bruising, par-
ticularly in the case of children.
When locking a vehicle, never leave chil-
dren unaccompanied inside, as from the out-
side it will be difficult to provide assistance if
required.
Having the doors locked prevents intruders
from getting in, for example when stopped at
a traffic light.
Note
For anti-theft security, only the driver door is
fitted with a loc
k cylinder.
112
background
Opening and closing
“Safe” security system**
This is an anti-theft device which consists of
a double loc
k for the door locks and a deacti-
vation function for the boot in order to pre-
vent forced entry.
Activation
The “safe” system is activated when the vehi-
cle is locked using the key or the remote con-
trol.
To activate it with the key, rotate once it is in-
serted in the door lock cylinder in the locking
direction.
To activate the system using the remote con-
trol, press the lock button once
on the re-
mot
e.
Onc
e thi
s system is activated, opening doors
from the outside and the inside is not possi-
ble. The rear lid can not be opened. The cen-
tral lock button does not work.
When the ignition is switched off, the instru-
ment panel display indicates that the “Safe”
system is on.
Deactivation
Rotate the key inserted in the lock cylinder
twice towards the locking direction.
To activate the system using the remote con-
trol, press the lock button on the remote
twice
in less than five seconds.
On deactivating the “Safe” system, the alarm
v
o
lumetric
sensor is also deactivated.
With the “Safe” switched off, doors can be
opened from the interior but not from the ex-
terior.
See “Selective unlocking system*”
“Safe” status
On the driver door, there is warning lamp visi-
ble from outside the vehicle through the win-
dow which shows the “Safe” system status.
We will know that “Safe” system is activated
by the flashing warning lamp. The indicator
will flash on all vehicles, fitted and nor fitted
with an alarm, until they unlock.
Remember:
Safe activated with or without an alarm:
warning lamp flashes continuously.
Safe deactivated without an alarm: the warn-
ing lamp stays off.
Safe deactivated with an alarm: the warning
lamp stays off.
WARNING
No one should remain inside the vehicle if the
“Safe” sys
tem is activated because opening
the doors will not be possible in the event of
an emergency neither from the inside nor the
outside and help from the outside is made
difficult. Danger of death. Passengers could
become trap
ped inside in case of emergency.
Selective unlocking system*
This system allows to unlock either just the
driver door or all
the vehicle.
Driver door unlock button
Unlock once. Use either the key or the remote
control.
Once the key is inserted in the lock cylinder,
rotate once in the unlock direction. The driver
door will remain without “Safe” and un-
locked. In vehicles fitted with an alarm, see
the Anti-theft Alarm section page 118.
Using the remote control, press the unlock
button on the remote
once. The “Safe”
sy
s
t
em for all the vehicle is deactivated, only
the driver door is unlocked and both the
alarm and the warning lamp are also turned
off.
Unlocking all doors and the luggage com-
partment
The unlock button on the remote control
must be pressed twice
so that all doors
and the lug
g
ag
e compartment can be
opened.
Press twice within 5 seconds to deactivate
the “Safe” system for all vehicle, to unlock all
»
113
Technical dataAdviceOperationEmergenciesSafety
background
Operation
doors and to use the luggage compartment.
The w
arnin
g l
amp and the alarm (only vehi-
cles fitted with one) are turned off.
Unlocking the luggage compartment
See
page 9.
Activating the selective unlocking system*
With the door open, insert a key into the start
cylinder and start the ignition. Insert the oth-
er key into the driver door lock and turn in the
opening direction for at least 3 seconds. The
turn signals will flash twice.
Deactivating the selective unlocking system*
With the door open, insert a key into the start
cylinder and start the ignition. Insert the oth-
er key into the driver door lock and turn in the
locking direction for at least 3 seconds. The
turn signals will flash once.
Self-locking system to prevent invol-
untary unlocking
It is an anti-theft system and prevents the un-
int
ention
al
unlocking of the vehicle.
If the vehicle is unlocked and none of the
doors (including the boot) are opened within
30 seconds, it re-locks automatically.
Automatic speed-dependent locking
and unlocking system*
This is a safety system which prevents access
to the v
ehicle from the outside when it is run-
ning (e.g. when stopped at a traffic light).
Locking
The doors will lock automatically if the speed
of 15 km/h (9 mph) is exceeded. The rear lid
will lock automatically if the speed of 6 km/h
(4 mph) is exceeded.
If the vehicle is stopped and any of its doors
open, when starting again and exceeding the
mentioned speed, all doors will lock again.
Unlocking
On withdrawing the ignition key, the vehicle
will returns to its status prior to self-locking.
Each door can be unlocked and opened inde-
pendently from the inside (for example, when
a passenger gets out). To do it, simply oper-
ate the lever inside the door.
Activating the system*
With the ignition on, press the locking key on
the central locking system within 3 to 10 sec-
onds.
Deactivating the system*
With the ignition on, pre
ss the unlocking key
on the central locking system within 3 to 10
seconds.
In both cases, if the operation has been car-
ried out correctly, the locking lamp will flash
Fig. 128
.
WARNING
The door handles must not be operated when
the vehic
le is running: the door would open.
Note
If the airbags are triggered during an acci-
dent, the vehic
le is unlocked, except for the
luggage compartment. It is possible to lock
the vehicle from inside with the central lock-
ing, after turning the ignition off and back on
again.
114
background
Opening and closing
Central lock button*
Fig. 128 Central lock button.
Read the additional information carefully
page 9
The central lock button allows you to lock and
unlock the vehicle from the inside.
The central lock button also works with the
ignition switched off, except when the “safe”
system is activated.
Please note the following if you lock your ve-
hicle with the central lock button:
Locking the doors and rear lid prevents ac-
cess from the outside (for safety reasons, e.g.
when stopped at a traffic light).
The driver door cannot be locked while it is
open. This avoids the user from forgetting his
key inside the vehicle.
All doors can be unlocked separately from
inside the vehicle. Do this by pulling the door
release lever once.
WARNING
If the v
ehicle is locked, children and disa-
bled people may be trapped inside it.
Repeated operation of central locking will
prevent the central lock button from working
for a few seconds. Then, it can only be un-
locked in case it has been previously locked.
After few seconds, the central locking be-
comes operative again.
The central lock button is not operative
when the vehicle is locked from the outside
(with the remote control or the key).
Note
Vehicl
e locked,
button.
Vehicle unlocked,
button.
Childproof lock
3 Valid for vehicles: 5-door versions
Fig. 129 Childproof lock on the left hand side
door
.
The childproof lock prevents the rear doors
fr
om bein
g opened fr
om the inside. This sys-
tem prevents minors from opening a door ac-
cidentally while the vehicle is running.
This function is independent of the vehicle
electronic opening and locking systems. It
only affects rear doors. It can only be activa-
ted and deactivated manually, as described
below:
Activating the childproof lock
Unlock the vehicle and open the door in
which you wish to activate the childproof
lock.
With the door open, rotate the groove in
the door using the ignition key, anti-clock-
wise for the left-hand side doors Fig. 129
»
115
Technical dataAdviceOperationEmergenciesSafety
background
Operation
and clockwise for the right-hand side
door
s.
D
e
activating the childproof lock
Unlock the vehicle and open the door
whose childproof lock you want to deacti-
vate.
With the door open, rotate the groove in
the door using the ignition key, anti-clock-
wise for the right-hand side doors, and
clockwise for the left-hand side doors
Fig. 129.
Once the childproof lock is activated, the
door can only be opened from the outside.
The childproof lock can be activated or deac-
tivated by inserting the key in the groove
when the door is open, as described above.
Keys
Set of keys
Fig. 130 Set of keys.
The set of keys may consists of the following,
dependin
g on the
v
ersion of your vehicle:
a remote control key Fig. 130
A
a key without remote control
B
,
a plastic key tab*
C
.
or
two keys without remote control
B
a plastic key tab*
C
.
D
up
lic
ate keys
If you need a replacement key, go to a Techni-
cal Service with your vehicle identification
number.
WARNING
An incorrect
use of the keys can cause seri-
ous injuries.
Never leave children or disabled persons in
the vehicle. In case of emergency, they may
not be able to leave the vehicle or manage on
their own.
An uncontrolled use of the key could start
the engine or activate any electric equipment
(e.g. electric windows), causing risk of acci-
dent. The doors can be locked using the re-
mote control key. This could become an ob-
stacle for assistance in an emergency situa-
tion.
Never forget the keys inside the vehicle. An
unauthorised use of your vehicle could result
in injury, damage or theft. Always take the
key with you when you leave the vehicle.
Never remove the key from the ignition if
the vehicle is in motion. Otherwise, the steer-
ing could suddenly block and it would be im-
possible to steer the vehicle.
CAUTION
There are electronic components in the re-
mote contr
ol key. Avoid wetting and hitting
the keys.
116
background
Opening and closing
Radio frequency remote con-
tr
o
l*
Un
locking and locking the vehicle
Fig. 131 Assignment of buttons on the re-
mot
e c
ontr
ol key.
Fig. 132 Range of the radio frequency remote
c
ontr
o
l.
The radio frequency remote control key is
u
sed t
o loc
k and unlock the vehicle from a
distance.
By using button
4
Fig. 131
on the c
ontrol,
the key shaft is released.
Unlocking the vehicle
Fig. 131
1
.
L
oc
k
ing the vehicle
Fig. 131
2
.
Un
loc
k
ing the rear lid. Press button
Fig. 131
3
until all the turn signals on the
v
ehic
l
e flash briefly. When the unlocking but-
ton
3
is pressed, you have 2 minutes to
open the door
. Onc
e thi
s time has passed, it
will lock again.
Moreover, the battery indicator on the key
Fig. 131 (arrow), will flash.
The remote control transmitter and the bat-
teries are integrated in the key. The receiver
is inside the vehicle. The maximum range de-
pends on different factors. The range is re-
duced as the batteries start to lose power.
WARNING
Read and observe the relevant warnings ››
in Set of keys on page 116.
Note
The radio fr
equency remote control key
functions only when you are within range
Fig. 132.
If the v
ehicle cannot be unlocked or locked
by using the radio frequency remote control,
the remote control key will have to be re-
synchronised. For this, go to your technical
services.
Replacing the battery
If the battery indicator does not flash when
the button
s are pushed, the battery must be
replaced.
CAUTION
The use of inappropriate batteries may dam-
age the ra
dio frequency remote control. For
this reason, always replace the dead battery
with another of the same size and power.
For the sake of the environment
Used batteries must be disposed of at an ap-
propriat
e waste facility or through an author-
ised service, given that their components can
affect the environment.
Synchronising the remote control key
If it is not possible to unlock or lock the door
w
ith the r
emot
e control, it should be re-
synchronised.
»
117
Technical dataAdviceOperationEmergenciesSafety
background
Operation
While the vehicle is open:
Press the
button
2
Fig. 131
on the
r
emote control.
Then close the vehicle using the key shaft
within one minute.
While the vehicle is closed:
Press the
button
1
Fig. 131
on the
r
emote control.
Then close the vehicle using the key shaft
within one minute.
It is possible that the vehicle could no longer
be opened and closed with the remote con-
trol if the button
is repeatedly pressed
outs
ide of
the eff
ective range of the radio fre-
quency remote control. The remote control
key will have to be resynchronised.
Spare remote control keys are available at
your Technical Service, where they must be
matched to the locking system.
Up to five remote control keys can be used.
Anti-theft alarm*
Description of anti-theft alarm sys-
tem*
The anti-theft alarm makes it more difficult to
break
into the vehicle or steal it. The system
will initiate acoustic and optical warning sig-
nals when your vehicle is tried to be forced.
The anti-theft alarm system is automatically
switched on when locking the vehicle. The
system is immediately activated and the turn
signal light located on the driver door will
flash along with the turn signals, indicating
that the alarm and the locking security sys-
tem (double lock) have been turned on.
If any of the doors or the bonnet are open,
they will not be included in the protection
zones of the vehicle when the alarm is con-
nected. If the door or the bonnet are subse-
quently closed, they will be automatically in-
cluded in the protection areas of the vehicle
and the turn signals will flash accordingly
when the doors close.
The turn signal light will flash twice on
opening and deactiv
ating the alarm.
The turn signal light will flash once on clos-
ing and activating the alarm.
When does the system trigger an alarm?
The system triggers an alarm, if the following
unauthorised actions are carried out when
the vehicle is locked:
Mechanical opening of the vehicle with the
vehicle key without switching on the ignition
in the next 15 seconds (in certain markets,
such as the Netherlands, the alarm is activa-
ted immediately).
A door is opened.
Opening the bonnet.
The rear lid is opened.
Ignition switched on with a non-validated
key.
Movements in the driving compartment
(vehicles with a volume sensor).
Towing of the vehicle
1)
.
Vehicle tilt angle
1)
.
Undue manipulation of the alarm.
Battery handling.
In this case, the acoustic signals will go off
and the turn signal will flash for approximate-
ly 30 seconds. This cycle may be repeated up
to 10 times depending on the country.
1)
With vehicles fitted with a tow-away protection
118
background
Opening and closing
Opening all the doors in manual mode
In
v
ehic
les without an alarm, when opening
the driver door manually, all doors are
opened.
How to switch the alarm off
To deactivate the anti-theft alarm, turn the
key in the opening direction, open the door
and switch the ignition on, or press the un-
lock button
on the remote control.
In
v
ehic
les equipped with an anti-theft alarm
system, you have 15 seconds to insert the
key in the ignition lock and activate the igni-
tion if the vehicle is opened using the driver
door key.
Otherwise, the alarm will trigger for 30 sec.
and the ignition will be blocked.
Note
After 28 d
ays, the indicator light will be
switched off to prevent the battery from
draining if the vehicle has been left parked
for a long period of time. The alarm system
remains activated.
The alarm will trigger again if attempts are
made to open another protection zone.
The alarm system can be activated or deac-
tivated using the radio frequency remote con-
trol page 117.
The anti-theft alarm is not activated when
the vehicle is locked from within using the
central locking button
.
If the v
ehicle battery is run down or flat
then the anti-theft alarm will not operate cor-
rectly.
Vehicle monitoring remains active even if
the battery is disconnected or not working for
any reason.
The alarm is triggered immediately if one of
the battery cables is disconnected while the
alarm system is active.
Vehicle interior monitoring and anti-
tow sy
stem*
Monitoring or control function incorporated
in the anti-thef
t
al
arm* which detects unau-
thorised vehicle entry by means of ultra-
sound.
Activation
It is automatically switched on when the
anti-theft alarm is activated.
Deactivation
Open the vehicle with the key, either me-
chanically or by pressing the
button on
the r
emot
e c
ontrol. The time period from
when the door is opened until the key is in-
serted into the contact should not exceed
15 seconds, otherwise the alarm will be
triggered.
Press the button
on the remote control
tw
ic
e.
The volumetric sensor and tilt sen-
sors will be deactivated. The alarm system
remains activated.
The vehicle interior monitoring and the anti-
tow system are automatically switched on
again next time the vehicle is locked.
The vehicle interior monitoring and anti-tow
sensor (tilt sensor) are automatically switch-
ed on when the anti-theft alarm is switched
on. In order to activate it, all the doors and
the rear lid must be closed.
If you wish to switch off the vehicle interior
monitoring and the anti-tow system, it must
be done each time that the vehicle is locked;
if not, they will be automatically switched on.
The vehicle interior monitoring and the anti-
tow system should be switched off if animals
are left inside the locked vehicle (otherwise,
their movements will trigger the alarm) or
when, for example, the vehicle is transported
or has to be towed with only one axle on the
ground.
False alarms
Interior monitoring will only operate correctly
if the vehicle is completely closed. Please ob-
serve related legal requirements.
The following cases may cause a false alarm:
Open windows (partially or fully),
»
119
Technical dataAdviceOperationEmergenciesSafety
background
Operation
Ti
ltin
g p
anoramic sunroof open (partially or
completely),
Movement of objects inside the vehicle,
such as loose papers, items hanging from
the rear vision mirror (air fresheners), etc.
Note
If the v
ehicle is relocked and the alarm is
activated without the volumetric sensor func-
tion, relocking will activate the alarm with all
its functions, except the volumetric sensor.
This function is reactivated when the alarm is
switched on again, unless it is deliberately
switched off.
If the alarm has been triggered by the volu-
metric sensor, this will be indicated by a
flashing of the warning lamp on the driver
door when the vehicle is opened. The flash is
different to the flash indicating the alarm is
activated.
The vibration of a mobile phone left inside
the vehicle may cause the vehicle interior
monitoring alarm to trigger, as both sensors
react to movements and shakes inside the ve-
hicle.
If on activating the alarm, any door or the
rear lid is open, only the alarm will be activa-
ted. The vehicle interior monitoring and the
anti-tow system will only be activated once
all the doors are closed (including the rear
lid).
Boot hatch
Openin
g and c
lo
sing
Read the additional information carefully
page 9
WARNING
Alwa
ys close the rear lid properly. Risk of
accident or injury.
The rear lid must not be opened when the
reverse or rear fog lights are lit. This may
damage the tail lights.
Do not close the rear lid by pushing it down
with your hand on the rear window. The glass
could smash. Risk of injury!
Ensure the rear lid is locked after closing it.
If not, it may open unexpectedly while driv-
ing.
Never allow children to play in or around
the vehicle. A locked vehicle can be subjected
to extremely high and low temperatures, de-
pending on the time of year, thus causing se-
rious injuries/illness. It could even have fatal
consequences. Close and lock both the rear
lid and all the other doors when you are not
using the vehicle.
Closing the rear lid without observing and
ensuring it is clear could cause serious injury
to you and to third parties. Make sure that no
one is in the path of the rear lid.
Never drive w
ith the rear lid open or half-
closed, exhaust gases may enter into the in-
terior of the vehicle. Danger of poisoning!
If you only open the rear lid, do not leave
the key inside. The vehicle cannot be opened
if the key is left inside.
Electric windows
Opening and clo
sing of the electric
windows*
Fig. 133 Detail of the driver door: controls for
the fr
ont
and r
ear windows (5-door vehicles
with front and rear electric windows).
Read the additional information carefully
page 11
The front and rear electric windows can be
operated by using the controls on the driver
120
background
Opening and closing
door. The other doors each have a switch for
their o
wn w
indo
w.
Always close the windows fully if you park
the vehicle or leave it unattended
.
Y
ou c
an u
se the electric windows for approx.
10 minutes after switching off the ignition if
neither the driver door nor the front passen-
ger door has been opened and the key has
not been removed from the ignition.
Safety switch not pressed: buttons on rear
doors are activated.
Safety switch pressed: buttons on rear doors
are deactivated.
WARNING
Observe the safety warnings ››
in Set of
keys on p
age 116.
Incorrect use of the electric windows can
result in injury.
Never close the rear lid without observing
and ensuring it is clear, to do otherwise could
cause serious injury to you and third parties.
Make sure that no one is in the path of a win-
dow.
If the ignition is switched on, the electric
equipment could be activated with risk of in-
jury, for example, in the electric windows.
The doors can be locked using the remote
control key. This could become an obstacle
for assistance in an emergency situation.
Alwa
ys take the key with you when you
leave the vehicle.
The electric windows will work until the ig-
nition has been switched off and one of the
front doors has been opened.
If necessary, use the safety switch to disa-
ble the rear electric windows. Make sure that
they have been disabled.
Note
If the window is not able to close because it
i
s s
tiff or because of an obstruction, the win-
dow will automatically open again
page 121. If this happens, check why the
window could not be closed before attempt-
ing to close it again.
One-touch opening and closing*
One-touch opening and closing means you
do not
h
av
e to hold down the button.
Buttons Fig. 133
1
,
2
,
4
and
5
have
tw
o po
s
itions for opening windows and two
for closing them. This makes it easier to open
and close windows to the desired position.
One-touch closing
Pull up the window button briefly up to the
second position. The window closes fully.
One-touch opening
Push down the window button briefly up to
the second position. The window opens
fully.
Restoring one-touch opening and closing
The automatic open and close function will
not work if the battery has been temporari-
ly disconnected. The function can be re-
stored as follows:
Close the window as far as it will go by lift-
ing and holding the electric window switch.
Release the switch and then lift it again for
1 second. This will re-enable the automatic
function.
If you push (or pull) a button to the first
stage, the window will open (or close) until
you release the button. If you push or lift the
button briefly to the second stage, the win-
dow will open (one-touch opening) or close
(one-touch closing) automatically. If you op-
erate the button while the window is opening
or closing, it stops at this position.
Roll-back function
The roll-back function reduces the risk of in-
jur
y
when the el
ectric windows close.
»
121
Technical dataAdviceOperationEmergenciesSafety
background
Operation
If
a w
indo
w is obstructed when closing au-
tomatically, the window stops at this point
and lowers immediately ››
.
Next, check why the window does not close
bef
or
e att
empting it again.
If you try within the following 10 seconds
and the window closes again with difficulty
or there is an obstruction, the automatic clos-
ing will stop working for 10 seconds.
If the window is still obstructed, the win-
dow will stop at this point.
If there is no obvious reason why the win-
dow cannot be closed, try to close it again by
pulling the tab within ten seconds. The win-
dow closes with maximum force. The roll-
back function is now deactivated.
If more than 10 seconds pass, the window
will open fully when you operate one of the
buttons. One-touch closing is reactivated.
WARNING
Incorrect
use of the electric windows can
result in injury.
Always take the ignition key with you when
leaving the vehicle, even if you only intend to
be gone for a short time. Please ensure that
children are never left alone inside the vehi-
cle.
The electric windows will work until the ig-
nition has been switched off and one of the
front doors has been opened.
Clos
ing the windows without observing and
ensuring it is clear could cause serious injury
to you and third parties. Make sure that no
one is in the path of a window.
Never allow people to remain in the vehicle
when you close the vehicle from the outside.
The windows cannot be opened even in an
emergency.
The roll-back function does not prevent fin-
gers or other parts of the body getting
pinched against the window frame. Risk of
accident.
Convenience opening/closing*
Using the door lock*
Hold the key in the door lock of the driver
door in either the loc
k
in
g or the unlocking
position until all windows are either
opened or closed.
Release the key to interrupt this function.
Using the remote control
Keep the locking/unlocking button pressed
for the electric window risers to
open/close; if you stop pressing the but-
ton, the window raising/lowering function
is stopped.
If the automatic raising is stopped and im-
mediately after, the opening button is kept
pressed, the window risers will lower.
Once the windows are completely closed,
the turn signals will flash.
Tilting panoramic roof*
Opening or closing of the tilting pan-
oramic roof
Read the additional information carefully
page 11
The panoramic/tilting sunroof is opened and
closed by using the switch when the ignition
is switched on.
Always close the panoramic/tilting sunroof
fully if you park the vehicle or leave it unat-
tended
.
The ti
ltin
g s
unroof can be operated for up to
about ten minutes after the ignition has been
switched off, provided the driver door and
the front passenger door are not opened.
Sun visor
The sun visor is opened and closed manually
(independently of the panoramic/tilting sun-
roof).
WARNING
Incorrect
use of the tilting sunroof can re-
sult in injury.
122
background
Lights and visibility
Never clo
se the tilting sunroof without first
checking that there are no obstructions. Risk
of serious injury to you or others. Make sure
that no one is in the path of the tilting sun-
roof.
Always take the vehicle key with you when
you leave the vehicle.
Never leave children or disabled persons in
the vehicle, particularly if they have access to
the keys. Unsupervised use of a key could
mean that the engine is started or that elec-
trical equipment is used (e.g. electric tilting
sunroof) with a risk of accident. The doors
can be locked using the remote control key.
This could become an obstacle for assistance
in an emergency situation.
The tilting sunroof continues to function
until one of the front doors is opened and the
key removed from the ignition.
Ensure that no object and/or end is be-
tween the glass and the sunroof when the
one-touch opening/closing function is reset.
Convenience closing*
Using the door lock
Hold the key in the door lock of the driver
door in the loc
k
in
g position until the tilting
sunroof is closed.
Release the key to interrupt this function.
Using the remote control
Push the lock button on the remote control
for approximately 3 seconds. The tilting
sunroof closes.
Press the unlock button to interrupt the
function.
Roll-back function of the tilting panor-
amic sunroof*
The tilting panoramic sunroof has a r
o
l
l-back
function which prevents larger objects get-
ting trapped when the roof is closed. The roll-
back function does not prevent fingers get-
ting pinched against the roof opening. The
tilting sunroof stops and opens again imme-
diately if it is obstructed when closing.
Lights and visibility
Light
s
Sw
it
ching lights on and off
Read the additional information carefully
page 21
Switching on the front fog lights*
Turn the switch from position or to
the first stop and pull it. The symbol of
the light control lights up.
Switching on the rear fog light (vehicles with
front fog lights)
Turn the lights control from position or
to the second s
top and pull out
. A
c
ontr
o
l lamp on the instrument panel lights
up.
Switching on the rear fog light (vehicles with
no front fog lights)
Turn the light control to the end from posi-
tion or and pull it. A control lamp on
the instrument panel lights up.
WARNING
Never drive with just the side lights on, there
is a ri
sk of accident. The side lights are not
bright enough to illuminate the road ahead
»
123
Technical dataAdviceOperationEmergenciesSafety
background
Operation
and to ensure that other road users are able
to see y
ou. Always use your dipped beam
headlights if it is dark or if visibility is poor.
Note
The dip
ped beam he
adlights will only work
with the ignition on. The side lights come on
automatically when the ignition is turned off.
If the lights are left on after the key has
been taken out of the ignition lock, an audi-
ble warning sounds while the driver door re-
mains open. This is a reminder to switch the
lights off.
The rear fog light is so bright that it can
dazzle drivers behind you. You should use
the rear fog light only when visibility is very
poor.
The use of the lighting described here is
subject to the relevant statutory require-
ments.
Automatic lighting*
Activation
Rotate the switch to the
 po
s
ition, this
indication will light up.
Deactivation
Turn the light switch to .
Automatic lighting
If automatic headlight control is switched on,
dipped beam headlights are automatically
switched on by a photosensor if you drive in-
to a tunnel, for example.
WARNING
Even if
the automatic headlight control is
switched on, the dipped beam headlights will
not be switched on with fog. Therefore, the
dipped beam must be switched on manually.
Note
For those
vehicles with the automatic head-
light system, when the key is removed from
the ignition, the audible warning will only
sound if the light knob is in position or .
If the daylight driving automatic light func-
tion is switched on, the front fog lights or
rear fog light cannot be switched on in addi-
tion.
The use of the lighting described here is
subject to the relevant statutory require-
ments.
Do not put stickers on the windscreen in
front of the sensor. This may cause disrup-
tions or faults in the automatic lighting sys-
tem.
The rain sensor switches on the dipped
beam headlights when the windscreen wipers
have been operating continuously for a few
seconds and it switches the lights off when
the continuous or interval wipe is switched
off for some minut
es.
Daytime running lights
table on page 2
The daytime running lights are enabled auto-
matically when the ignition is switched on.
Daytime running lights are signalling devices
for improving road safety. The lights are built
into the headlights and come on each time
the ignition is turned on if the light switch is
in position 0 or . It is automatically
switched off when the dipped beam lights
are turned on.
WARNING
The side lights or daytime driving lights are
not bright enough t
o illuminate the road
ahead and to ensure that other road users are
able to see you.
Always use your dipped beam head lights if
it is raining or if visibility is poor.
The rear lights do not come on with the
daytime driving light. A vehicle which does
not have the rear lights on may not be visible
to other drivers in the darkness, if it is rain-
ing or in conditions of poor visibility.
124
background
Lights and visibility
Note
See legal requirements for each country.
Instrument and switch lighting, head-
light ran
ge control
Fig. 134 Dash panel: headlight range control
Instrument and switch lighting
The lightin
g l
ev
el of instruments, controls
and displays can be adjusted through the in-
fotainment system with the
CAR
button and
the
S
ETUP
function button
page 24.
The instrument lighting (some dials and nee-
dles), the centre console lighting and the
lighting of the displays are regulated by a
photodiode incorporated in the instrument
panel.
The instrument lighting (needles) is switched
on when the ignition is on and the light is
off. The instrument lighting is dimmed auto-
matically as the daylight starts to fade. It
goes out completely when ambient light is
very low. This function is intended to remind
the driver to switch on the dipped beam
headlights in good time when light condi-
tions become poor.
Headlight range control
By using the electrical headlight range con-
trol you can adjust the headlight range to the
load level that is being carried in the vehicle
Fig. 134. This way, it is possible to avoid
dazzling oncoming traffic more than necessa-
ry. At the same time, by using the correct
headlight settings, the driver has the best
possible lighting for the road ahead.
The headlights can only be adjusted when
the dipped beam is switched on. Turn the
wheel downwards to lower the headlight
beam from the basic setting 0.
Dynamic headlight range control
Vehicles with gas discharge bulbs (xenon
bulbs) are equipped with dynamic headlight
range control. When you switch on the lights,
their range regulates itself according to the
vehicle load.
Vehicles with gas discharge bulbs do not
have headlight range control.
Turn signal and main beam lever
Read the additional information carefully
page 22
Parking lights
Switch the ignition off and remove the key
from the lock.
Move the turn signal lever up or down to
turn the right or left-hand parking lights on,
respectively.
Convenience turn signals
For the convenience turn signals, move the
lever as far as possible upwards or down-
wards and release the lever. The turn signal
will flash three times.
The convenience turn signals are activated
and deactivated in the Easy Connect system
via the

key and the
Set
up
function button
page 107.
In vehicles that do not have the correspond-
ing menu, this function can be deactivated in
a specialised workshop.
WARNING
The main beam can dazzle other drivers. Risk
of acc
ident! Never use the main beam head-
lights or the headlight flasher if they could
dazzle other drivers.
»
125
Technical dataAdviceOperationEmergenciesSafety
background
Operation
Note
If the con
venience turn signals are operat-
ing (three flashes) and the other convenience
turn signals are switched on, the active part
stops flashing and only flashes once in the
new part selected.
The turn signals only work when the igni-
tion is switched on. The corresponding warn-
ing lamp or flashes in the instrument
panel. The control lamp flashes when the
turn signals are operated, provided a trailer is
correctly attached and connected to the vehi-
cle. If a turn signal bulb is defective, the con-
trol lamp flashes at double speed. If the trail-
er turn signal bulbs are defective, the control
lamp does not light up. Change the bulb.
The main beam headlights can only be
switched on if the dipped beam headlights
are already on. The warning lamp then
comes on in the instrument panel.
The headlight flasher comes on for as long
as you pull the lever – even if no other lights
are switched on. The warning lamp then
comes on in the instrument panel.
When the parking lights are switched on,
the headlight and the tail light on the corre-
sponding side of the vehicle light up. The
parking lights will only work if the key is re-
moved from the ignition. If said light is on, an
audible warning will be emitted while the
driver door is open.
If the turn signal lever is left on after the
key has been taken out of the ignition lock,
an acoustic signal sounds when the driver
door is opened. This is intended as a remind-
er to swit
ch off the turn signal, unless you
wish to leave the parking light on.
Coming Home/Leaving Home Func-
tion*
The Coming Home function is controlled man-
ually.
The Leaving Home function is control-
led with a photosensor.
If the Coming Home or Leaving Home func-
tion is connected, the front side and dipped
lights, the tail lights and the number plate
light will light up to provide assistance.
Coming home function
The Coming Home function is activated by
switching off the ignition and briefly flashing
the lights. When the driver door is opened,
the Coming Home lighting comes on. If the
driver door is already open when the lights
are flashed briefly, the Coming Home lighting
comes on immediately.
When the last door of the vehicle or the rear
lid is closed, the Coming Home function
starts and the switching off the headlights is
delayed.
The Coming Home lighting switches off in the
following cases:
On compl
etion of the time period establish-
ed for the delay in switching off the lights af-
ter all the vehicle doors and the rear lid have
been closed.
If, 30 seconds after being connected, any
doors or the rear lid remain open.
If the light switch is turned to position .
If the ignition is switched on.
Automatic Leaving Home function
The Leaving Home function is activated when
the vehicle is unlocked if:
the light control is in position  and
the photosensor detects “darkness”.
The Leaving Home lighting switches off in the
following cases:
If the time period for the delay in switching
off the headlights has ended
If the vehicle is locked again.
If the light switch is turned to position .
If the ignition is switched on.
Manual Leaving Home function
In vehicles without an automatic headlight
system (light sensor), if the manual Coming
Home function is activated when leaving the
car, upon returning to the car and unlocking
it the manual Leaving Home function will be
activated automatically.
126
background
Lights and visibility
Note
To activat
e the Coming/Leaving home func-
tion, the rotary light switch must be in posi-
tion  and the light sensor must detect
darkness.
If the ignition key is removed while the
lights are on, the lights flash briefly and the
driver door opens, no audible warning is
heard, since with the Coming Home function
on, the lights are automatically switched off
after a period of time (except when the light
switch is in position or .
Adaptive headlights* (for driving
r
ou
nd bend
s)
Fig. 135 Cornering lighting using adaptive
he
a
dlights.
When driving around bends, the headlights
w
i
l
l light the most important areas of the
road.
This cornering light gives better illumination
of the side of the road and the corner area.
The dynamic lighting is controlled automati-
cally according to speed and the steering
wheel angle.
The two main headlights move at different
angles to avoid that the front of the vehicle is
left completely in the dark.
Note
The system operates from a speed of about
10 km/h (6 mph).
Fog lights with cornering function*
This is an additional light source to dipped
be
am he
a
dlights to light up the road as a
bend is taken.
The cornering light operates with the lights
switched on and when driving at less than
40 Km/h (25 mph). Ignition occurs by turning
the steering or connecting the turn signal.
Forward gear
If the steering wheel is turned to the right,
or the right-hand turn signal operated, the
right-hand fog light turns on.
If the steering wheel is turned to the left, or
the left-hand turn signal operated, the left-
hand fog light turns on.
In reverse, both fog lights turn on.
Note
When the fog lamps are on, the cornering
function i
s activated and both headlights are
continuously on.
Hazard warning lights
Read the additional information carefully
page 22
The hazard warning lights are used to draw
the attention of other road users to your vehi-
cle in emergencies.
If your vehicle breaks down:
1. Park your vehicle at a safe distance from
movin
g traffic.
2. Press the button to switch on the hazard
warning lights
.
3. Switch the ignition off.
4. Apply the handbrake.
5. For a manual gearbox, engage 1st gear;
f
or an aut
om
atic gearbox, move the gear
lever to P.
6. Use the warning triangle to draw the atten-
tion of other road users to your vehicle.
7. Always take the vehicle key with you when
you leave the vehicle.
»
127
Technical dataAdviceOperationEmergenciesSafety
background
Operation
All turn signals flash simultaneously when
the h
az
ar
d warning lights are switched on.
The two turn signal turn signal lamps
and the turn signal lamp in the switch will
flash at the same time. The hazard warning
lights also work when the ignition is switch-
ed off.
WARNING
The risk of
an accident increases if your ve-
hicle breaks down. Always use the hazard
warning lights and a warning triangle to draw
the attention of other road users to your sta-
tionary vehicle.
Due to the high temperatures that the cata-
lytic converter can reach, never park in an
area where the catalytic converter could come
into contact with highly inflammable materi-
als, for example dry grass or spilt petrol. This
could start a fire.
Note
The batter
y will run down if the hazard
warning lights are left on for a long time,
even if the ignition is switched off.
The use of the hazard warning lights de-
scribed here is subject to the relevant statu-
tory requirements.
Interior lights
Int
erior and r
e
ading lights
Read the additional information carefully
page 22
Luggage compartment lighting
The light is activated when the rear lid is
open, even when the ignition and lights are
turned off. For this reason, ensure that the
rear lid is always closed.
Glove compartment light
When opening the glove compartment on the
passenger side, the glove compartment light
will automatically turn on and will turn off
upon closure.
Ambient light*
table on page 2
The ambient lighting lights up the central
console area and the footwell area.
They will switch on fully when the doors are
opened and will decrease in intensity while
driving when the dipped beam headlight is
on.
The intensity of the ambient light* can be ad-
justed using the Easy Connect menu (see
Adjusting Lights > Interior light-
ing
page 24).
Note
If not all the vehicle doors are closed, the in-
terior lights
will be switched off after approx.
10 minutes, providing the ignition key has
been removed and the courtesy light position
selected. This prevents the battery from dis-
charging.
Visibility
Heated r
ear window
Fig. 136 Centre console: heated rear window
sw
it
c
h.
The heated rear window only works when the
en
gine i
s
running. When it is switched on, a
lamp lights up on the switch.
After approximately 8 minutes, the heating
device of the rear window switches off auto-
matically.
128
background
Lights and visibility
For the sake of the environment
The heated rear window should be switched
off as
soon as the glass is demisted. By sav-
ing electrical power you can also save fuel.
Note
To avoid possible damage to the battery, an
automatic
temporary disconnection of this
function is possible, coming back on when
normal operating conditions are re-establish-
ed.
Sun visors
Fig. 137 Sun visor on the driver side.
The sun visors for the driver and the front
p
a
s
senger can be pulled out of their central
supports and turned towards the doors in the
direction of the arrow Fig. 137. Never pull
them downwards.
The driver sun visor has compartments for
cards, and the passenger sun visor has a
vanity mirror with a cover*.
Note
Incorrect use of the sun visor (e.g. pulling
them downw
ards once they are open) may re-
sult in broken hinges. This damage is not cov-
ered by the vehicle warranty.
Windscreen wiper and rear win-
dow wiper sy
stems
Windscreen wipers
Read the additional information carefully
page 23
WARNING
Worn and dirty
wiper blades reduce visibili-
ty and safety levels while driving.
In cold conditions you should not use the
wash/wipe system unless you have warmed
the windscreen with the heating and ventila-
tion system. The windscreen washer fluid
could otherwise freeze on the windscreen and
obscure your view of the road.
Always note the corresponding warnings
page 54.
WARNING
The rain sensor* may not detect enough rain
to swit
ch on the wipers.
If necessary, switch on the wipers manually
when water on the windscreen obstructs visi-
bility.
CAUTION
In icy conditions, always check that the wiper
bla
des are not frozen to the glass before us-
ing the wipers for the first time. If you switch
on the windscreen wipers when the wiper
blades are frozen to the windscreen, you
could damage both the wiper blades and the
wiper motor.
Note
The winds
creen wipers will only work when
the ignition is switched on.
The heat output of the heated jets* is con-
trolled automatically when the ignition is
switched on, depending upon the outside
temperature.
In certain versions of vehicles with alarms,
the windscreen wiper will only work in inter-
val/rain sensor mode when the ignition is on
and the bonnet closed.
When the interval wipe function is on, the
intervals are directly proportional to the
speed. This way, the higher the vehicle speed
the shorter the intervals.
»
129
Technical dataAdviceOperationEmergenciesSafety
background
Operation
If y
ou stop the vehicle with the windscreen
wiper in position 1 or 2, it will automatically
change to a lower position speed. The set
speed will be resumed when the vehicle pulls
away.
The windscreen will be wiped again after
approximately five seconds once the “auto-
matic wash/wipe system” has been activa-
ted, provided the vehicle is moving (drip func-
tion). If you activate the wipers less than 3
seconds after the drip function, a new wash
sequence will begin without performing the
last wipe. For the “drip” function to work
again, you have to turn the ignition off and
then on again.
Do not put stickers on the windscreen in
front of the rain sensor*. This may cause sen-
sor disruption or faults.
Rear window wiper
Fig. 138 Windscreen wiper lever: rear window
w
iper
.
Switching on the interval wipe
Press the lever forward to position
6
Fig. 138.
The w
iper w
ill wipe the window
approximately every 6 seconds.
Switching off the interval wipe function
Pull the lever back from position
6
toward
the s
t
eerin
g wheel. The wiper will continue
to function for a short period if you switch
off whilst the wipers are in motion.
Switching on the window wiper and washer
system
Press the lever fully forwards to position
7
Fig. 138 . The wiper and w
asher operate
at the same time. The rear window wash
system will function as long as you hold the
lever in this position.
Release the lever. The washer system stops
and the wipers
continue until the end of
the cycle.
Move the lever towards the steering wheel
to switch off.
WARNING
Worn and dirty
wiper blades reduce visibili-
ty and safety levels while driving.
Always note the corresponding warnings
page 54.
CAUTION
In icy conditions, always check that the wiper
bla
de is not frozen to the glass before using
the wiper for the first time. If you switch on
the wiper when the wiper blade is frozen to
the glass, this could damage both the wiper
blade and the wiper motor.
Note
The rear w
indow wiper will only work when
the ignition is switched on.
Depending on the version of the model,
when you engage reverse gear and with the
headlight wiper activated, this can start a
wipe.
Headlight washer*
The headlight washers clean the headlight
l
en
se
s.
The headlight washers are activated auto-
matically when the windscreen washer is
used and the window wiper lever is pulled to-
wards the steering wheel for at least 1.5 sec-
onds – provided the dipped beam headlights
or main beams are switched on. Clean off
stubborn dirt (insects, etc.) from the head-
lights at regular intervals, for instance when
filling the fuel tank.
130
background
Lights and visibility
Note
To ens
ure that the headlight washers work
properly in winter, keep the nozzle holders in
the bumper free of snow and remove any ice
with a de-icer spray.
To remove water, the windscreen wipers
will be activated from time to time, the head-
light washers will be activated every three cy-
cles.
Rear view mirrors
Int
erior mirr
or
It is dangerous to drive if you cannot see
c
l
e
arly through the rear window.
Interior mirror with automatic anti-dazzle
function*
The anti-dazzle function is activated every
time the ignition is switched on.
When the anti-dazzle function is enabled, the
interior rear vision mirror will darken auto-
matically according to the amount of light it
receives. The anti-dazzle function is cancel-
led if reverse gear is engaged.
Note
The automatic
anti-dazzle function will only
work properly if the sun blind* for the rear
window is retracted and there are no other
obj
ects preventing light from reaching the in-
terior rear vision mirror.
If you have to stick any type of sticker on
the windscreen, do not do so in front of the
sensors. Doing so could prevent the anti-daz-
zle function from working well or even from
working at all.
Folding in the exterior mirrors man-
ually
The exterior mirrors of the vehicle may be fol-
ded in. F
or thi
s, pr
ess the mirror housing to-
wards the vehicle.
Note
Before washing the vehicle with an automatic
car wa
sh, fold in the exterior mirrors to avoid
damage.
Electric exterior mirrors*
Fig. 139 Exterior mirror controls.
Read the additional information carefully
page 13
The exterior mirrors can be adjusted using
the rotary knob in the driver door.
Basic setting of exterior mirrors
1. Turn knob Fig. 139 to position L (left ex-
terior mirror).
2. Turn the rotary knob to position the exteri-
or mirror so that you have a good view to
the rear of the vehicle.
3. Turn the knob to position R (right exterior
mirror).
4. Swivel the rotary knob to position the ex-
terior mirror so that you have a good view
to the rear of the vehicle
.
»
131
Technical dataAdviceOperationEmergenciesSafety
background
Operation
Heated exterior mirrors*
Press the demisting button
Fig. 136
The mirrors demist for some minutes to
prevent draining the battery unnecessarily.
If necessary, press the button again to re-
peat the function.
The exterior mirror heating is not activated
in temperatures above approximately
+20°C (+68°F).
Folding in the exterior mirrors electrically*
Turn the control Fig. 139 to position to
fold in the exterior mirrors. You should al-
ways fold in the exterior mirrors if you are
driving through an automatic car wash.
This will help prevent damage.
Folding exterior mirrors back out to the ex-
tended position*
Turn the knob to position L or R to return
the exterior mirrors to their original posi-
tion
.
WARNING
Conv
ex or aspheric mirrors increase the
field of vision however the objects appear
smaller and further away in the mirrors. If you
use these mirrors to estimate the distance to
vehicles behind you when changing lane, you
could make a mistake. Risk of accident.
If pos
sible, use the rear vision mirror to es-
timate distances to vehicles behind you.
Make sure that you do not get your finger
trapped between the mirror and the mirror
base when folding back the mirrors. Risk of
injury!
For the sake of the environment
The exterior mirror heating should be switch-
ed off
when it i
s no longer needed. Other-
wise, it is an unnecessary fuel waste.
Note
If the electric
al adjustment ever fails to op-
erate, the mirrors can be adjusted by hand by
lightly pressing the edge of the mirror glass.
In vehicles with electric exterior mirrors,
the following points should be observed: if,
due to an external force (e.g. being knocked
while manoeuvring), the adjustment of the
mirror housing is altered, the mirror will have
to be fully folded electrically. Do not readjust
the rear vision mirror housing by hand, as
this will interfere with the mirror adjuster
function.
The rear vision mirrors can be adjusted sep-
arately or simultaneously, as described
above.
The fold-in function on the exterior mirrors
will not activate at speeds over 40 km/h
(25 mph).
Seats and head restraints
Adju
s
tin
g the seat and head re-
straints
Adjusting the front seats
Read the additional information carefully
page 12
WARNING
The safe driving chapter contains important
information, tip
s, suggestions and warnings
that you should read and observe for your
own safety and the safety of your passengers
page 56.
WARNING
Never adju
st the driver or front passenger
seat while the vehicle is in motion. While ad-
justing your seat, you will assume an incor-
rect sitting position. Risk of accidents. Adjust
the driver or front passenger seat only when
the vehicle is stationary.
To reduce the risk of injury to the driver and
front passenger in case of a sudden braking
or an accident, never drive with the backrest
tilted towards the rear. The maximum protec-
tion of the seat belt can be achieved only
when the backrests are in an upright position
and the driver and front passenger have prop-
erly adjusted their seat belts. The further the
132
background
Seats and head restraints
backrests are tilted to the rear, the greater
the risk of
injury due to improper positioning
of the belt web!
Exercise caution when securing the seat
height into forwards/backwards position. In-
juries can be caused if the seat height is ad-
justed without due care and attention.
To move the seat forwards and backwards,
pull upwards and not sideways on the lever,
as the force exerted on it in that direction
could damage it.
Folding and lifting the backrest of the
fr
ont
se
ats
3 Applies to vehicles with 3 doors:
Fig. 140 Front seats: lever for folding down
the b
ac
k
rest.
Read the additional information carefully
page 12
Vehicles without the Easy-Entry function
To fold the backrest, pull the lever
1
up-
w
ar
d
s and push the backrest forwards.
To unfold the backrest, push it back.
Vehicles with the Easy-Entry function
To fold the backrest, pull the lever
1
up-
w
ar
d
s and push the backrest forwards. You
can push the seat forwards at the same
time to make entry to the rear seats easier.
To unfold the backrest, first move the seat
completely back.
The Easy-Entry function facilitates the access
to the vehicle rear seats. Before lifting the
backrest, return the seat to the original posi-
tion. The seat inserts when the backrest is lif-
ted.
Adjusting or disassembling the head
restraints
Fig. 141 Adjusting and removing the head re-
s
tr
aints.
Read the additional information carefully
page 12
Adjusting height (front seats)
Press the button on the side and pull up-
wards to the desired position.
To lower the head restraint, press the but-
ton and push head restraint downwards.
Make sure that it engages securely into one
of its positions.
Adjusting height (rear seats)
Press the button on the side and pull up-
wards to the desired position.
To lower the head restraint, press the but-
ton and push head restraint downwards.
»
133
Technical dataAdviceOperationEmergenciesSafety
background
Operation
M
ak
e s
ure that the head restraint engages
securely in one of its positions page 60.
Removing the head restraint
Push the head restraint up as far as it will
go.
Press the button ›› Fig. 141 (arrow).
Pull head restraint out of fitting without re-
leasing the button.
Fitting the head restraint
Insert the head restraint into the guides on
the corresponding backrest.
Push head restraint down.
Adjust the head restraint to suit body size
page 60.
WARNING
Never drive if
the head restraints have been
removed. Risk of injury.
Never drive if the head restraints are in an
unsuitable position (the lowest position) as
there is a risk of serious injury.
After refitting the head restraint, you must
always adjust it properly for height to achieve
optimal protection.
Please observe the safety warnings in ››
in Correct adjustment of front head restraints
on page 60
.
Note
To fit and r
emove the rear head restraints,
gently tilt the seat backrest forwards.
When fitting the head restraints again, in-
sert the tubes as far as possible into the
guides without pressing the button.
Seat functions
Heated se
ats*
Fig. 142 Front seat heating switch.
The front seat cushions and backrests can be
he
at
ed el
ectrically.
Press the corresponding switch Fig. 142
to switch on the seat heating.
Press once to connect the heating at maxi-
mum force. The two LEDs illuminate
Fig. 142. After 15 minutes of high inten-
sity, the upper LED goes out, the system is
deactivated for 2 minutes and is then reac-
tivated at low intensity (the lower LED re-
mains on permanently).
Press the switch again to set the heating to
minimum force. (The lower LED lights up).
To disconnect the heating, press the switch
again.
CAUTION
To avoid damaging the heating elements,
ple
ase do not kneel on the seat or apply
sharp pressure at a single point to the seat
cushion and backrest.
Note
The seats are only heated electrically when
the engine is
running.
134
background
Seats and head restraints
Folding down the back seat
Fig. 143 Folding up the rear seat cushion.
Fig. 144 Button for unlocking the rear back-
r
e
s
t.
Folding seat down
Remove the head restraint
page 133.
Pull the front edge of the seat cushion
Fig. 143
1
upwards in the direction of
the arr
o
w
.
Lift the cushion
2
forwards in the direc-
tion of
the arr
o
w.
Pull the release button Fig. 144 in the di-
rection of the arrow and fold the backrest
forwards.
Insert the head restraints in the spaces on
the rear of the seat cushion which are visi-
ble when the seat cushion is lowered.
Folding seat forward
Remove the head restraints from the
spaces in the seat cushion.
Lift the backrest, and before securing it, re-
place the head restraints in the seat cush-
ion, and then click the seat correctly onto
the locking rails.
Once the backrest is locked, pull on the
central seat belt or directly on the backrest
to check that the backrest has properly en-
gaged in position.
Check that the position lever is in neutral
position.
Lower the cushion and push it backwards
below the seat belt buckles.
Press the front part of the cushion down-
wards.
On split rear seats*, the backrest and cush-
ion can be lowered and raised respectively in
two sections.
WARNING
Plea
se be careful when folding back the
backrest! Injuries can be caused if the seat
height is adjusted without due care and at-
tention.
Do no trap or damage seat belts when rais-
ing the backrest.
After raising the backrest, check it has en-
gaged properly in position. Do this by pulling
on the central seat belt or directly on the
backrest and check that the position lever is
in the neutral position.
The three point automatic seat belt only
works correctly when the backrest of the cen-
tral seat is correctly engaged.
135
Technical dataAdviceOperationEmergenciesSafety
background
Operation
Transport and practical
equipment
Pr
actic
a
l equipment
Glove compartment
Fig. 145 Passenger side: glove compartment.
Fig. 146 Glove compartment: storage com-
p
ar
tment
for instruction manual.
The compartment can be opened by pulling
the l
ev
er
Fig. 145.
This compartment can hold documents in A4
format, a water bottle of 1.5 L, etc.
Depending on the vehicle equipment, the CD
player is located in the glove compartment.
Separate operating instructions are enclosed
for this equipment in the corresponding In-
struction Manual.
WARNING
Always keep the storage compartment cover
closed whi
le the vehicle is in motion in order
to reduce the risk of injury caused by a sud-
den braking or by an accident.
Storage compartment on the driver
s
ide
Fig. 147 Compartment on the driver side
There is a storage compartment on the driver
s
ide
St
or
age compartment under the front
seats*
Fig. 148 Storage compartment under the
right
fr
ont
passenger seat.
To open
The compartment is opened by pulling on
the l
ev
er and a
ssisting it with your hand.
To close
Press the cover inwards until the closed
drawer “clicks” into position.
Note
The storage drawer will hold a maximum
weight of
1.5 kg.
136
background
Transport and practical equipment
Storage pocket in the seat*
Fig. 149 Storage pocket.
There is a storage pocket on the rear of the
fr
ont
se
ats.
Storage compartment in front door
panel*
In this storage compartment a 1.5l water bot-
tl
e, et
c
. can be stored.
Front drink holder*
Fig. 150 Front drink holders in the centre con-
so
l
e.
In the central console, in front of the gear lev-
er
, ther
e ar
e two drinks holders ›› Fig. 150.
WARNING
Do not put
hot drinks in the drink holders.
During sudden or normal driving manoeuvres,
when braking suddenly or in case of an acci-
dent, the hot drink could spill. Risk of scald-
ing.
Never use rigid materials (for example,
glass or ceramic), since they could cause in-
jury in the case of an accident.
When travelling, the drinks holder should
always be closed to prevent risk in the event
of sudden breaking or accident.
Rear drink holder*
Fig. 151 Drinks holder in the centre console.
On the rear part of the centre console, behind
the h
andbr
ak
e, there is a drink holder* in-
stalled ›› Fig. 151.
This drinks holder has a capacity for a bottle
of up to 1 litre.
137
Technical dataAdviceOperationEmergenciesSafety
background
Operation
Front ashtray*
Fig. 152 Front ashtray.
Opening and closing the ashtray
To open the ashtray, lift the cover
Fig. 152.
To close, push the cover down.
Emptying the ashtray
Extract the ashtray and empty it.
WARNING
Never put paper in the ashtray. Hot ash could
ignite the paper in the a
shtray and cause a
fire.
Cigarette lighter*
Fig. 153 Lighter.
Press on the cigarette lighter
Fig. 153 to
activate it
.
Wait for the lighter to spring out.
Pull out the cigarette lighter and light the
c
ig
ar
ette on the glowing coil.
WARNING
Improper use of
the cigarette lighter can
lead to serious injuries or start a fire.
Using the lighter carefully. Carelessness or
negligence when using the cigarette lighter
can cause burns and serious injuries.
The lighter only works when the ignition is
turned on or the engine is running. To avoid
the risk of fire, never leave children alone in-
side the vehicle.
Electrical power socket
Fig. 154 Front power socket.
The 12 Volt cigarette lighter power socket can
al
so be u
sed f
or other electrical components
with a power rating of up to 120 Watt. When
the engine is switched off, however, the vehi-
cle battery will discharge. For further informa-
tion see page 190.
WARNING
The power sockets and the connected acces-
sories w
ill only operate when the ignition is
on or when the engine is running. Improper
use of the sockets or electrical accessories
can lead to serious injuries or cause a fire. To
avoid the risk of injury, never leave children
alone inside the vehicle.
138
background
Transport and practical equipment
Note
The use of el
ectrical appliances with the
engine switched off will cause a battery dis-
charge.
Before using any electrical accessories, see
the instructions in page 190.
Power socket in the luggage compart-
ment*
3 Applies to the model: IBIZA ST
Fig. 155 Detailed view of the side trim in the
lug
g
ag
e compartment: 12 volt socket
Lift the power socket cover
Fig. 155.
Insert the plug of the electrical appliance
into the power socket.
Electrical equipment can be connected to any
of the 12 volt sockets. The appliances con-
nected to the power socket must not exceed
a power rating of 100 W.
CAUTION
Always use the correct type of plugs to avoid
damagin
g the sockets.
Note
The power soc
kets will only work with the
ignition on.
The use of electrical appliances with the
engine switched off will cause a battery dis-
charge.
Luggage compartment
L
o
a
ding the luggage compartment
Fig. 156 Position heavy items as far forward
a
s
po
ssible.
All luggage and other loose objects must be
s
af
ely
secured in the luggage compartment.
Unsecured objects which shift back and forth
could affect safety or driving characteristics
of the vehicle by shifting the centre of gravity.
Distribute the load evenly in the luggage
compartment.
Place heavy objects as far forward as possi-
ble in the luggage compartment
Fig. 156.
Place the heavy objects first.
Secure heavy objects to the fitted fastening
rings* page 140.
Secure loose loads with a luggage net* or
with non-elastic straps secured to the fas-
tening* rings page 140.
WARNING
Loose lug
gage and other objects in the lug-
gage compartment could cause serious inju-
ries.
Always stow objects in the luggage com-
partment and secure them with the fastening
rings*.
During sudden manoeuvres or accidents,
loose objects can be thrown forward, injuring
vehicle occupants or even third parties. This
increased risk of injury will be further in-
creased if a loose object is struck by an inflat-
ing airbag. If this happens, objects may
shoot outward like a missile. Risk of fatal in-
jury.
Always keep all objects in the luggage com-
partment and use appropriate grips to secure
»
139
Technical dataAdviceOperationEmergenciesSafety
background
Operation
them, particularly in the case of heavy
obj
ects.
Never exceed the allowed axle weights or
allowed maximum weight. If said weights are
exceeded, the driving characteristics of the
vehicle may change, leading to accidents, in-
juries and damage to the vehicle.
Please note that the centre of gravity may
shift when transporting heavy objects; this
may affect vehicle handling and lead to an ac-
cident. Therefore, it is essential to adjust
your speed and driving style accordingly, to
avoid accidents.
Never leave your vehicle unattended, espe-
cially when the rear lid is open. Children
could climb into the luggage compartment,
closing the door behind them; they will be
trapped and run the risk of death.
Never allow children to play in or around
the vehicle. Close and lock all the doors and
rear lid when you leave the vehicle. Before
you lock the vehicle, make sure that there are
no adults or children in the vehicle.
Please observe the notes on the page 56.
CAUTION
Hard objects on the rear shelf could chafe
agains
t the wires of the heating element in
the heated rear window and cause damage.
Note
The tyre pr
essure must be adjusted accord-
ing to the load. When necessary check the
tyre pressures on the label located on the in-
side fuel tank flap ›› page 212.
Air circulation in the vehicle helps reduce
fogging of the windows. Used air escapes
through ventilation slits in the side trim of
the luggage compartment. Ensure that the
ventilation slots are never covered.
Straps for securing the load to the fasten-
ing rings* are commercially available from ac-
cessory shops.
Fastening rings*
3 Applies to the model: IBIZA ST
Fig. 157 Location of fastening rings in lug-
g
ag
e c
ompartment.
There may be four fastening rings included in
the lug
g
ag
e compartment for fastening lug-
gage and other objects Fig. 157 (arrows).
Always use suitable and undamaged straps
to secure luggage and other objects to the
fastening rings
in Loading the lug-
g
ag
e c
ompartment on page 139.
Pull up the fastening rings to attach the
straps.
Example: An object weighing 4.5 kg is lying
unsecured in the vehicle. During a frontal col-
lision at a speed of 50 km/h (31 mph), this
object generates a force corresponding to 20
times its weight. That means that the effec-
tive weight of the object increases to approxi-
mately 90 kg. You can imagine the severity of
the injuries which might be sustained if this
“object” strikes an occupant as it flies
through the interior of the vehicle. This in-
creased risk of injury will be further increased
if a loose object is struck by an inflating air-
bag.
WARNING
If piece
s of baggage or other objects are se-
cured to the fastening rings with inappropri-
ate or damaged retaining cords, injuries
could result in the event of braking manoeu-
vres or accidents.
Never secure a child seat on the fastening
rings.
140
background
Transport and practical equipment
Stretched luggage net*
3 Applies to the model: IBIZA ST
Fig. 158 Stretched luggage net.
The luggage net can be used to secure and
r
et
ain light
items in the luggage compart-
ment.
Luggage net
Secure the luggage net to the four fasten-
ing rings Fig. 158 (arrows).
WARNING
The luggage net should only be used to hold
obj
ects weighing up to 5 kg. Heavier objects
cannot be safely secured (risk of injury).
Rear shelf
Fig. 159 Rear shelf.
Removing the shelf
Unhook the loops
Fig. 159
B
from
hou
s
in
gs
A
.
Extract the cover from its slot, in its rest po-
s
ition and p
u
ll outwards.
WARNING
Do not place heavy or hard objects on the
rear shelf
, because they will endanger the ve-
hicle occupants in case of sudden braking.
CAUTION
Befor
e closing the rear lid, ensure that the
rear shelf is correctly fitted.
An overloaded luggage compartment could
mean that the rear shelf is not correctly seat-
ed and it may be bent or damaged.
If the lugg
age compartment is overloaded,
remove the tray.
Note
En
sur
e that, when placing items of clothing
on the luggage compartment cover, rear visi-
bility is not reduced.
141
Technical dataAdviceOperationEmergenciesSafety
background
Operation
Rear shelf with storage compartment*
3 Applies to the model: IBIZA ST
Fig. 160 Luggage compartment: removing
s
t
or
age compartment.
Fig. 161 Accessing storage compartment.
To remove the storage compartment
Remove the rear shelf and pull the storage
c
omp
ar
tment upwards holding it by the
edges Fig. 160.
The storage compartment can be accessed
from the rear seats by lifting the front part of
the rear shelf Fig. 161.
WARNING
Do not place heavy or hard objects on the
rear shelf
, because they will endanger the ve-
hicle occupants in case of sudden braking.
CAUTION
Befor
e closing the rear lid, ensure that the
rear shelf is correctly fitted.
An overloaded luggage compartment could
mean that the rear shelf is not correctly seat-
ed and it may be bent or damaged.
If the luggage compartment is overloaded,
remove the tray.
The load in the storage compartment
should not exceed 3 kg.
Note
Ensur
e that, when placing items of clothing
on the luggage compartment cover, rear visi-
bility is not reduced.
If your vehicle has a storage compartment*,
only place light objects inside.
Roof rack/roof luggage rack*
Intr
oduction
Please observe the following points if you in-
tend to c
arry loads on the roof:
For safety reasons, only luggage racks and
accessories supplied by SEAT Official Serv-
ices are recommended.
It is essential that you follow the assembly
instructions included with the bars exactly,
being especially careful to position front and
rear luggage compartment cover bars on the
special housings in the longitudinal bars.
You must also respect their position accord-
ing to the direction of travel indicated in the
assembly manual. Not following these in-
structions may damage the bodywork.
Pay special attention to the tightening tor-
que of the attac
hment bolts and check them
following a short journey. If necessary, re-
tighten the bolts and check them at regular
intervals.
Distribute the load evenly. A maximum load
of 40 kg is permitted for each roof rack sys-
tem support bar, the load must be distrib-
uted evenly along the entire length. However,
the maximum load permitted for the entire
roof (including the support system) of 75 kg
must not be exceeded nor the total weight
recommended for the entire vehicle. See the
“Technical Data” section.
142
background
Transport and practical equipment
When tr
an
s
porting heavy or large objects
on the roof, any change in the normal vehicle
behaviour due to a change in the centre of
gravity or an increased wind resistance must
be taken into account. For this reason, a suit-
able speed and driving style must be used.
On vehicles fitted with a sliding/tilting sun-
roof*, make sure it does not hit the load on
the roof upon opening.
Attach the cross bars of the roof carri-
er system
Fig. 162 Ibiza/Ibiza SC: attachment points for
the r
oof
r
ailings for the roof carrier system.
Fig. 163 Ibiza ST: attachment points for the
roof r
ailings for the roof carrier system.
The crossbars are the basis of a series of spe-
c
i
al
roof carrier systems. For safety reasons,
special fixtures must be used to safely trans-
port luggage, bicycles, skis, surf boards or
boats on the roof. Suitable accessories can
be acquired at SEAT dealerships.
Always secure the crossbars and the roof car-
rier system properly. Always take the assem-
bly instructions that come with the crossbars
and the roof carrier system in question into
account.
Ibiza Model
The front and rear attachment points
1
and
2
are only visible when the doors are open
Fig. 162 A.
»
143
Technical dataAdviceOperationEmergenciesSafety
background
Operation
Ibiza SC Model
The fr
ont
att
achment points
1
are only visi-
b
l
e when the door
s are open; the rear attach-
ment points
3
are marked on the top edge
of
the s
ide w
indow with arrow heads
Fig. 162 B.
Ibiza ST Model
The crossbars are assembled on the roof rail-
ings. The attachment points can be seen on
the inside of the roof railings ›› Fig. 163.
WARNING
Incorrect attachment and use of the cross-
bars
and the roof carrier system may cause
the whole system to detach from the roof and
cause an accident and injuries.
Always take the manufacturer assembly in-
structions into account.
Use only crossbars and the roof carrier sys-
tem when they are in perfect condition and
are properly secured.
Always secure the crossbars and the roof
carrier system properly.
Check threaded joints and attachments
travelling and if necessary tighten them after
you have travelled a short distance. When
making long trips, check the threaded joints
whenever you stop for a rest.
Always fit the special roof carrier systems
correctly for wheels, skis and surfboards, etc.
Do not modify or repair the crossbars or
roof carrier system.
Note
Always read the assembly instructions that
come with the c
rossbars and the roof carrier
system carefully and keep them in the vehi-
cle.
Air conditioning
He
atin
g,
ventilation and cool-
ing
General notes
Read the additional information carefully
page 39
Pollution filter
The pollution filter (a combined particulate
filter and active carbon filter) serves as a bar-
rier against impurities in the outside air, in-
cluding dust and pollen.
For the climate control system to work with
maximum efficiency, the pollution filter must
be replaced at the specified intervals in the
Maintenance Programme.
If the filter loses efficiency prematurely due
to use in areas reaching very high pollution
levels, the pollen filter must be changed
more frequently than stated in the Service
Schedule.
WARNING
Reduced visibility through the windows in-
cre
ases the risk of serious accidents.
Always ensure that all windows are free of
ice and snow, and that they are not fogged,
144
background
Air conditioning
so as to maintain good visibility of everything
outside.
The m
aximum heat output required to de-
frost windows as quickly as possible is only
available when the engine has reached its
normal running temperature. Only drive when
you have good visibility.
Always ensure that you use the heating
system, fresh air system, air conditioner and
the heated rear window to maintain good visi-
bility to the outside.
Never leave the air recirculation on for a
long period of time. If the cooling system is
switched off and air recirculation mode
switched on, the windows can mist over very
quickly, considerably limiting visibility.
Switch air recirculation mode off when it is
not required.
WARNING
Stuffy or used air will increase fatigue and re-
duce driver c
oncentration possibly resulting
in a serious accident.
Never leave the fresh air fan turned off or
use the air recirculation for long periods of
time; the air in the vehicle interior will not be
refreshed.
CAUTION
If y
ou suspect that the air conditioner is
damaged, switch it off with the
A/C
button to
prevent further damage and have it checked
by a s
pecialised workshop.
Repairs to the air conditioner require spe-
cialist knowledge and special tools. There-
fore, we recommend you to take the vehicle
to a specialised workshop.
Note
If
the humidity and t
emperature outside the
vehicle are high, condensation can drip off
the evaporator in the cooling system and
form a pool underneath the vehicle. This is
normal and does not indicate a leak.
Keep the air intake slots in front of the
windscreen free of snow, ice and leaves to en-
sure heating and cooling are not impaired,
and to prevent the windows from misting
over.
The air from the vents flows through the ve-
hicle interior and is extracted by slots in the
luggage compartment designed for this pur-
pose. Therefore, you should avoid obstruct-
ing these slots with any kind of object.
The air conditioner operates most effective-
ly with the windows and the sliding/tilting
sunroof* closed. However, if the temperature
inside the vehicle is excessive because of the
sun, the air inside can be cooled faster by
opening the windows for a short time.
Do not smoke while air recirculation mode
is on, as smoke drawn into the air condition-
ing system leaves residue on the evaporator,
producin
g a permanent unpleasant odour.
At low outside temperatures, the compres-
sor switches off automatically and cannot be
switched on even with the
AUTO
button.
It is advisable to turn on the air condition-
ing at l
east once a month, to lubricate the
system gaskets and prevent leaks. If a de-
crease in the cooling capacity is detected, a
Technical Service should be consulted to
check the system.
To ensure correct operation, the grilles on
both sides of the screen must not be obstruc-
ted
When the engine is under extreme strain,
switch off the compressor for a moment.
Economic use of the air conditioning
When the air conditioning is switched on, the
c
ompr
e
ssor consumes engine power and has
influence on fuel consumption. Consider the
following points in order to have the system
operating in the minimum possible time.
If the vehicle interior has overheated due to
an excessive solar radiation, it is best to
open the windows or doors to allow the hot
air to escape.
While in motion, the air conditioning
should not be switched on if the windows or
the sunroof* are open.
145
Technical dataAdviceOperationEmergenciesSafety
background
Operation
Air outlets
Fig. 164 Air vents
Air distribution
Symbol page 146
C
Main air output through out-
lets
1, 2
5
1, 2, 5
3, 4
Outlets
3
and
4
can be closed or opened
separat
ely using the slats and the air flow di-
rected as required.
Heating and fresh air
Contro
ls
Fig. 165 Heating controls on the dash panel.
U
se t
urn c
ontrols
A
,
B
and
C
Fig. 165
t
o a
djust the temperature, blower speed and
air distribution.
Press the
D
button to switch air recircula-
tion mode on or off
.
When the f
unction is ac-
tivated, a warning light on the button is
turned on.
Temperature
Switch
A
adjusts temperature. The desired
t
emper
at
ure inside the vehicle cannot be
lower than the ambient temperature. Maxi-
mum heat output, which is needed to defrost
the windows quickly, is only available when
the engine has reached its operating temper-
ature.
146
background
Air conditioning
Blower
The air flo
w c
an be set
at four speeds with
switch
B
. The blower should always be set
at
the lo
w
est speed when driving slowly.
Air distribution
Control
C
for setting the flow of air in the re-
quir
ed dir
ection.
– Air distribution towards the windscreen
in order to demist. For safety reasons, it is
not recommended to switch air recirculation
on.
– Air distribution to upper body.
– Air distribution to footwell
– Air distribution to the windscreen and
the footwell.
WARNING
For y
our safety, the windows should never
be fogged up or covered with snow or ice.
This is essential to ensure good visibility.
Please familiarise yourself with the correct
operation of the heating and ventilation sys-
tem, including the demist/defrost functions
for the windows.
Note
Plea
se consider the general notes
page 144.
Air recirculation
Air recirculation prevents unpleasant smells
from enterin
g the interior.
Connecting the recirculation
In any position of rotary switch
C
except
thaw:
Pr
ess button
D
Fig. 165 and the l
amp in
the button will illuminate.
Disconnecting the recirculation
If the lamp is on, press button
D
and the
l
amp w
i
ll go off, indicating that the entry of
outside air has been activated.
If the rotary switch
C
Fig. 165 is in the
thaw position, the recirculation flap will al-
ways be open and air will always enter from
the outside.
If the rotary switch
C
is switched from any
po
s
ition t
o the thaw position, recirculation
will be automatically deactivated.
WARNING
In air recir
culation mode, no cold air from
the outside enters the vehicle interior. The
windows can quickly fog over if the heating is
switched off. Therefore, never leave the air re-
circulation mode switched on for a long time
(risk of accident).
Vehicle ventilation or heating
Ventilating the vehicle interior
Turn the temperature selector
Fig. 165
A
anticlockwise.
Turn blower switch
B
to any of the head
settings
1 -4.
Set the airflow to the desired direction us-
ing air distribution control
C
.
Open the relevant air outlets.
Interior heatin
g
Turn the temperature selector
Fig. 165
A
clockwise to select the desired tempera-
t
ur
e.
T
urn blower switch
B
to any of the head
settin
g
s
1 -4.
Set the airflow to the desired direction us-
ing air distribution control
C
.
Open the relevant air outlets.
D
efr
o
sting the windscreen
Turn the temperature selector
Fig. 165
A
clockwise to reach the maximum tem-
per
at
ur
e.
Turn the blower switch
B
to setting 4.
Turn air distribution control to .
Close outlet
3
.
»
147
Technical dataAdviceOperationEmergenciesSafety
background
Operation
Open and t
urn outl
et
4
towards the side
w
indo
w
s.
Keeping the windscreen and the side win-
dows demisted
Turn the temperature selector Fig. 165
A
to the heating area.
Turn blower switch
B
to any of the head
settin
g
s
2 -3.
Turn air distribution control to .
Close outlets
3
Open and turn outlets
4
towards side win-
do
w
s.
Onc
e the windows are demisted and as a pre-
ventive measure, the control
C
can be set in
po
s
ition
, thus obtaining greater comfort
while preventing the windows from misting
again.
Heating
Maximum heat output, which is needed to
defrost the windows quickly, is only available
when the engine has reached its operating
temperature.
Note
Remember that the temperature of the engine
cool
ant should be optimum to ensure that the
heating system functions correctly (except in
vehicles fitted with additional heating*).
Air conditioning*
C
ontr
o
ls
Fig. 166 Air conditioning controls on the
d
a
sh p
anel.
Temperature selector
page 149
Blower control. There are four speed set-
tings for the blower. At low speed, it is
recommended to set the blower to a mini-
mum of 1 to improve the intake of fresh
air.
Air distribution control page 149
Air recirculation button
p
age 149
A/C
button – Switches on the cooling
sy
s
t
em page 149
The air conditioning system only works when
the engine is running and the fan is switched
on.
A
B
C
D
E
U
s
in
g the rotary switches
A
,
B
and
C
Fig. 166 y
ou c
an a
djust temperature, blow-
er speed and air distribution.
To switch a function on or off, press the ap-
propriate button
D
or
E
. When the function
i
s
activ
ated, a red warning light on the but-
ton is turned on.
To demist the windscreen
Turn air distribution to .
Turn the fan control to one of the two levels
depending on the speed required.
Rotate the temperature control to the de-
sired level of comfort.
Close outlets
3
Open and turn outlets
4
towards side win-
do
w
s.
WARNING
For your safety, the windows should never be
fogg
ed up or covered with snow or ice. This is
essential to ensure good visibility. Please fa-
miliarise yourself with the correct operation
of the heating and ventilation system, includ-
ing the demist/defrost functions for the win-
dows.
Note
Please consider the general notes.
148
background
Air conditioning
Vehicle interior heating or cooling
sy
s
t
em
Interior heating
Turn off the cooling system using the
Fig. 166
A/C
button (the button light
turns
off).
Turn the temperature selector
A
to set the
desir
ed temperature inside the vehicle.
Turn the blower switch to any of the set-
tings 1-4.
Set the air distribution control
C
to the air
flo
w c
onfigur
ation desired:
(towards the
w
ind
s
creen),
(towards the chest),
(towards the footwell) and
(towards the
w
ind
s
creen and footwell areas).
Interior cooling
Turn off the cooling system using the
A/C
button (the button light turns on).
Turn the temperature control switch until
the de
s
ir
ed interior temperature is reached.
Turn the blower switch to any of the set-
tings 1-4.
Set the air distribution control to the air
flow configuration desired:
(towards the
w
ind
s
creen),
(towards the chest),
(towards the footwell) and
(towards the
w
ind
s
creen and footwell areas).
Heating
Maximum heat output, which is needed to
defrost the windows quickly, is only available
when the engine has reached its operating
temperature.
Coolant system
When the air conditioning is switched on, the
temperature and the air humidity go down.
This way, if the outside humidity is extreme,
the air conditioning prevents the misting of
the windows and therefore, comfort is im-
proved.
If the air conditioning does not work, this
may be due to the following reasons:
The engine is stationary.
The fan blower is switched off.
The outside temperature is lower than ap-
proximately +3°C (+37°F).
The air conditioning system compressor
has been temporarily switched off because of
an increased engine coolant temperature.
The air conditioner fuse is faulty.
Another fault in the vehicle. Have the air
conditioning checked by a specialised work-
shop.
Air recirculation
Air recirculation prevents unpleasant smells,
e.g. when pa
ssing through a tunnel or in
queuing traffic, from entering the interior.
If the rotary switch
C
Fig. 166 i
s in the
thaw position, the recirculation flap will al-
ways be open (button light off).
If the rotary switch
C
is switched from any
position t
o the thaw position, recirculation
will be automatically deactivated.
Connecting the recirculation
In any position of rotary switch
C
except
th
a
w:
Pr
ess button
D
Fig. 166
, the switch's
lamp will light up, indicating that air recircu-
lation inside the vehicle has been activated.
Disconnecting the recirculation
In any position of rotary switch
C
except
th
a
w:
Pr
ess button
D
again and the button's
l
amp w
i
ll go off, indicating that air recircula-
tion from the outside has been activated.
In the thaw position of rotary switch
C
, the
entr
y
of
air into the vehicle interior is always
from the outside.
»
149
Technical dataAdviceOperationEmergenciesSafety
background
Operation
WARNING
In air recirculation mode, no cold air from the
outside ent
ers the vehicle interior. If the air
conditioner is switched off, the windows can
quickly mist over. Therefore, never leave the
air recirculation mode switched on for a long
time (risk of accident).
Note
When engagin
g reverse gear, the air recir-
culation is connected automatically to pre-
vent the entrance of exhaust gases in the ve-
hicle on travelling backwards. The control
lamp on the button
does not light up.
If the temperature control is turned to the
col
dest setting (blue point) and the
A/C
but-
ton is on, the “Air recirculation” function is
automatic
ally activated in order to cool the
vehicle faster using less energy, and its func-
tion control lamp will light up.
If the function is not deactivated by press-
ing the button, it will deactivate after approx-
imately 20 minutes.
Climatronic*
General
notes
Fig. 167 Climatronic: controls.
Read the additional information carefully
page 39
Climatronic automatically maintains a com-
fortable temperature. To do so, it automati-
cally regulates the supplied air temperature
and the blower and air distribution levels.
The system also allows for the effect of sun-
light, so there is no need for manual adjust-
ment. It also has a humidity sensor that
helps to automatically demist the wind-
screen.
Automatic operations page 151 guaran-
tee maximum comfort any time of year.
150
background
Air conditioning
Climatronic description
C
oo
lin
g only works if the following conditions
are met:
The engine is running
the outside temperature is above +2°C
(+36°F);
A/C
18
Fig. 167
sw
itched on.
Starting the Climatronic
The corresponding function will be switched
on when a button is pressed, turning on the
air conditioniNG if it was switched off, with
the exception of button
17
Fig. 167
(recir-
culation)
Switching off the Climatronic
Turn control
10
to the left until the seg-
ments
of
c
olumn
9
Fig. 167
switch off.
After 1 second has elapsed, turn the control
again to switch off the display.
In order to ensure engines subject to heavy
loads are cooled, the air conditioning com-
pressor is switched off in the event of high
coolant temperatures.
Recommended setting for all seasons of the
year
Set the required temperature. We recom-
mend +22 °C (72°F).
Press the
AUTO
button
13
Fig. 167
.
Adjust vents 3 and 4 page 146 so that
the air flow is directed slightly upwards.
Change between degrees Centigrade and de-
grees Fahrenheit
Keep the
AUTO
and
A/C
Fig. 167
b
uttons
held down for 2 seconds at the same time.
The data is displayed on the screen in the
units required.
Note
A vi
sit to the specialised service once a
year is recommended to clean the Climatronic
system.
The interior temperature sensor
11
Fig. 167 is at
the bottom. Do not cover it
with stickers or the like, as this could have a
negative effect on Climatronic operations.
Automatic mode
Automatic mode is used to maintain a con-
s
t
ant
temperature and demist the windows
inside the vehicle.
Switching on automatic mode
Set the interior temperature between +16°C
(+64°F) and +29°C (+84°F).
Adjust vents 3 and 4
page 146 so that
the air flow is directed slightly upwards.
Press the
AUTO
button
13
Fig. 167
and
AUTO di
splayed on the screen.
Automatic mode is switched off by pressing
the air distribution buttons or increasing or
decreasing the blower speed. However, the
temperature remains regulated.
Adjusting the temperature
When you switch on the ignition, control
1
Fig. 167 can be used t
o set the required in-
terior temperature.
It is possible to select interior temperatures
from +16°C (+64°F) to +29°C (+84°F). In this
range the temperature is regulated automati-
cally. If a temperature below +16°C (+64°F) is
selected, “LO” is displayed on the screen. If a
temperature above +29°C (+84°F) is selected,
“HI” is displayed on the screen. At both ex-
tremes, Climatronic works at maximum cool-
ing or heating power, respectively. The tem-
perature is not regulated.
In the event of prolonged, irregular distribu-
tion of the air flow from the outlets (particu-
larly the footwells) and significant differen-
ces in temperature, e.g. on leaving the vehi-
cle, sensitive people may catch cold.
151
Technical dataAdviceOperationEmergenciesSafety
background
Operation
Air recirculation
Air recirculation prevents unpleasant smells,
e.g. when pa
ssing through a tunnel or in
queuing traffic, from entering the interior.
Switching on air recirculation mode
Press button
17
Fig. 167 and the
symbol is displayed on the screen.
Switching off air recirculation mode
Press button
17
Fig. 167
and the
symbol disappears from the screen.
WARNING
Read and observe the safety warnings ››
in
General
notes on page 144.
Note
If air recirculation mode remains on for 15 mi-
nutes, the
symbol will start to flash on
the screen to indicate prolonged air recircula-
tion. If air recirculation is not switched off,
the symbol will continue to flash for about 5
minutes.
Blower selection
Climatronic automatically regulates blower
s
peed ac
c
ording to the interior temperature.
It is possible, however, to set the blower
speed to suit requirements.
Turn control
10
Fig. 167
c
ounter-clock-
wise (to lower the speed) or clockwise (to in-
crease the speed).
Climatronic will switch off when the blower
switches off.
WARNING
Read and observe the safety warnings ››
in
General
notes on page 144.
Windscreen defrost
Switching on windscreen defrosting
Press the button

12
Fig. 167.
Switching off windscreen defrosting
Press button

12
Fig. 167 several
times or press the
AUTO
button.
The t
emper
at
ure is regulated automatically.
The air output is increased from vents 1 and
2
page 146.
Driving
Ad
dr
e
ss
Introduction
The power steering is not hydraulic but elec-
tromech
anical. The advantage of this steer-
ing is that it foes not need flexible hydraulic
pipes, hydraulic oil, pump, filter or other
parts. The electromechanical system saves
fuel. Whereas a hydraulic system needs con-
tinuous oil pressure, electromechanical
steering only needs power when it is used.
In vehicles with electromechanical steering,
the assisted steering function automatically
adjusts according to vehicle speed, steering
wheel torque and wheel orientation. The
power steering only works when the engine
is running.
WARNING
If the power steering does not work, you will
need much more s
trength to turn the wheel.
This has a considerable effect on vehicle
safety.
The power steering only works when the
engine is running.
Never allow the vehicle to move when the
engine is switched off.
Never remove the key from the ignition
while the vehicle is moving. The steering lock
152
background
Driving
could be engaged and vehicle steering would
not work.
Note
The ignition of the vehicle being towed must
be sw
itc
hed on to prevent the steering wheel
from locking and also to allow the use of the
turn signals, horn, windscreen wipers and
washers.
Information relating to different vehi-
c
l
e pr
ocesses.
In order to make the vehicle more difficult to
s
t
e
al, you should always lock the steering be-
fore leaving the vehicle.
Mechanical steering lock
The steering column is locked when the key
is removed from the ignition lock and the ve-
hicle is stationary.
Activating the steering lock
Park the vehicle ›› page 156.
Remove the ignition key.
Turn the steering wheel slightly until the
steering lock has engaged.
Deactivating the steering lock
Turn the steering wheel slightly to release
the lock.
Insert the key in the ignition lock.
Hold the steering wheel in this position
and switch on the ignition.
Electromechanical steering
In vehicles with electromechanical steering,
the assisted steering function automatically
adjusts according to vehicle speed, steering
wheel torque and wheel orientation. The
power steering only works when the engine
is running.
You should take into account that you will
need considerably more power than normal
to steer the vehicle if the power steering is
not working correctly or at all.
Power-assisted steering
Power-assisted steering helps the driver in
critical situations. In counter-steering, it as-
sists by applying additional torque ››
.
WARNING
Power-assisted steering, together with the
ESC, helps
the driver to control vehicle steer-
ing in critical situations. However, the driver
is ultimately responsible for steering the ve-
hicle at all times. Power-assisted steering
does not remove this responsibility.
Starting and stopping the en-
gine
Ignition k
ey
po
sitions
Fig. 168 Ignition key positions.
Read the additional information carefully
page 20
Ignition switched off, steering lock
1
In this position
Fig. 168, the ignition and
the engine are OFF and the steering may be
locked.
For the Steering lock to operate without the
ignition key, turn the steering wheel until it
locks with an audible sound. You should al-
ways lock the steering wheel when you leave
your vehicle. This will help prevent vehicle
theft
.
»
153
Technical dataAdviceOperationEmergenciesSafety
background
Operation
Switching the ignition or the glow plug sys-
t
em on
2
Turn the ignition key to this position and re-
l
e
a
se it. If the key cannot be turned or it is
difficult to turn from position
1
to position
2
, move the steering wheel from one side to
the other; thi
s
w
ill release it.
Starting
3
The engine is started when the key is in this
po
s
ition. El
ectrical devices with high power
consumption are switched off temporarily at
the same time.
Each time that the vehicle is restarted, the ig-
nition key must be turned to position
1
. The
r
epetitiv
e s
tart prevention lock of the igni-
tion prevents possible damage to the starter
motor if the engine is already running.
WARNING
The ignition key mu
st NOT be removed from
the lock until the vehicle comes to a stand-
still. Otherwise, the steering could be imme-
diately blocked- Risk of accident!
Always remove the key from the ignition
when leaving the vehicle, even if only for a
short period. This is especially important if
children or disabled people are left alone in
the vehicle. They could accidentally start the
engine or work electrical equipment such as
the electric windows, resulting in an acci-
dent.
Unsuper
vised use of the key could start the
engine or any electrical system, such as the
electric windows. This could result in serious
injury.
CAUTION
The starter motor will only work when the en-
gine i
s s
topped (ignition key position
3
).
Electronic immobiliser
The electronic immobiliser prevents unau-
thori
sed per
son
s from driving the vehicle.
Inside the key there is a chip that deactivates
the electronic immobiliser automatically
when the key is inserted into the ignition.
The electronic immobiliser will be activated
again automatically as soon as you pull the
key out of the ignition lock.
The engine can only be started using a genu-
ine SEAT key with its correct code.
Note
A perfect operation of the vehicle is ensured
if genuine
SEAT keys are used.
Starting petrol engines
The engine can only be started using a genu-
ine SEA
T key with its correct code.
Move the gearbox lever to the neutral posi-
tion and depress the clutch pedal thor-
oughly and hold it in this position for the
starter to turn the engine on.
Turn the ignition key to the starting posi-
tion page 153.
Let go of the ignition key as soon as the en-
gine starts; the starter motor must not run
on with the engine.
After starting a very hot engine, you may
need to slightly press down the accelerator.
When starting a cold engine, it may be a little
noisy for the first few seconds until oil pres-
sure has built up in the hydraulic valve com-
pensators. This is quite normal, and no cause
for concern.
If the engine does not start immediately,
switch the starter off after 10 seconds and try
again after half a minute. If the engine still
does not start, the fuel pump fuse should be
checked
page 81, Fuses.
154
background
Driving
WARNING
Never st
art or run the engine in unventila-
ted or closed rooms. The exhaust gases con-
tain carbon monoxide, an odourless and col-
ourless poisonous gas. Risk of fatal acci-
dents. Carbon monoxide can cause loss of
consciousness and result in death.
Never leave the vehicle unattended if the
engine is running.
Never use “cold start sprays”, they could
explode or cause the engine to run at high
revs. Risk of injury.
CAUTION
When the engine is
cold, you should avoid
high engine speeds, driving at full throttle
and over-loading the engine. Risk of engine
damage.
The vehicle should not be pushed or towed
more than 50 metres to start the engine. Un-
burnt fuel could enter the catalytic converter
and damage it.
Before attempting to push-start or tow a ve-
hicle in order to start it, you should first try to
start it using the battery of another vehicle.
Please observe and follow the notes on the
page 52, How to jump start.
For the sake of the environment
Do not warm-up the engine by running the
engine with the
vehicle stationary. Start off
immediately, driving gently. This helps the
engine reach operating temperature faster
and reduce
s emissions.
Starting diesel engines
The engine can only be started using a genu-
ine SEA
T key with its correct code.
Move the gearbox lever to the neutral posi-
tion and depress the clutch pedal thor-
oughly and hold it in this position for the
starter to turn the engine on.
Turn the ignition key to position
Fig. 168
2
. The warning lamp w
i
l
l light for en-
gine pre-heating.
When the lamp turns off, turn the ignition
key to position
3
to start the engine. Do
not
pr
e
ss the accelerator.
Release the ignition key as soon as the en-
gine starts. The starter motor should not
turn at the same time.
When starting a cold engine, it may be a little
noisy for the first few seconds until oil pres-
sure has built up in the hydraulic valve com-
pensators. This is quite normal, and no cause
for concern.
If there are problems starting the engine, see
the
page 52.
Glow plug system for the diesel engine
To avoid unnecessary discharging of the bat-
tery, do not use any other major electrical
equipment while the glow plugs are pre-heat-
ing.
Start the engine as soon as the glow plug
warning lamp goes out.
Starting a diesel engine after the fuel tank
has been completely run dry
If the fuel tank has been completely run dry,
it may take longer than normal (up to one mi-
nute) to start a diesel engine after refuelling.
This is because the fuel system must elimi-
nate air first.
WARNING
Observe the safety warnings ››
in Starting
petrol
engines on page 155.
CAUTION
When the engine is
cold, you should avoid
high engine speeds, driving at full throttle
and over-loading the engine. Risk of engine
damage.
The vehicle should not be pushed or towed
more than 50 metres to start the engine. Un-
burnt fuel could enter the catalytic converter
and damage it.
Before attempting to push-start or tow a ve-
hicle in order to start it, you should first try to
»
155
Technical dataAdviceOperationEmergenciesSafety
background
Operation
start it using the battery of another vehicle.
Plea
se observe and follow the notes on the
page 52, How to jump start.
For the sake of the environment
Do not warm-up the engine by running the
en
gine with the
vehicle stationary. You
should drive off as soon as you start the en-
gine. This helps the engine reach operating
temperature faster and reduces emissions.
Switching off the engine
Stop the vehicle.
Turn the ignition key to position
Fig. 168
1
.
Af
t
er sw
itching the engine off, the radiator
fan may run on for up to 10 minutes. It is also
possible that the fan turns itself on once
more if the coolant temperature increases
due to the heat accumulated in the engine
compartment or due to its prolonged expo-
sure to solar radiation.
WARNING
Never swit
ch the engine off until the vehi-
cle is completely stationary.
The brake servo works only when the en-
gine is running. With the engine switched off,
more strength is needed to brake. As normal
brake operation cannot be performed, risk of
accident
s and serious injury may exist.
The steering lock can be immediately
blocked once the key is removed from the ig-
nition. The vehicle cannot be steered. Risk of
accident.
Power-assisted steering does not work
when the engine is off, and more strength is
needed to turn the wheel.
If the key is removed from the ignition lock
the steering lock could be engaged and vehi-
cle steering would not work.
CAUTION
When the engine has been running under a
heavy lo
ad for a long period, heat can accu-
mulate in the engine compartment and cause
engine damage. For this reason, idle the en-
gine for approximately 2 minutes before
switching it off.
Braking and parking
Br
ak
in
g capacity and braking distance
The efficiency of the brakes depends directly
on the br
ak
e p
ad wear. This wear depends to
a great extent on the conditions under which
the vehicle is operated and the way the vehi-
cle is driven. If you often drive in town, drive
short distances or have a sporty driving style,
we recommend that you have the thickness
of your brake pads checked by technical serv-
ices more frequently than recommended in
the Maintenance Programme.
If you drive with wet brakes, for example, af-
ter crossing areas of water, on days of heavy
rainfall or even after washing the car, the ef-
fect of the brakes is reduced as the brake
discs are wet or even frozen (in winter): in
this case, the brakes should be “dried” by
pressing the brake pedal several times.
WARNING
Longer braking distances and faults in the
brake sy
stem increase the risk of accidents.
New brake pads must be run in and do not
have the correct friction during the first
200 km. This reduced braking capacity may
be compensated for by pressing on the brake
pedal a little harder, which also applies when
the brake pads have to be changed further
on.
If brakes are wet or frozen, or if you are
driving on roads which have been salted,
braking power may be lower than normal.
On steep slopes, if brakes are excessively
used, they will overheat. Before driving down
a long steep slope, it is advisable to reduce
speed and change down into a lower gear or
range (depending on the type of transmis-
sion). Thus, make use of engine braking and
relieve the brakes.
Never let the brakes “drag” by applying
light pressure. Continuous braking will cause
156
background
Driving
the brakes to overheat and the braking
dist
ance will increase. Apply and then release
the brakes alternately.
Never let the vehicle run with the engine
switched off. The braking distance is in-
creased considerably when the brake servo is
not active.
If the brake fluid loses its viscosity and is
subjected to heavy use, vapour bubbles can
form in the brake system. This reduces the ef-
ficiency of the brakes.
Non-standard or damaged front spoilers
could restrict the airflow to the brakes and
cause them to overheat. Before purchasing
accessories please observe the relevant in-
structions page 190, Modifications.
If a brake system circuit fails, the braking
distance will be increased considerably. Con-
tact a specialised workshop immediately and
avoid unnecessary journeys.
Handbrake
Fig. 169 Handbrake between the front seats.
The handbrake should be applied firmly to
pr
ev
ent
the vehicle from accidentally rolling
away. Always apply the handbrake when you
leave your vehicle and when you park.
Applying the handbrake
Pull the handbrake lever up firmly
Fig. 169.
Releasing the handbrake
Pull the lever up slightly and press the re-
lease knob in the direction of the arrow
Fig. 169 and guide the handbrake lever
down fully
.
A
lw
a
ys pull the handbrake all the way up, so
there is less risk of driving off with it still en-
gaged
.
The handbrake warning lamp lights
up
when the h
andbr
ake is applied and the igni-
tion switched on. The warning lamp turns off
when the handbrake is released.
WARNING
Never use the h
andbrake to stop the vehi-
cle when it is in motion. The braking distance
is considerably longer, because braking is
only applied to the rear wheels. Risk of acci-
dent!
If the handbrake is only partially released,
this will cause the rear brakes to overheat,
which can impair the function of the brake
system and could lead to an accident. This al-
so causes premature wear on the rear brake
pads.
CAUTION
Always apply the handbrake before you leave
the vehic
le. Put it in 1st gear as well. In vehi-
cles with an automatic gearbox, place the
gear lever in position P.
Parking
The handbrake should always be firmly ap-
p
lied when the
v
ehicle is parked.
Always note the following points when park-
ing the vehicle:
Use the brake pedal to stop the vehicle.
»
157
Technical dataAdviceOperationEmergenciesSafety
background
Operation
Ap
p
ly
the handbrake.
Put it in 1st gear.
Switch the engine off and remove the key
from the ignition. Turn the steering wheel
slightly to engage the steering lock.
Always take you keys with you when you
leave the vehicle
.
Ad
dition
a
l notes on parking the vehicle on
gradients:
Turn the steering wheel so that the vehicle
rolls against the kerb if it started to roll.
If the vehicle is parked facing downhill,
turn the front wheels so that they point to-
wards the kerb.
If the vehicle is parked facing uphill, turn
the front wheels so that they point away from
the kerb.
Secure the vehicle as usual by applying the
handbrake firmly and putting it in 1st gear.
WARNING
Take me
asures to reduce the risk of injury
when you leave your vehicle unattended.
Never park where the hot exhaust system
could ignite inflammable materials, such as
dry grass, low bushes, spilt fuel etc.
Never allow vehicle occupants to remain in
the vehicle when it is locked. They would be
unable to open the vehicle from the inside,
and could become trapped in the vehicle in
an emergency. In the event of an emergency,
locked door
s will delay assistance to vehicle
occupants.
Never leave children alone in the vehicle.
They could set the vehicle in motion, for ex-
ample, by releasing the handbrake or the
gearbox lever.
Depending on weather conditions, it may
become extremely hot or cold inside the vehi-
cle. This can be fatal.
Hill driving assistant*
This function is only included in vehicles with
E
SC.
The hi
l
l driving assistant helps the driver to
move off and upward on a hill when the vehi-
cle is stationary.
The system maintains brake pressure for ap-
proximately two seconds after the driver
takes his foot off the brake pedal to prevent
the vehicle from lurching backward when it is
started. During these 2 seconds, the driver
has enough time to release the clutch pedal
and accelerate without the vehicle moving
and without having to use the handbrake,
making start-up easier, more comfortable
and safer.
These are the basic operation conditions:
being on a ramp or hill/slope,
doors closed,
vehicle completely stationary,
engine running and foot on the brake,
besides having a gear engaged or being in
neutral for manual gear change and with the
selector lever at position S, D or R for an au-
tomatic gearbox.
This system is also active when reversing up-
hill.
WARNING
If y
ou do not start the vehicle immediately
after taking your foot off the brake pedal, the
vehicle may start to roll back under certain
conditions. Depress the brake pedal or use
the hand brake immediately.
If the engine stalls, depress the brake ped-
al or use the hand brake immediately.
When following a line of traffic uphill, if you
want to prevent the vehicle from rolling back
accidentally when starting off, hold the brake
pedal down for a few seconds before starting
off.
Note
The Official Service or a specialist workshop
can tel
l you if your vehicle is equipped with
this system.
158
background
Driving
Manual gearbox
Driv
in
g w
ith manual gearbox
Read the additional information carefully
page 37
Certain versions of the model may include a
6-speed manual gearbox, and its diagram is
shown on the gearbox lever.
The reverse gear can only be engaged when
the car is stationary. When the engine is run-
ning and before engaging this gear, wait
about 6 seconds with the clutch pressed
down thoroughly in order to protect the gear-
box.
The reverse lights switch on when the reverse
gear is selected and the ignition is on.
WARNING
When the engine is
running, the vehicle
will start to move as soon as a gear is engag-
ed and the clutch released.
Never select the reverse gear when the ve-
hicle is in motion. Risk of accident.
Note
Do not re
st your hand on the gear lever
while driving. The pressure of your hand
could cause premature wear on the selector
forks in the gearbox.
When chan
ging gear, you should always
depress the clutch fully to avoid unnecessary
wear and damage.
Do not “slip” the clutch to hold the vehicle
on a hill. This causes premature wear and
damage to the clutch.
Do not leave your foot on the clutch pedal;
although the pressure may seem insignifi-
cant, it can cause the premature wear of the
clutch plate. Use the foot rest when you do
not need to change gear.
Gear-change indicator
3 Valid for vehicles: with a manual gearbox
The r
ecommended gear for saving fuel is in-
dicated on the dash screen of certain vehi-
cles during driving.
Display Meaning
The optimal gear is selected.
Changing to a higher gear is recommended.
Changing to a lower gear is recommended.
Information regarding the “cleanliness” of
the die
sel
p
articulate filter
The exhaust system manager detects that the
diesel particulate filter is nearly saturated
and contributes to self-cleaning by recom-
mending the optimal gear. For this purpose,
it might be necessary to drive momentarily
with a high rpm page 101.
WARNING
The gear change indicator is only an auxiliary
function and in no c
ase should be a substi-
tute for careful driving.
The responsibility of choosing the correct
gear depending on the situation (e.g. over-
taking, driving up or down a slope or towing a
trailer) lies with the driver.
For the sake of the environment
Selecting the correct gear can help to save
fuel.
Note
The recommended gear display is switched
off when the clut
ch pedal is pressed.
Automatic gearbox*
Driv
in
g pr
ogrammes
Read the additional information carefully
page 38
The automatic gearbox has got two gearbox
programmes.
»
159
Technical dataAdviceOperationEmergenciesSafety
background
Operation
Selecting the normal programme
Put the selector lever into position D.
Sel
ectin
g the s
port programme
Put the selector lever into position S.
If you select the normal programme, D, you
will drive in the economy mode, i.e. the pro-
gramme is designed to reduce fuel consump-
tion. The gearbox changes up into a higher
gear as soon as possible and down into a
lower gear as late as possible.
If you select the sport programme, S, you will
drive in a sporty mode, i.e. a programme in
which shifts into high gears are postponed in
order to use the full power of the engine.
Selector lever positions
Read the additional information carefully
page 38
Selector lever positions
The selected gear is displayed on the side of
the selector lever and on the instrument pan-
el display. The currently selected gear for the
automatic gearbox will also be shown on the
display.
Tiptronic gear indicator
If the automatic gearbox is shifted manually,
the selected gears are shown on the screen.
P - parking lock
When the selector lever is in this position,
the driven wheels are locked mechanically.
Position P on the lever must only be selected
if the vehicle is stationary.
To move selector lever from position P, the
locking button on the selector lever handle
must be pressed and the brake pedal de-
pressed at the same time while the ignition is
switched on.
To put the selector lever in position P, simply
press the lock button down and, if necessary,
depress the brake pedal down.
R - Reverse gear
The reverse gear is engaged in this position.
Reverse gear must be engaged only when the
vehicle is stationary and the engine is idling.
To move the selector lever to position R,
press the lock button down and, at the same
time, press the brake pedal down, with the
ignition switched on.
With the selector lever in position R and the
ignition switched on the following occurs:
Reverse lights light up.
The air conditioner automatically changes
the air recirculation mode.
The wiper starts if the windscreen washer is
on.
The parking distance warning system*
switches on.
N - Neutral (idling)
If this position is selected, the gearbox is in
neutral. Power is not transmitted to the
wheels and the engine does not have a brak-
ing function.
Never use the N position to drive down a long
hill. There is no engine braking and the
brakes are subjected to excessive stain.
You could damage the automatic gearbox if
you drive down hills with the gearbox lever in
position N and the engine switched off.
D - Drive (forward)
In this position the gearbox automatically
changes to a lower or higher gear, according
to the engine's requirements, the driving
style and speed. The braking effect of the en-
gine when driving downhill is very limited
when the selector is in this position. The in-
strument panel display shows the selected
gear as well as the selector lever in position
D.
When travelling at speeds lower than 5 km/h
(3 mph) or when the vehicle is stationary,
160
background
Driving
press the brake pedal to change the selector
l
ev
er fr
om position N to position D.
S - Standard driving position (Sport pro-
gramme)
When the selector lever is in position S, it will
automatically change up into a higher gear
later, and change down into a low gear, if
compared with position D. This way, it is pos-
sible to take full advantage of the engine re-
serve power, depending on the engine de-
mand, driving style and speed. The braking
effect of the engine when driving downhill is
very limited. On the instrument panel display
the selected gear is shown as well as the se-
lector lever to position S.
To select gear range S, press the lock button
on the selector lever.
WARNING
As a driver
, you should never leave your ve-
hicle if the engine is running and a gear range
is engaged. If you have to leave your vehicle
while the engine is running, you must apply
the parking brake and put the selector lever
in position P.
If the engine is running and if D or R is en-
gaged, you will need to hold the car on the
foot brake. The car will creep forward as the
power transmission is not fully interrupted
even when the engine is idling.
Never accelerate when moving the selector
lever or you may cause an accident.
Never mov
e the selector lever to R or P
when driving. Risk of accident!
Before driving down a long, steep slope, it
is advisable to reduce speed and change into
a lower gear.
If you stop the vehicle up hill, always hold
the foot brake strongly depressed down to
stop it from rolling back.
Never allow the brake to rub and do not use
the brake pedal too often or for long periods.
Constant braking will cause the brakes to
overheat and will considerably reduce the
brake effect. This increases the braking dis-
tance and could cause the brake system to
fail.
Never allow the car to roll down a gradient
with the gear in neutral N, or in selector lever
position D, even if the engine is not running.
If the vehicle moves with no control, an ac-
cident and serious injury may occur.
WARNING
Never switch the engine off until the vehicle
is s
tationary. You could lose control of your
vehicle. This could cause an accident and se-
rious injury.
The airbags and belt tensioners do not
work when the ignition is switched off.
The brake servo does not work with the en-
gine off. You need more force to stop the vehi-
cle.
Pow
er steering does not work when the en-
gine is not running. That is why it is much
more difficult to turn the steering wheel.
Never remove the key from the ignition if
the vehicle is in motion. The steering lock
could suddenly engage, and you would not be
able to steer the vehicle.
CAUTION
If you allow the vehicle to move when the en-
gine i
s sw
itched off or with the selector lever
in position “N”, take your foot off the acceler-
ator and wait until the engine starts idling
before returning to position “D”.
Selector lever lock
Fig. 170 Automatic gearbox
The selector lever lock in position P or N pre-
v
ents
g
ears from being engaged inadvertent-
ly, which would cause the vehicle to move.
»
161
Technical dataAdviceOperationEmergenciesSafety
background
Operation
The selector lever lock is released as follows:
Switch the ignition on.
Press and hold the brake pedal and press
the sel
ect
or l
ever lock on the left of the se-
lector lever at the same time Fig. 170.
The warning lamp on the instrument panel
lights up when the brake pedal should be ap-
plied. This is essential when the selector lev-
er is taken from the P or N positions.
Level lock only engages with the vehicle sta-
tionary at a speed of up to 5 km/h (3 mph).
At speeds of over 5 km/h (3 mph) the selec-
tor lever lock is automatically deactivated in
position N.
The selector lever lock is not engaged if the
selector lever is moved quickly through posi-
tion N (e.g. when shifting from R to D). This
makes it possible, for instance, to “rock” the
vehicle backwards and forwards if it is stuck
in snow or mud. The selector lever lock en-
gages automatically if the brake pedal is not
depressed and the lever is in position N for
more than about 1second.
Selecting gears manually with Tip-
tronic mode*
Fig. 171 Changing gear with Tiptronic.
Fig. 172 Steering wheel with paddle levers
f
or aut
om
atic gearbox.
The Tiptronic system allows the driver to se-
l
ect
g
ears manually.
Changing gear with the selector lever
Press the selector lever from position D to
the right into the tiptronic selector gate.
Lightly press the selector lever forward
Fig. 171
+
to change up to a higher
g
e
ar
.
Lightly press the selector lever backward
Fig. 171
-
to change down to a lower
g
e
ar
.
Changing gear with the steering wheel pad-
dle levers*
Press the right paddle lever
+
towards the
s
t
eerin
g wheel to change up Fig. 172.
Press the left paddle lever
-
towards the
s
t
eerin
g wheel to change down Fig. 172.
Using the paddle levers on the steering
wheel, you can access manual driving mode
regardless of the pre-selected driving mode.
General information about driving in tiptron-
ic mode
When accelerating, the automatic gearbox /
DSG automatic gearbox goes into a higher
gear a little before the engine reaches its
maximum permitted revolutions.
If a lower gear is selected, the automatic
gearbox / DSG automatic gearbox will only
change down when the engine cannot go
over its maximum permitted revolutions.
162
background
Driving
If “tiptronic” is selected whilst the vehicle is
in motion and the aut
om
atic
gearbox / DSG
automatic gearbox is in third gear and selec-
tor lever position D, “tiptronic” mode will
then also be in third gear.
Changing gears in the normal or sport pro-
gramme using the steering wheel paddle lev-
ers
If the paddle levers Fig. 172 are used in
the normal or sport programme, the system
switches temporarily to “tiptronic” mode. To
exit “Tiptronic” mode again, press the right
paddle lever
+
towards the steering wheel
f
or ap
pr
oximately one second. You will also
leave “tiptronic” mode if the paddle levers
are not moved for a certain time.
Note
The gear p
addle levers on the steering
wheel can be operated with the selector lever
in any position and with the vehicle in mo-
tion.
Driving tips
The gearbox changes gear ratios automatical-
ly
a
s
the vehicle moves.
Starting
Start the engine with the selector lever in
position P or N.
Driving
Press and hold the brake pedal.
Holding down the lock button (button on
the selector lever), select R or D.
Release the lever and wait a little for the
gearbox to engage the gear (a slight move-
ment can be felt).
Release the brake and press the accelerator
in Selector lever positions on
p
ag
e 161
.
Stopping briefly
If stopping for a short time, keep the vehi-
cle stationary by pressing the foot brake
hard to prevent the vehicle moving back-
wards on a slope or “creeping” forwards,
e.g. at traffic lights. The selector lever does
not need to be put into the positions P or N
for this.
Do not press the accelerator.
Parking
Press and hold the brake pedal until the ve-
hicle comes to a standstill
in Selector
l
ev
er po
sitions on page 161.
Apply the handbrake.
By pressing the lock button down, move
the selector lever to P and release the lock
button.
Driving up and down hills
Press the selector lever from position “D”
to the right into the tiptronic selector gate.
Lightly press the selector lever back to
change down.
Holding the car on a hill
The brake must be always pressed down to
prevent the vehicle from “rolling back-
wards”
in Selector lever positions on
p
ag
e 161
. Do not try to prevent the vehicle
from “rolling backwards” by increasing the
engine speed while a range of gears is se-
lected.
Starting the vehicle up hills
Apply the handbrake.
With a selected gear, accelerate slowly and
at the same time, release the handbrake.
The steeper the slope, the lower the needed
gear. This increases the braking effect of the
engine. For example, when driving down a
very steep slope in third gear. If the engine
brake effect is not enough, the vehicle will
speed up. The automatic gearbox automati-
cally changes up to prevent the engine over-
revving. Use the foot brake to reduce speed
and change into 3rd gear using Tiptronic*
in Selector lever positions on page 161.
Y
our
v
ehicle has an automatic interlock
which prevents the selector lever from being
»
163
Technical dataAdviceOperationEmergenciesSafety
background
Operation
put into a position for driving forwards or in
r
ev
er
se from positions P or N if the brake
pedal is not depressed.
The ignition key cannot be removed unless
the selector lever is in position P.
Control lamp “Pressing brake pedal”
When the warning lamp next to the selector
lever lights up, press the brake pedal. This is
necessary when the automatic gearbox selec-
tor lever is moved out of positions P or N. A
text message or instructions to perform nec-
essary operations may appear on the instru-
ment panel.
CAUTION
If y
ou stop the vehicle up hills, do not at-
tempt to stop it from rolling back by depress-
ing the accelerator when a gear has been se-
lected. Otherwise, the automatic gearbox
may overheat causing damage. Pull the hand-
brake up or fully depress the brake pedal to
prevent the vehicle from rolling away.
If you allow the vehicle to roll when the en-
gine is not running, or with the selector lever
in position N, a lack of lubrication in the auto-
matic gearbox will damage it.
Kick-down feature
This feature allows maximum acceleration.
If you press the accelerator down thoroughly,
the g
e
arbo
x automatically changes down, de-
pending on speed and engine speed, into a
lower gear to take full advantage of give the
vehicle maximum acceleration.
The gearbox does not change gear until the
engine reaches the maximum determined en-
gine speed for the gear.
WARNING
You could lose control of the vehicle if you ac-
celer
ate on slippery road surfaces. Risk of se-
rious injury.
Be particularly careful when using the kick-
down features on slippery road surfaces. With
a fast acceleration, the vehicle could lose
traction and skid.
You should use the kick-down feature only
when traffic and weather conditions allow it
to be used safely.
Gearbox malfunctions
Gearbox: Fault! Stop the ve-
hicle and place the lever in the
position P.
There is
a fault in the gearbox. Stop the vehi-
cle in a safe place and do not continue driv-
ing. Seek specialist assistance.
Gearbox: System fault! You
may continue driving.
Have the fault corrected by a specialised
workshop w
ithout delay.
Gearbox: System fault! You
can continue driving with re-
strictions. Reverse gear disa‐
bled
Take the vehicle to a specialised workshop
and have the fault repaired without delay.
Gearbox: System fault! You
can continue driving in D until
switching off the engine
Stop the vehicle in a safe place well away
from moving traffic. Seek specialist assis-
tance.
Gearbox: too hot. Adapt your
driving accordingly
Continue driving at moderate speeds. When
the warning lamp switches off, you can con-
tinue driving in a normal manner.
Gearbox: press the brake and
engage a gear again.
If the fault was caused by a gearbox with a
high temperature, this driver message will be
displayed when the gearbox has cooled
again.
164
background
Driving
Run-in and economical driving
R
u
nnin
g in a new engine
The engine needs to be run in over the first
1,500 km.
Up to 1000 k
ilometres
Do not drive at speeds of more than 2/3
the maximum speed.
Do not accelerate hard.
Avoid high engine revolutions.
Do not tow a trailer.
From 1000 to 1500 k
ilometres (600 to 900
miles)
Speeds can be gradually increased to the
maximum road speed or maximum permis-
sible engine speed (rpm).
During its first few hours of running, the in-
ternal friction in the engine is greater than
later on, when all the moving parts have bed-
ded in.
For the sake of the environment
If the engine is run in gently, its life will be in-
cre
ased and its oil consumption reduced.
Tyre and brake pad run-in
New tyres should be run-in carefully for the
first
500 km (300 miles). New brake pads
should be run-in carefully for the first
200 km.
During the first 200 km, you can compensate
for the reduced braking effect by applying
more pressure to the brake pedal. In case of
a sharp braking, the braking distance will be
longer with new brake pads than with brake
pads which have been run-in.
WARNING
At firs
t, new tyres do not give maximum
grip, and require running-in. This may cause
an accident. Drive particularly carefully in the
first 500 km.
New brake pads must be “run in” and do
not have the correct friction properties during
the first 200 km. However, the reduced brak-
ing capacity may be compensated by press-
ing on the brake pedal a little harder.
Environmental compatibility
Environmental protection is a top priority in
the de
s
ign, c
hoice of materials and manufac-
ture of your new SEAT.
Constructive measures to encourage recy-
cling
Joints and connections designed for easy
dismantling
Modular construction to facilitate disman-
tling
Increased use of single-grade materials.
Plastic parts and elastomers are marked in
accordance with ISO 1043, ISO 11469 and
ISO 1629.
Choice of materials
Use of recycled materials.
Use of compatible plastics in the same part
if its components are not easily separated.
Use of recycled materials and/or materials
originating from renewable sources.
Reduction of volatile components, includ-
ing odour, in plastic materials.
Use of CFC-free coolants.
Ban on heavy metals, with the exceptions
dictated by law (Annex II of ELV Directive
2000/53/EC): cadmium, lead, mercury, hexa-
valent chromium.
Manufacturing methods
Reduction of the quantity of thinner in the
protective wax for cavities.
Use of plastic film as protection during ve-
hicle transport.
»
165
Technical dataAdviceOperationEmergenciesSafety
background
Operation
U
se of
so
lvent-free adhesives.
Use of CFC-free coolants in cooling sys-
tems.
Recycling and energy recovery from resi-
dues (RDF).
Improvement in the quality of waste water.
Use of systems for the recovery of residual
heat (thermal recovery, enthalpy wheels,
etc.).
The use of water-soluble paints.
Catalytic converter
To maintain the useful life of the catalytic
c
on
v
erter
Use only unleaded petrol with petrol en-
gines, as lead damages the catalytic con-
verter.
Do not let the fuel get too low in the tank.
For engine oil changes, do not replenish
with too much engine oil
page 206, Top-
ping up engine oil.
Never tow the vehicle to start it, use jump
leads if necessary
page 52.
If you notice misfiring, uneven running or
loss of power when the vehicle is moving, re-
duce speed immediately and have the vehi-
cle inspected at the nearest specialised
workshop. In general, the exhaust warning
lamp will light up when any of the described
symptoms occur ›› page 100. If this hap-
pens, unburnt fuel can enter the exhaust sys-
tem and escape into the environment. The
catalytic converter can also be damaged by
overheating.
WARNING
The catalytic converter reaches very high
temperat
ures! Risk of fire!
Never park where the catalytic converter
could come into contact with dry grass or
flammable materials under the vehicle.
Do not apply additional underseal or anti-
corrosion coatings to the exhaust pipes, cata-
lytic converter or the heat shields on the ex-
haust system. These materials could catch
fire when the vehicle is being driven.
CAUTION
Never run the fuel tank completely dry be-
cause the irr
egularity of the fuel supply may
cause ignition problems. This allows unburnt
fuel to enter the exhaust system, which could
cause overheating and damage the catalytic
converter.
For the sake of the environment
Even when the emission control system is
workin
g perfectly, there may be a smell of
sulphur from the exhaust gas under some
conditions. This depends on the sulphur con-
tent of the fuel used. Quite often the problem
can be solved by changing to another brand
of fuel
.
Diesel engine particulate filter*
Fig. 173 Vehicle data sticker on back cover of
the M
aint
en
ance Programme.
Your vehicle is fitted with a DPF (Diesel Partic-
u
l
at
e Filter) if the vehicle data sticker (back
cover of the “Maintenance Programme”) lists
the code PR 7GG Fig. 173.
The diesel engine particulate filter eliminates
most of the soot from the exhaust gas sys-
tem. Under normal driving conditions, the fil-
ter cleans itself. If this is not possible (for ex-
ample, multiple short trips) the filter will be
obstructed by soot and the diesel engine
particulate filter warning lamp will light up.
This does not represent a fault, it is a warning
that indicates that the filter has not been
able to regenerate automatically and that you
166
background
Driving
must perform a cleaning cycle, as indicated
in
page 101.
WARNING
The diesel en
gine particulate filter may
reach extremely high temperatures; the vehi-
cle should be parked so that the exhaust pipe
does not come into contact with flammable
materials underneath the vehicle. Otherwise
there is a risk of fire.
CAUTION
Your v
ehicle is not designed to use biodie-
sel fuel. Never, under any circumstances re-
fuel with biodiesel. The use of biodiesel fuel
could damage the engine and the fuel sys-
tem. The addition of biodiesel to diesel by
the diesel producer in accordance with stand-
ard EN 590 is authorised and will not cause
damage to the engine or the fuel system.
Using diesel fuel with a high sulphur con-
tent may significantly reduce the useful life of
the diesel particulate filter. Your Technical
Service will be able to tell you which coun-
tries have diesel with a high sulphur content.
Ecological and environmentally-
friendly
driv
in
g
Fuel consumption, environmental pollution
and w
e
ar t
o the engine, brakes and tyres de-
pends in large part on your driving style. By
adopting an economical driving style and an-
ticipating the traffic situation ahead, you can
easily reduce fuel consumption by 10-15%.
Some tips on how to help you reduce pollu-
tion while saving money are listed below.
Active cylinder management (ACT
®
)
Depending on the equipment, the vehicle
may have active cylinder management
(ACT
®
).
The active cylinder management (ACT
®
) may
automatically deactivate some of the engine
cylinders if the driving situation does not re-
quire too much power. When it is switched
off, no fuel is injected into these cylinders,
hence total fuel consumption may be re-
duced. The number of active cylinders can be
seen on the instrument panel display
page 30.
Drive anticipating the traffic situation
A vehicle uses most fuel when accelerating.
When you anticipate situations, you have to
brake less often and, thus, accelerate less. If
it is possible, let the vehicle roll with a gear
engaged, for example, if you see a red light
ahead. The braking effect achieved in this
way helps to reduce the wear of brakes and
tyres; emissions and fuel consumption are
reduced to zero (disconnection due to iner-
tia).
Change gear early to save energy
An effective way of saving fuel is to change
up quickly through the gears. Running the
engine at high rpm in the lower gears uses
an unnecessary amount of fuel.
Manual gearbox: shift up from first to second
gear as soon as possible. We recommend
that, whenever possible, you change to a
higher gear upon reaching 2000 rpm. Follow
the “recommended gear” indication that ap-
pears on the instrument panel page 159.
Avoid driving at high speed
We advise you not to drive at the top speed
permitted by the vehicle. Fuel consumption,
exhaust emissions and noise levels all in-
crease very rapidly at higher speeds. Driving
at moderate speeds will help to save fuel.
Avoid idling
It is worthwhile switching off the engine
when waiting in a traffic jam, at level cross-
ings or at traffic lights with a long red phase.
The fuel saved after only 30 - 40 seconds is
greater than the amount of fuel needed to re-
start the engine.
The engine takes a long time to warm up
when it is idling. Mechanical wear and pollu-
tant emissions are also especially high dur-
ing this initial warm-up phase. It is therefore
best to drive off immediately after starting
»
167
Technical dataAdviceOperationEmergenciesSafety
background
Operation
the engine. Avoid running the engine at high
s
peed.
P
eriodic
maintenance
Periodic maintenance work guarantees that,
before beginning a journey, you will not con-
sume more than the required amount of fuel.
A well-serviced engine gives you the benefit
of improved fuel efficiency as well as maxi-
mum reliability and an enhanced resale val-
ue.
A badly serviced engine can consume up to
10% more fuel than necessary.
Avoid short journeys
To reduce the consumption and emission of
polluting exhaust gases, the engine and the
exhaust gas filtration systems should reach
the optimum operating temperature.
With the engine cold, fuel consumption is
proportionally higher. The engine does not
warm up and fuel consumption does not nor-
malise until having driven approximately four
kilometres (2.5 miles). This is why we recom-
mend avoiding short trips whenever possi-
ble.
Maintain the correct tyre pressures
Bear in mind that keeping the tyres at an ad-
equate pressure saves fuel. If the tyre pres-
sure is just one bar (14.5 psi/100 kPa) too
low, fuel consumption can increase by as
much as 5%. Due to the greater rolling resist-
ance, under-inflation also increases tyre wear
wear and impairs handling.
The tyre pressures should always be checked
when the tyres are cold.
Do not use winter tyres all year round as they
increase fuel consumption by up to 10%.
Avoid unnecessary weight
Given that every kilo of extra weight will in-
crease the fuel consumption, it is advisable
to always check the luggage compartment to
make sure that no unnecessary loads are be-
ing transported.
A roof rack is often left in place for the sake
of convenience, even when it is no longer
needed. At a speed of 100 km/h (62 mph)
and 120 km/h (75 mph) your vehicle will use
about 12% more fuel as a result of the extra
wind resistance caused by the roof rack even
when it is not in use.
Save electricity
The engine activates the alternator, which
produces electricity. With the need for elec-
tricity, fuel consumption also increases. Be-
cause of this, always turn off electrical devi-
ces when you do not need them. Examples of
devices that use a lot of electricity are: the
blower at high speeds, the rear window heat-
ing or the seat heaters*.
Note
If y
our vehicle has Start-Stop, it is not rec-
ommended that you switch this function off.
It is recommended that you close the win-
dows when driving at more than 60 km/h
(37 mph)
Do not drive with your foot resting on the
clutch pedal,, as the pressure can make the
plate spin, more fuel will be used and it can
burn the clutch plate lining, causing a serious
fault.
Do not hold the car on a hill with the clutch,
use the foot brake or hand brake, using the
latter to start. The fuel consumption will be
lower and you will prevent the clutch plate
from being damaged.
On descents, use the engine brake, chang-
ing to the gear that is more suitable for the
slope. Fuel consumption will be “zero” and
the brakes will not suffer.
Driving abroad
To drive abroad, the following must be taken
int
o c
on
sideration:
For vehicles fitted with a catalytic converter
ensure that unleaded petrol is available for
the journey. See the chapter “Refuelling”. Au-
tomobile organisations will have information
about service station networks selling unlea-
ded fuel.
168
background
Driver assistance systems
In some c
ou
ntrie
s, it is possible that your
car model is not sold, and therefore some
spare parts are not available or the technical
services may only be able to carry out limited
repairs.
SEAT importers and distributors will gladly
provide information about the technical prep-
aration that your vehicle requires and also
about necessary maintenance and repair
possibilities.
Adhesive strips for headlights
In countries where vehicles drive on the other
side of the road to your home country, the
asymmetric dipped beam may dazzle drivers
of oncoming vehicles.
To prevent dazzling, you must apply stickers
to certain parts of the headlight lenses. Fur-
ther information is available at any Technical
Service.
In vehicles with adaptive headlights, the ro-
tation system must previously be disconnec-
ted. To do this, please go to a specialised
workshop.
Driver assistance systems
Br
ak
in
g and stability systems
Connecting/disconnecting ESC and
ASR
The ESC is switched on automatically when
the engine is
started, and only works when
the engine is running and includes the ABS,
EDS and ASR systems.
The ASR and ESC function should only be
switched off in situations in which traction is
insufficient, among others:
When driving in deep snow or on surfaces
that ar
e not very firm.
To “free” the vehicle if it gets stuck.
Then switch the ASR and ESC function back
on.
Depending on finishes and versions, it is
possible either to disconnect only the ASR or
else activate ESC Sport mode.
ESC in “Sport” mode
Sport mode can be connected via the Easy
Connect
page 107 system menu. The abili-
ty of the ESC to stabilise the vehicle is limi-
ted; the traction control system (ASR) be-
comes disabled
.
The control lamp lights
up
. F
or vehicles
with a driver information system*, the driver
will be shown the electronic stability
control (ESC) option: sport.
Warning! Limited stability.
Disable ESC “Sport” mode
Through the Easy Connect system menu
page 107. The warning lamp will switch
off. For vehicles with a driver information sys-
tem*, the driver will be shown the elec-
tronic stability control (ESC)
option: on.
Disable ASR
The Easy Connect system is used to switch off
the ASR page 107. The traction control sys-
tem will be disabled.
The control lamp lights up. For vehicles
with a driver information system* the driver
will be informed that ASR is disabled.
Activate ASR
The Easy Connect system ›› page 107 is used
to switch on the ASR. The traction control sys-
tem will be enabled.
The control lamp switches off. For vehicles
with a driver information system* the driver
will be informed that ASR is enabled.
Activate or deactivate the ASR or ESC func-
tion in the Easy
Connect system by means of
»
169
Technical dataAdviceOperationEmergenciesSafety
background
Operation
the button

and the function buttons
Set
up
and
E
SC
System
.
WARNING
You should switch on the ESC Sport mode on-
ly if the tr
affic conditions and your driving
ability allow you to do so safely: risk of skid-
ding!
With ESC in Sport mode, the stabilising
function will be limited to allow for a sportier
drive. The driving wheels could spin and the
vehicle could skid.
Note
If the ASR is disconnected or the ESC’s Sport
mode is sel
ected, cruise control* will be
switched off.
Electronic Stability Control (ESC)*
This Electronic Stability System reduces the
ri
sk
of
skidding and improves the vehicle's
stability and ability to hold the road.
The Electronic Stability Control (ESC) contains
the electronic differential lock (EDL) and the
traction control system (ASR). The ESC works
together with the ABS. Both control lamps
will light up if the ESC or ABS systems are
faulty.
The ESC system is started automatically
when the engine is started.
The ESC system is always active and cannot
be switched off. With the Easy Connect sys-
tem it is only possible to deactivate the ASR
or else select Sport mode.
The ASR can be deactivated when wheel spin
is desirable page 172.
For example:
When driving with snow chains.
When driving in deep snow or on loose sur-
faces.
When the vehicle is stuck, to rock it back-
wards and forwards.
Press the button to switch the ASR back on
when you no longer need wheel spin.
Electronic Stability Control (ESC)*
The ESC reduces the risk of skidding by brak-
ing the wheels individually.
The system uses the steering wheel angle
and road speed to calculate the changes of
direction desired by the driver, and constant-
ly compares them with the actual behaviour
of the vehicle. When irregularities occur, for
example, if the vehicle begins to skid, the
ESC brakes the appropriate wheel automati-
cally.
The forces acting on the braked wheel bring
the vehicle back to a stable condition. If the
vehicle tends to oversteer (the rear end
slides out), the system will act on the front
wheel on the outside of the turn.
WARNING
Do not for
get that the electronic stability
control ESC cannot defy the laws of physics.
This should be kept in mind, particularly on
slippery and wet roads and when towing a
trailer.
Always adapt your driving style to suit the
condition of the roads and the traffic situa-
tion. The greater safety provided by the ESC
should not encourage you to run any risks.
CAUTION
To ens
ure that the ESC works correctly, all
four wheels must be fitted with the same
tyres. Any differences in the rolling radius of
the tyres can cause the system to reduce en-
gine power when this is not desired.
Any modifications made to the vehicle (for
example, to the engine, brake system, run-
ning gear or to the combination of wheels
and tyres) may affect the operation of the
ABS, EDL, ESC and ASR.
Electronic differential lock (EDS)*
EDL helps the vehicle to start moving, accel-
er
at
e and c
limb a gradient in slippery condi-
tions where this may otherwise be difficult or
even impossible.
170
background
Driver assistance systems
It uses the ABS sensors to monitor the speed
of
the driv
en wheel
s. In case of an EDL fault,
the warning light for ABS lights up
page 102.
At speeds of up to approximately 80 km/h
(50 mph), it is able to balance out differences
in the speed of the driven wheels of approxi-
mately 100 rpm/min caused by a partially
slippery road surface. It does this by braking
the wheel which has lost traction and distrib-
uting more driving force to the other driven
wheel via the differential.
To prevent the disc brake of the braking
wheel from overheating, the EDL cuts out au-
tomatically if subjected to excessive loads.
The vehicle will continue to function normally
without EDL. For this reason, the driver is not
informed that the EDL has been switched off.
The EDL will switch on again automatically
when the brake has cooled down.
WARNING
When accel
erating on a slippery surface,
for example on ice and snow, press the accel-
erator carefully. Despite EDL, the driven
wheels may start to spin. This could impair
the vehicle's stability.
Always adapt your driving style to suit road
conditions and the traffic situation. Do not let
the extra safety afforded by EDL tempt you in-
to taking any risks when driving, this can
cause accidents.
CAUTION
Modifications to the vehicle (e.g. to the en-
gine, the brake sy
stem, running gear or any
components affecting the wheels and tyres)
could affect the efficiency of the EDL
page 190.
Hydraulic Brake Assist (HBA)*
The function (Hydraulic Brake Assist HBA) is
only inc
luded in vehicles with ESC.
In an emergency, most drivers brake in time,
but not with maximum force. This results in
unnecessarily long braking distances.
This is when the brake assist system comes
into action. When pressing the brake pedal
rapidly, the assistant interprets it as an emer-
gency. It very quickly builds up the full brake
pressure so that the ABS can be activated
more quickly and efficiently, thus reducing
braking distance.
Do not reduce the pressure on the brake ped-
al, since the brake assist system switches off
automatically as soon as you release the
brake.
Automatic hazard warning lights activation
The brake lights flash automatically to indi-
cate that the vehicle is braking suddenly or in
an emergency situation. If the emergency
braking continues until the vehicle comes to
a standstill, the hazard warning lights will
then come on and the brak
e lights will re-
main on permanently from that moment. The
warning lights will automatically switch off
when the vehicle begins to move again or
when the "warning" light button is pressed.
WARNING
The risk of
accident is higher if you drive
too fast, if you do not keep your distance from
the vehicle in front, and when the road sur-
face is slippery or wet. The increased acci-
dent risk cannot be reduced by the brake as-
sist system.
The brake assist system cannot defy the
laws of physics. Slippery and wet roads are
dangerous even with the brake assist system!
Therefore, it is essential that you adjust your
speed to suit the road and traffic conditions.
Do not let the extra safety features tempt you
into taking any risks when driving.
Anti-lock brake system (ABS)
The anti-lock brake (ABS) system prevents
the wheel
s
fr
om locking during braking and
is an important part of the vehicle's active
safety system.
How the ABS works
If one of the wheels turns too slowly in rela-
tion to the vehicle's speed, and is close to
locking, the system will reduce the braking
»
171
Technical dataAdviceOperationEmergenciesSafety
background
Operation
pressure to this wheel. The driver is made
a
w
ar
e of this control process by a pulsating
of the brake pedal and audible noise. This is
a deliberate warning to the driver that one or
more of the wheels is tending to lock and the
ABS control function has intervened. In this
situation it is important to keep the brake
pedal fully depressed so the ABS can regu-
late the brake application. Do not “pump”.
If you brake hard on a slippery road surface,
the best possible control is retained as the
wheels do not lock.
However, ABS will not necessarily guarantee
shorter braking distances in all conditions.
Braking distance could even be further if you
brake on gravel or on fresh snow on a slip-
pery surface.
WARNING
The anti-lock br
ake system cannot defy the
laws of physics. Slippery and wet roads are
dangerous even with ABS! If you notice that
the ABS is working (to counteract locked
wheels under braking), you should reduce
speed immediately to suit the road and traffic
conditions. Do not let the extra safety fea-
tures tempt you into taking any risks when
driving.
The effectiveness of ABS is also determined
by the tyres fitted page 212.
If the running gear or brake system is modi-
fied, the effectiveness of the ABS could be se-
verely limited.
Traction control system (ASR)*
The traction control system prevents the driv-
en wheels fr
om spinning when the vehicle is
accelerating. This system always includes
ABS.
Description and operation of the traction
control system during acceleration (ASR
On front-wheel drive vehicles, the ASR sys-
tem intervenes, reducing engine power and
preventing the driven wheels from slipping
during acceleration. The system works in the
entire speed range in conjunction with ABS.
If a failure occurs in the ABS, the ASR will al-
so stop working.
TCS helps the car to start moving, accelerate
and climb a gradient in slippery conditions
where this may otherwise be difficult or even
impossible.
The ASR automatically switches on when the
engine is started. If necessary, it could be
connected or disconnected by means of the
Easy Connect system.
When the ASR is off, the warning lamp lights
up . The ASR should normally be left on.
Only in exceptional circumstances, when
wheel spin is required, can they be turned off
using the ESC button, for example:
With compact temporary spare wheel.
When using the snow chains.
When driving in deep s
now or on soft ter-
rain.
When the vehicle is bogged-down, to free it
“by rocking it.”
The ASR should be switched on again as
soon as possible.
WARNING
Remember that
not even the ASR can defy
the laws of physics. This should be kept in
mind, particularly on slippery and wet roads
and when towing a trailer.
Always adapt your driving style to suit the
condition of the roads and the traffic situa-
tion. The greater safety provided by the ASR
should not encourage you to run any risks.
CAUTION
To ens
ure that the ASR works correctly,
identical tyres should be fitted on all four
wheels. Any differences in the rolling radius
of the tyres can cause the system to reduce
engine power when this is not desired.
Any modifications made to the vehicle (for
example, to the engine, brake system, run-
ning gear or to the combination of wheels
and tyres) may affect the operation of the
ABS and ASR.
172
background
Driver assistance systems
Electronic differential lock (XDS)*
When taking a curve, the driveshaft differen-
tial mec
hanism allows the outer wheel to turn
at a higher speed than the inner wheel. In
this way, the wheel that is turning faster (out-
er wheel) receives less drive torque than the
inner wheel. This may mean that in certain
situations the torque delivered to the inner
wheel is too high, causing the wheels to
spin. On the other hand, the outer wheel is
receiving a lower drive torque than it could
transmit. This causes an overall loss of lateral
grip on the front axle, resulting in understeer
or “lengthening” of the trajectory.
The XDS system can detect and correct this
effect via the sensors and signals of the ESC.
Via the ESC, the XDS will brake the inside
wheel and counter the excess driving torque
of that wheel. This means that the driver's
desired trajectory is much more precise.
The XDS system works in combination with
the ESC and is always active, even when ASR
traction control is disconnected or the ESC is
in Sport mode.
Brake servo
The brake servo increases the pressure you
ap
p
ly
to the brake pedal. It works only when
the engine is running.
If the brake servo is not functioning, e.g. due
to a malfunction, or if the vehicle is being
towed, you will have to press the brake pedal
considerably harder to make up for the lack
of servo assistance.
WARNING
The braking distance can also be affected by
extern
al factors.
Never let the vehicle coast with the engine
switched off. Failure to follow this instruction
could result in an accident. The braking dis-
tance is increased considerably when the
brake servo is not active.
If the brake servo is not working, for exam-
ple when the vehicle is being towed, you will
have to press the brake pedal considerably
harder than normal.
Start-Stop System*
D
e
s
cription and operation
The Start-Stop function stops the engine
when the
v
ehic
le is stopped and starts it au-
tomatically when required.
Vehicles with a manual gearbox
When the vehicle is stopped, put it into
neutral and release the clutch pedal. The
engine will switch off. The warning lamp
will appear on the instrument panel dis-
play.
When the clutch pedal is pressed the en-
gine will start up again. The warning lamp
will switch off.
Vehicles with an automatic gearbox
Use the foot brake to bring the vehicle to a
stop and keep the brake pedal pressed
down with your foot. The engine will switch
off. The warning lamp will appear in the
display.
When you take your foot off the brake pedal
the engine will start up again. The warning
lamp will switch off.
Start-Stop function conditions
The driver seat belt must be buckled.
The bonnet must be closed.
The engine must be at operating tempera-
ture.
The steering wheel must be straight.
The vehicle must be on flat ground.
The vehicle must not be in reverse.
A trailer must not be connected.
The temperature of the interior must be
within the comfort limits (
A/C
button should
be sel
ect
ed).
The w
indscreen de-mist function must be
off.
»
173
Technical dataAdviceOperationEmergenciesSafety
background
Operation
If
in an inc
r
ease in airflow is not requested.
The temperature must not be set to HI or
LO.
The driver door must be closed.
The diesel particulate filter must not be in
regeneration mode, for diesel engines.
The battery charge must not be low for the
next start.
Battery temperature must be between -1°C
(+30°F) and +55°C (+131°F).
Start-Stop function interruption
In the following situations, the Start-Stop
function will be interrupted and the engine
will automatically start:
The vehicle starts moving.
The brake pedal is pressed several times in
a row.
The battery has been discharged excessive-
ly.
The Start-Stop System is manually deacti-
vated.
The windscreen de-mist function is turned
on.
The temperature of the interior exceeds the
comfort limits (
A/C
button).
If the airflow is increased by more than 3
pr
e
s
ses.
Temperature setting HI or LO is selected.
The engine coolant temperature is insuffi-
cient.
The alternator is faulty, for example the V-
belt has ruptured.
If any of the conditions described in the
previous section are not fulfilled.
When the engine is turned off by the Start-
Stop function, this is displayed on the instru-
ment panel.
If the Start-Stop system is not switched on,
the warning lamp will appear on the instru-
ment panel.
WARNING
Never allow the vehicle to move with the en-
gine off for an
y reason. You could lose control
of your vehicle. This could cause an accident
and serious injury.
The brake servo does not work with the en-
gine off. You need more force to stop the vehi-
cle.
Power steering does not work when the en-
gine is not running. That is why it is much
more difficult to turn the steering wheel.
Turn off the Start-Stop system when driving
through water (fording streams, etc.).
Note
For v
ehicles with the Start-Stop function
and a manual gearbox, when the engine is
started, the clutch must be pressed.
When the conditions
for the Start-Stop
function are not fulfilled, the instrument pan-
el displays the Start-Stop indicator dimmed.
If the steering wheel is turned more than
270°, it will not be possible to start the vehi-
cle again. To start the vehicle, straighten the
steering wheel so that it is turned less than
270°.
There are different versions of the dash
panel; the display of indications on the
screen may differ.
Activating and deactivating the Start-
St
op f
u
nction
Fig. 174 The Start-Stop function button.
Every time the ignition is switched on, the
St
ar
t
-Stop function is automatically activa-
ted.
174
background
Driver assistance systems
Manually deactivating the Start-Stop func-
tion
Press the
Fig. 174
b
utton located on
the centre console. When the Start-Stop
function is switched off, the warning lamp
comes on.
If the Start-Stop function is operating then
the engine starts immediately.
Switching the Start-Stop function on manual-
ly
Press the
Fig. 174
button located on
the centre console. The warning lamp will
switch off.
Tiredness detection (break rec-
ommendation)*
Introduction
table on page 2
The Tiredness detection informs the driver
when their driving behaviour shows signs of
fatigue.
WARNING
Do not let the comfort afforded by the Tired-
ness
detection system tempt you into taking
any risks when driving. Take regular breaks,
sufficient in length when making long jour-
neys.
The driver a
lways assumes the responsibil-
ity of driving to their full capacity.
Never drive if you are tired.
The system does not detect the tiredness of
the driver in all circumstances. Consult the in-
formation in the section page 176, System
limitations.
In some situations, the system may incor-
rectly interpret an intended driving manoeu-
vre as driver tiredness.
No warning is given in the event of the ef-
fect called microsleep!
Please observe the indications on the in-
strument panel and act as is necessary.
Note
Tirednes
s detection has been developed for
driving on motorways and well paved roads
only.
If there is a fault in the system, have it
checked by a specialised workshop.
Function and operation
Fig. 175 On the instrument panel display:
tir
edne
s
s detection symbol.
Tiredness detection determines the driving
beh
av
iour of
the driver when starting a jour-
ney, making a calculation of tiredness. This is
constantly compared with the current driving
behaviour. If the system detects that the driv-
er is tired, an audible warning is given with a
sound and an optic warning is shown with a
symbol and complementary message on the
instrument panel display ›› Fig. 175. The
message on the instrument panel display is
shown for approximately 5 seconds, and de-
pending on the case, is repeated. The system
stores the last message displayed.
The message on the instrument panel display
can be switched off by pressing the

button on the windscreen wiper lever or the
b
utt
on

on the multi function steering
wheel
page 25.
»
175
Technical dataAdviceOperationEmergenciesSafety
background
Operation
The message can be recalled to the instru-
ment
p
anel
display using the multifunction
display
page 25.
Conditions of operation
Driving behaviour is only calculated on
speeds above about 65 km/h (40 mph) up to
around 200 km/h (125 mph).
Switching on and off
Tiredness detection can be activated or deac-
tivated in the Easy Connect system with the
button

and the function button

page 107. A mark indicates that the ad-
ju
stment has been activated.
System limitations
The Tiredness detection has certain limita-
tions inherent to the system. The following
conditions can limit the Tiredness detection
or prevent it from functioning.
At speeds below 65 km/h (40 mph)
At speeds above 200 km/h (125 mph)
When cornering
On roads in poor condition
In unfavourable weather conditions
When a sporty driving style is employed
In the event of a serious distraction to the
driver
Tiredne
ss detection will be restored when the
vehicle is stopped for more than 15 minutes,
when the ignition is switched off or when the
driver has unbuckled their seat belt and
opened the door.
In the event of slow driving during a long pe-
riod of time (below 65 km/h (40 mph) the
system automatically re-establishes the tired-
ness calculation. When driving at a faster
speed the driving behaviour will be recalcula-
ted.
Parking aid
General information
Various systems are available to help you
when p
ark
in
g or manoeuvring in tight
spaces, depending on the equipment fitted
on your vehicle.
The rear parking aid is an audible assistant
that warns about obstacles located behind
the vehicle
page 177.
During parking, Parking System Plus assists
the driver by visually and audibly warning
them about obstacles detected in front and
behind the vehicle
page 178.
WARNING
Alwa
ys pay attention, also when looking
straight ahead, to traffic and the vehicle sur-
roundings. The assistance systems are not a
replacement for driver awareness. When in-
serting or removing the vehicle from a park-
ing space, or when performing similar ma-
noeuvres the driver always assumes the re-
sponsibility.
Adapt your speed and driving style at all
times to suit visibility, weather, road and traf-
fic conditions.
The ultrasound sensors have blind spots in
which obstacles and people are not regis-
tered. Pay special attention to children and
animals.
Always keep visual control of the vehicle
surroundings: use the rear vision mirrors for
additional help.
CAUTION
Parking Aid functions may be negatively af-
fected b
y different factors that may lead to
damage to the vehicle or its immediate sur-
rounds:
Under certain circumstances, the system
does not detect or display certain objects:
Objects such as chains, trailer draw bars,
fences, posts and thin trees.
Objects that are located above the sen-
sors, such as protrusions in a wall.
176
background
Driver assistance systems
Obj
ects with certain surfaces or struc-
tures, such as wire mesh fences or pow-
der snow.
Certain surfaces of objects and garments
do not reflect the ultrasound sensors' sig-
nals. The system cannot detect, at least cor-
rectly, these objects or people wearing such
clothes.
Ultrasound sensor signals may be affected
by external sound sources. In certain circum-
stances this may prevent them from detect-
ing people or objects.
Please note that low obstacles detected by
the system may no longer be registered by
the sensors as the car moves closer, so the
system will not give any further warning. In
certain circumstances, objects such as high
kerbs that could damage the bottom of the
vehicle are not detected either.
If the first warning from the Park Pilot is ig-
nored, the vehicle could suffer considerable
damage.
The knocks or damage on the radiator
grille, bumper, wheel arch and vehicle under-
body can adjust the orientation of the sen-
sors. This can affect the parking aid function.
Have the function checked by a specialised
workshop.
Note
In cert
ain situations, the system can give a
warning even though there is no obstacle in
the detected area, e.g:
with rough or c
obbled floors or ground
with long grass;
with external ultrasound sources, such as
cleaning vehicles or other vehicles;
In downpours, intense snow or dense ex-
haust gases;
if the registration plate (front or rear) is
not properly affixed to the bumper sur-
face;
or in locations such as the brow of a hill.
In order to guarantee good system opera-
tion, keep the ultrasound sensors clean, free
of snow or ice, and do not cover them with
adhesives or other objects.
If you use high-pressure or vapour equip-
ment to clean the ultrasound sensors, apply
it directly only very briefly and always from a
distance of more than 10 cm.
Retrofitting of accessories to the vehicle,
such as a bicycle carrier, may interfere with
the operation of the Parking Aid.
In order to familiarise yourself with the sys-
tem, it is advised that you practice parking in
an area or car park that is free from traffic.
There must be good weather and light condi-
tions.
The volume and tone of the warnings can
be modified, in addition to the indications
page 180.
In vehicles without a driver information
system, these parameters can be modified in
a SEAT Official Service or in a specialised
workshop.
Plea
se observe information on towing a
trailer page 181.
The display on the Easy Connect screen
shows a slight time delay.
Rear parking aid*
The rear Parking Aid assists the driver in
parkin
g by means of audible warning
sounds.
Description
There are sensors integrated in the rear
bumper. When the sensors detect an obsta-
cle, you are alerted by audible warnings.
Make particularly sure that the sensors are
not covered by adhesives, residues and the
like, as this could affect the system's opera-
tion. Cleaning instructions page 194.
The approximate measurement range of the
rear sensors is:
side area 0.60 m
central area 1.60 m
As you approach the obstacle, the time inter-
v
al
betw
een the audible warnings will be re-
duced. When you reach around 0.30 m the
warning will be constant: Do not continue to
move forward (or backward)
in General
»
177
Technical dataAdviceOperationEmergenciesSafety
background
Operation
information on page 176,
in General
inf
orm
ation on p
age 176 !
If you maintain separation from the obstacle,
the volume of the warning begins to reduce
after four seconds (does not affect the tone
of the constant warning).
Activating/Deactivating
When engaging reverse gear, the parking aid
is automatically switched on. This is con-
firmed with a short warning.
On disengaging reverse gear, the Parking Aid
system is disconnected immediately.
Parking system plus*
Fig. 176 Represented area.
Parking system plus assists you audibly and
v
i
s
ually when parking.
There are sensors integrated in the front and
rear bumpers. When they detect an obstacle,
you are alerted by audible warnings and visu-
ally on the Easy Connect system.
In the event of danger of a frontal collision,
the audible warnings come from the front of
the vehicle, and in the event of the danger of
a rear-end collision they come from the rear.
Make particularly sure that the sensors are
not covered by adhesives, residues and the
like, as this could affect the system's opera-
tion. Cleaning instructions page 194.
The approximate measurement range of the
sensors is:
1.20 m
0.60 m
1.60 m
0.60 m
As you approach the obstacle, the time inter-
val between the audible warnings will be re-
duced. When you reach around 0.30 m the
warning will be constant: do not continue to
move forward (or backward)!
If you maintain separation from the obstacle,
the volume of the warning begins to reduce
after four seconds (does not affect the tone
of the constant warning).
A
B
C
D
Parking Aid operation
Fig. 177 Centre console: parking aid button.
Manual connection of Parking Aid
Press the
b
utt
on
once.
Manual disconnection of Parking Aid
Press the
button again.
Manual disconnection of Parking Aid display
(the audible sounds remain active)
Press a button on the main menu of the fac-
tory-assembled infotainment system.
OR: press the BACK function button.
Automatic connection of Parking Aid
Engage reverse gear or turn the selector
lever to position R.
OR: If the vehicle approaches an obstacle
that is in its forwards path at a speed below
178
background
Driver assistance systems
10 km/h (6 mph)
page 179, Automatic ac-
tivation. The obstacle is detected as of a dis-
tance of approx. 95 cm if the automatic con-
nection is activated in the infotainment sys-
tem. A reduced display is shown.
Automatic disconnection of Parking Aid
Move the selector lever to position P.
OR: accelerate to more than approx.
10 km/h (6 mph) forward.
Temporary suppression of sound in Parking
Aid
Press the function button found on the
steering wheel.
Change from reduced view to full view
Engage reverse gear or turn the selector
lever to position R.
OR: press the car icon in reduced view.
If necessary, switch to the rear-assist image
(Rear View Camera “RVC”)
Engage reverse gear or turn the selector
lever to position R.
OR: Press the RVC function button.
A short confirmation signal will be heard and
the button symbol will light up yellow when
the system is switched on.
Automatic activation
Fig. 178 Miniature indication of automatic ac-
tiv
ation
When the Parking System Plus is switched on
aut
om
atic
ally, a miniature of the vehicle will
be displayed and the segments will be
shown on the left side of the screen
Fig. 178.
Automatic activation occurs when slowly ap-
proaching an obstacle located in front of the
vehicle. It only operates every time the speed
is reduced below approximately 10 km/h (6
mph) for the first time.
If the parking aid is switched off using the
button, the following actions must be carried
out in order for it to automatically switch on:
Switch off the ignition and switch it on
again.
OR: accelerate above 10 km/h (6 mph) be-
fore reducing speed below this number
again.
OR: place the selector lever in position P
and then move it from this position.
OR: switch on and off the automatic activa-
tion in the Easy Connect system menu.
The automatic activation with parking aid
miniature indication can be switched on and
off from the Easy Connect system menu
page 24:
Switch the ignition on.
Select:
CAR
button > Settings > Parking
and manoeuvring.
Select the Automatic activation op-
tion.
When the f
u
nction button check box is
activated , the function is on.
If the system has been activated automatical-
ly, an audible sound warning will only be giv-
en when obstacles in front are at a distance
of less than 50 cm.
CAUTION
The automatic connection of the Parking Aid
only w
orks when you are driving slowly. If
driving style is not adapted to the circum-
stances, an accident and serious injury or
damage may be caused.
179
Technical dataAdviceOperationEmergenciesSafety
background
Operation
Segments of the visual indication
Fig. 179 Parking Aid display on the Easy Con-
nect
sy
s
tem screen.
The distance of separation from the obstacle
c
an be e
s
timated using the segments around
the vehicle.
The optical indication of the segments works
as follows:
a white segment is dis-
played when the obstacle is not within
the vehicle's trajectory or the direction
of travel is in the opposite direction to
its location, and it is more than 30 cm
from the vehicle.
obstacles located in the
vehicle's trajectory and which are more
than 30 cm away from the vehicle are
displayed in yellow.
obstacles that are less than
30 cm away from the vehicle are dis-
played in red.
White segments:
Yellow segments:
Red segments:
Moreover, with the SEAT Media System
Plus/Navi System radios, a yellow trail indi-
cates the vehicle's expected journey based
on the steering wheel angle.
Whenever the obstacle is located in the vehi-
cle’s direction of travel, the corresponding
audible warning will sound.
As the vehicle approaches an obstacle, the
segments are displayed closer to the vehicle.
When the penultimate segment is displayed,
this means that the vehicle has reached the
collision zone. In the collision zone, the ob-
stacles are represented in red, including
those out of the path. Do not continue to
move forward (or backward) ››
in General
inf
orm
ation on p
age 176,
in General in-
f
orm
ation on p
age 176 !
Adjusting the display and audible
warnings
The settings for the display and audible
w
arnin
g
s are controlled via the Easy Con-
nect*.
Automatic activation
on – activates the Automatic activa-
tion option
page 179.
off – deactivates the Automatic ac-
tivation option page 179.
Front volume*
Volume in the front and rear area.
Front sound settings/sharpness*
Frequency (tone) of the sound in the front
area.
Rear volume*
Volume in the rear area.
Rear sound settings/sharpness*
Frequency (tone) of the sound in the rear
area.
Adjust volume
With the parking aid switched on, the active
audio/video source volume will be reduced
to the intensity of the selected setting.
Error messages
When the Parking Aid is activated or when it
i
s
sw
itched on, if a message reporting a Park-
ing aid error is displayed on the instrument
panel, there is a fault in the system.
If the fault doesn't disappear before discon-
necting, next time that parking aid is engag-
ed in reverse, it will not be indicated.
180
background
Driver assistance systems
Parking System Plus*
If
ther
e i
s a fault in the parking aid system a
message will appear on the instrument panel
indicating the error. In addition the key
LED will blink.
If there is a fault in a sensor, the symbol is
displayed on the Easy Connect display in
front of/behind the vehicle. If a rear sensor is
faulty, only the obstacles in the areas
A
and
B
are displayed
Fig. 176. If a front sensor
is faulty, only the obstacles in the areas
C
and
D
are displayed.
Hav
e the f
au
lt corrected by a specialised
workshop without delay.
Towing bracket
In vehicles equipped with a towing bracket
dev
ic
e fr
om the factory, when the trailer is
connected electrically, the Parking Aid rear
sensors will not be activated when reverse
gear is engaged, when the selector lever is
turned to position R or when the button is
pressed.
Parking System Plus
The distance to possible obstacles at the rear
of the vehicle will not be displayed on the
screen and nor will it be indicated by means
of audible sound signals.
The Easy Connect system screen will only dis-
play objects detected at the front, and the ve-
hicle's trajectory will be hidden.
Rear Assist “Rear View Cam-
era”*
Operating and safety warnings
WARNING
The Rear As
sist does not make it possible
to precisely calculate the distance from ob-
stacles (people, vehicles, etc.) and nor can it
overcome the system's own limits, hence us-
ing it may cause serious accidents and inju-
ries if used negligently or without due care.
The driver should be aware of his/her sur-
roundings at all times to ensure safe driving.
The camera lens expands and distorts the
field of vision and displays the objects on the
screen in a different, vague manner. The per-
ception of distances is also distorted by this
effect.
Some objects may, due to the resolution of
the display screen - not be displayed in a sat-
isfactory manner or may not be displayed at
all. Take special care with thin posts, fences,
railings or trees that might not be displayed
on screen and could damage the vehicle.
The rear assist has blind spots where it is
not possible to represent people or objects
(small children, animals and certain objects
cannot be detected in its field of vision). Mon-
itor the v
ehicle's surrounding area at all
times.
Keep the camera lens clean, free of ice and
snow, and do not cover it.
The system is not a replacement for driver
awareness. Supervise the parking operation
at all times, as well as the vehicle's surround-
ing area. Adapt your speed and driving style
at all times to suit visibility, weather, road
and traffic conditions.
Do not be distracted from the traffic by
looking at the screen.
The images on the rear assist screen are
only two-dimensional. Due to a lack of spatial
depth, protruding parts or holes in the road,
for example, are more difficult to detect or
may not be seen at all.
Vehicle load modifies the representation of
the orientation lines displayed. The width
represented by the lines diminishes with ve-
hicle load. Pay special attention to the vehi-
cle's surroundings when the inside of the ve-
hicle of the luggage compartment is carrying
a heavy load.
In the following situations, the objects or
other vehicles shown in the navigation sys-
tem display appear to be further away or
closer than they really are: Pay special atten-
tion:
On moving from a horizontal plane to a
slope.
On moving from a slope to a horizontal
plane.
»
181
Technical dataAdviceOperationEmergenciesSafety
background
Operation
If the v
ehicle is heavily loaded at the
rear.
When the vehicle approaches objects
that are not on the ground surface or are
jutting out from it. These objects may al-
so be outside the camera's angle of vi-
sion when reversing.
Note
It
is
important to take great care and pay
special attention if you are not yet familiar
with the system.
Rear assist will not be available if the vehi-
cle's rear lid is open.
Instructions for use
Fig. 180 On the rear bumper: location of the
r
e
ar a
ssist camera
table on page 2
A camera on the rear bumper aids the driver
during rev
erse parking or manoeuvring
Fig. 180. The camera image is viewed to-
gether with orientation lines projected by the
system on the Infotainment system screen.
The bottom of the screen displays part of the
bumper corresponding to the registration
plate area that will be used as reference by
the driver.
Rear assist settings:
Rear assist offers the user the possibility to
change the image's brightness, contrast and
colour settings.
To change these settings:
Park the vehicle in a safe place.
Apply the parking brake.
Switch the ignition on.
If necessary, switch on the Infotainment
system.
Engage reverse gear or turn the selector
lever to position R.
Press the function button displayed on
the right of the image.
Make the desired adjustments on the menu
by pressing the /+ function buttons or by
moving the corresponding scroll button.
Necessary conditions for parking and ma-
noeuvring with the
The system should not be used in the follow-
ing cases:
If the image displayed is not very reliable or
is distorted, for example low visibility or dirty
lens.
If the area behind the vehicle is not dis-
played very clearly or is incomplete.
If the vehicle is heavily loaded at the rear.
If the position and installation angle of the
camera have been changed, e.g. after a rear-
end collision. Have the system checked by a
specialised workshop.
Familiarising yourself with the system
To familiarise yourself with the system, the
orientation lines and their function, SEAT rec-
ommends practising parking and manoeu-
vring with the rear assist in a place without
too much traffic or in a car park when there
are good weather and visibility conditions.
Cleaning the camera lens
Keep the camera lens clean and clear of snow
and ice:
Moisten the lens using a normal alcohol-
based glass cleaning product and clean the
lens with a dry cloth.
Remove snow using a small brush.
182
background
Driver assistance systems
U
se de-ic
in
g spray to remove any ice.
CAUTION
Never use abr
asive cleaning products to
clean the camera lens.
Do not use hot or warm water to remove ice
or snow from the camera lens. Doing so could
damage the camera.
Parking and manoeuvring with the
rear a
ssist
Fig. 181 Display on the Infotainment system
s
c
r
een: orientation lines.
Switching the system on and off
The rear assist will switch on when the igni-
tion i
s
on or the en
gine running, on engaging
reverse gear (manual gearbox) or on chang-
ing the selector lever to the R position (auto-
matic gearbox).
The system switches off 8 seconds after
disengaging reverse gear (manual gearbox)
or removing the selector lever from the R po-
sition (automatic gearbox). The system will
also disconnect immediately after the igni-
tion is switched off.
The camera will stop transmitting images
above the speed of 15 km/h (9 mph) with re-
verse engaged.
In combination with the Parking System Plus
page 176, the camera image will cease to
be transmitted immediately when reverse
gear is disengaged or when the selector lever
is moved from the R position, and the optical
information provided by the Parking Aid sys-
tem will be displayed.
Also in combination with the system, the rear
assist image can also be concealed:
By pressing one of the Infotainment system
buttons on the display.
OR: By pressing the miniature vehicle that
appears on the left of the screen (which
switches to the full-screen mode of the Park-
ing System Plus's optical system).
If you wish to display the rear assist image
again:
Disengage reverse, or change the selector
lever's position, engage reverse again or
move the selector lever to position R.
OR: Press the RVC function button
1)
Meaning of the orientation lines
Fig. 181
Side lines: extension of the vehicle (the
approximate width of the vehicle plus the
rear view mirrors) on the road surface.
End of the side lines: the area marked in
green ends approximately 2 m behind
the vehicle on the road surface.
Intermediate line: indicates a distance of
approximately 1 m behind the vehicle on
the road surface.
Red horizontal line: indicates a safe dis-
tance of approximately 40 cm at the rear
of the vehicle on the road surface.
»
1
2
3
4
1)
WARNING: the RVC (Rear
View Camera) function
button will only be activated and available when the
reverse gear is engaged or the selector lever is set to
position R.
183
Technical dataAdviceOperationEmergenciesSafety
background
Operation
Parking manoeuvre
Place the vehicle in front of the parking
s
p
ac
e and engage reverse gear (manual
gearbox) or move the selector to the R posi-
tion (automatic gearbox).
Reverse slowly, and turn the steering wheel
so that the side orientation lines lead to-
wards the parking space.
Guide the vehicle into the parking space so
that the side orientation lines run parallel to
it.
Cruise speed* (cruise control -
GRA)
Operation
Fig. 182 Turn signal and main beam head-
light
l
ev
er: switch and rocker switch for the
cruise control.
Read the additional information carefully
page 34
The CCS is able to maintain the set speed in
the range from approx. 30 km/h (19 mph) to
180 km/h (112 mph).
Once the speed setting has been saved, you
may take your foot off the accelerator.
When the cruise control is on and a speed is
programmed, the indicator on the instru-
ment panel* is lit.
If the cruise control system is switched off,
the symbol is switched off. The system will
also be switched off fully when the 1st gear
is engaged.*
Switching on the cruise control system
Move the switch Fig. 182
1
towards the
l
ef
t
to ON.
Setting speed
Briefly press the lower part of the rocker
switch SET– Fig. 182
2
once when you
h
av
e r
eached the speed you wish to set.
When you release the rocker switch, the cur-
rent speed is set and held constant.
Switching off the cruise control system
Move the control
1
towards the right to
OFF or t
urn the ignition off
if
the vehicle is
stationary.
WARNING
It could be dangerous to use the cruise con-
trol
system if it is not possible to drive at con-
stant speed.
Do not use the cruise control system when
driving in dense traffic, on roads with lots of
bends or on roads with poor conditions (with
ice, slippery surfaces, loose grit or gravel), as
this could cause an accident.
Always switch the cruise control system off
after using it in order to avoid involuntary
use.
It is dangerous to use a set speed which is
too high for the current road, traffic or weath-
er conditions. Risk of accident.
Note
The cruise control cannot maintain a constant
speed when des
cending downhill. It will in-
crease due to its own weight. Use the foot
brake to slow the vehicle.
Adjusting the stored speed*
The speed can be altered without touching
the ac
c
el
erator or the brake.
Setting a higher speed
Press the upper part of the rocker switch
RES+
Fig. 182
2
to increase the speed.
The
v
ehic
le will continue to accelerate as
184
background
Driver assistance systems
long as you keep the rocker switch pressed.
When
y
ou r
elease the switch, the new speed
is stored.
Setting a lower speed
Press the lower part of the rocker switch
SET– Fig. 182
2
to reduce the speed. The
v
ehic
l
e will automatically reduce its speed for
as long as you keep the switch pressed.
When you release the switch, the new speed
is stored.
When you increase speed with the accelera-
tor and then release the pedal, the system
will automatically restore the set speed. This
will not be the case, however, if the vehicle
speed exceeds the stored speed by more
than 10 km/h (6 mph) for longer than 5 mi-
nutes. The speed will have to be stored
again.
Cruise control is switched off if you reduce
speed by depressing the brake pedal. Reacti-
vate the control by pressing once on the up-
per part of the rocker switch RES+ Fig. 182
2
.
Temporary deactivation of cruise con-
tr
o
l*
The cruise control system will be switched off
in the f
o
l
lowing situations:
if the brake pedal is depressed,
if the clutch pedal is depressed,
if the vehicle is accelerated to over
180 km/h (112 mph),
when the lever
1
is moved in the direction
of
OFF w
ithout
being fully engaged.
To resume cruise control, release the brake or
clutch pedal or reduce the vehicle speed to
less than 180 km/h (112 mph) and press
once on the upper part of the rocker switch
RES+ Fig. 182
2
.
Complete system deactivation
Vehicles with a manual gearbox
The sy
s
t
em is completely turned off by mov-
ing the control ›› Fig. 182 1 -- all the way to
the right hand side (set into the OFF posi-
tion), or when the vehicle is stationary,
switching off the ignition.
Vehicles with an automatic gearbox
To completely disengage the system, the se-
lector lever must be placed in one of the fol-
lowing positions: P, N, R or 1 or with the vehi-
cle stopped and the ignition turned off.
“SEAT Drive Profile” system
Function and operation
Fig. 183 In the centre console: button to ad-
ju
s
t
the "SEAT Drive Profile" system
The “SEAT Drive Profile” system modifies the
s
u
s
pension system's characteristics and
power steering behaviour.
you can choose between 2 different settings
with different characteristics.
CONVEN-
IENCE
Balanced setting, suitable, e.g. for day-to-
day use.
SPORT
This gives the vehicle sporty characteristics
and is suitable for a sporty driving style.
Settings can be changed when the vehicle is
s
t
ation
ary or in movement. When a “SEAT
Drive Profile” setting is changed it is activa-
ted immediately.
»
185
Technical dataAdviceOperationEmergenciesSafety
background
Operation
Selecting the system setting
If necessary, switch on the ignition.
To select S
PORT mode, press the

Fig. 183 b
utt
on u
ntil it lights up.
The CONVENIENCE mode is active when the

button is not lit. The set mode remains
sel
ect
ed af
ter the ignition is switched off.
CUPRA vehicle version
The modes of operation for the CUPRA are
Normal and Sport rather than Comfort and
Sport. The vehicle always starts up in Nor-
mal. The last selection does not remain once
the vehicle is turned off.
WARNING
Adjusting the “SEAT Drive Profile” modifies
driving pr
operties. The “SEAT Drive Profile”
system should never encourage you to take
risks.
Adapt your speed and driving style at all
times to suit visibility, weather, road and traf-
fic conditions.
WARNING
If the warning lamps and the corresponding
mess
ages are ignored when they light up, the
vehicle may stall in traffic and cause acci-
dents and severe injuries.
Never ignore the warning lamps or messag-
es.
Stop the v
ehicle at the next opportunity
and in a safe place.
CAUTION
Failure to heed the control lamps and corre-
s
ponding t
ext messages when they light up
may result in damage to the vehicle.
Note
If the “SEAT Drive Profile” system presents a
fault, the
symbol appears on the instrument
panel, with the message Fault: Damping
setting.
Indication on the display and warning
l
amp
There is a fault in the “SEAT Drive Pro-
file” suspension.
See a specialised workshop immediately and have the
“SEAT Drive Profile” suspension checked.
If the yellow warning lamp does not light up again after
the engine is restarted and the vehicle has travelled a
short distance, you do not need to take it to a special-
ised workshop.
Some warning and indication lamps will light
up briefly
when the ignition i
s
switched on to
check certain functions. They will switch off
after a few seconds.
WARNING
If the warning lamps and the corresponding
mess
ages are ignored when they light up, the
vehicle may stall in traffic and cause acci-
dents and severe injuries.
Never ignore the warning lamps or messag-
es.
WARNING
Changing the “SEAT Drive Profile” settings
while the
vehicle is in motion can distract you
from the road and lead to accidents.
CAUTION
Failure to heed the control lamps when they
light up and the corr
esponding messages
may result in damage to the vehicle.
Note
If the “SEAT Drive Profile” system does not
work a
s described in this chapter, have it
checked immediately by a specialised work-
shop.
186
background
Towing bracket device and trailer
Towing bracket device and
tr
ai
l
er
Driving with a trailer
What do you need to bear in mind
when towing a trailer?
Your vehicle may be used to tow a trailer
when fitted with the c
orrect equipment.
If the car is supplied with a factory-fitted tow-
ing bracket it will already have the necessary
technical modifications and meet the statuto-
ry requirements for towing a trailer. If you
wish to retrofit a towing bracket, consult
page 188.
Connectors
Your vehicle is fitted with a 12-pin connector
for the electrical connection between the
trailer and the vehicle.
If the trailer has a 7-pin plug you will need to
use an adapter cable. It is available at any
Technical Service.
Trailer weight/drawbar load
Never exceed the authorised trailer weight. If
you do not load the trailer up to the maxi-
mum permitted trailer weight, you can then
climb correspondingly steeper slopes.
The maximum trailer weights listed are only
applic
able for altitudes up to 1000 m above
sea level. With increasing altitude the engine
power and therefore the vehicle climbing
ability are impaired because of the reduced
air density. The maximum trailer weight has
to be reduced accordingly. The weight of the
vehicle and trailer combination must be re-
duced by 10% for every further 1000 m (or
part thereof). The gross combination weight
is the actual weight of the laden vehicle plus
the actual weight of the laden trailer. When
possible, operate the trailer with the maxi-
mum permitted drawbar load on the ball joint
of the towing bracket, but do not exceed the
specified limit.
The figures for trailer weights and drawbar
loads that are given on the data plate of the
towing bracket are for certification purposes
only. The correct figures for your specific
model, which may be lower than these fig-
ures for the towing bracket, are given in the
vehicle documentation or in ›› chapter Tech-
nical Data.
Distributing the load
Distribute loads in the trailer so that heavy
objects are as near to the axle as possible.
Loads carried in the trailer must be secured
to prevent them moving.
Tyre pressure
Set tyre pressure to the maximum permissi-
ble pressure shown on the sticker on the in-
side of the fuel tank flap. Set the tyre pres-
sure of the trailer tyres in accordance with the
trailer manufacturer's recommendations.
Exterior mirrors
Check whether you can see enough of the
road behind the trailer with the standard rear
vision mirrors. If this is not the case, you
should have additional exterior mirrors fitted.
Both exterior mirrors should be mounted on
hinged extension brackets. Adjust the mirrors
to give sufficient vision to the rear.
WARNING
Never transport people in a trailer. This could
res
ult in fatal accidents.
Note
Tow
ing a trailer places additional demands
on the vehicle. We recommend additional
services between the normal inspection inter-
vals if the vehicle is used frequently for tow-
ing a trailer.
Find out whether special regulations apply
to towing a trailer in your country.
187
Technical dataAdviceOperationEmergenciesSafety
background
Operation
Ball coupling of towing bracket*
The ball coupling is provided with instruc-
tions on fittin
g and removing the ball cou-
pling of the towing bracket.
WARNING
The towing bracket ball coupling must be
stor
ed securely in the luggage compartment
to prevent them being flung through the vehi-
cle and causing injury.
Note
By l
aw, the ball coupling must be removed
if a trailer is not being towed if it obscures
the number plate.
Driving tips
Driving with a trailer always requires extra
c
ar
e.
W
eight distribution
The weight distribution of a loaded trailer
with an unladen vehicle is very unfavourable.
However, if this cannot be avoided, drive ex-
tra slowly to allow for the unbalanced weight
distribution.
Speed
The stability of the vehicle and trailer is re-
duced with increasing speed. For this reason,
it is advisable not to drive at the maximum
permissible speed in an unfavourable road,
weather or wind conditions. This applies es-
pecially when driving downhill.
You should always reduce speed immediately
if the trailer shows the slightest sign of snak-
ing. Never try to stop the “snaking” by in-
creasing speed.
Always brake in due course. If the trailer has
an overrun brake, apply the brakes gently at
first and then, firmly. This will prevent the
jerking that can be caused by locking of trail-
er wheels. Select a low gear in due course
before going down a steep downhill. This en-
ables you to use the engine braking to slow
down the vehicle.
Reheating
At very high temperatures and during pro-
longed slopes, driving with a low gear and
high engine speed; always monitor whether
the excessive coolant temperature gauge is
activated page 106.
Retrofitting a towing bracket*
Fig. 184 IBIZA/IBIZA SC: attachment points
f
or t
o
wing bracket.
If a towing bracket is to be fitted after the ve-
hic
l
e i
s purchased, this must be completed
according to the instructions of the towing
bracket manufacturer.
188
background
Towing bracket device and trailer
The attachment points
A
for the towing
br
ac
k
et are underneath the vehicle.
The distance between the centre of the ball
coupling and the ground should never be
lower than the indicated value, even with a
fully loaded vehicle and including the maxi-
mum drawbar load.
Elevation values for securing the towing bracket:
IBIZA IBIZA SC IBIZA ST
B
65 mm (minimum)
C
350 mm to 420 mm (fully laden vehicle)
D
959 mm
E
438 mm 379 mm
F
209 mm 386 mm
Fitting a towing bracket
Driving with a trailer involves an extra effort
f
or the
v
ehicle. Therefore, before fitting a
towing bracket, please contact a Technical
Service to check whether your cooling system
needs modification.
The legal requirements in your country
must be observed (e.g. the fitting of a sepa-
rate control lamp).
Certain vehicle components, for example
the rear bumper, must be removed and rein-
stalled. The towing bracket securing bolts
must be tightened using a torque wrench,
and a power socket must be connected to the
vehicle electrical system. This requires speci-
alised knowledge and tools.
Figures in the illustration show the eleva-
tion value and the attachment points which
must be considered if you are retrofitting a
towing bracket.
WARNING
The towing brackets should be fitted at a spe-
cia
lised workshop.
If the towing bracket is incorrectly instal-
led, there is a serious danger of accident.
For your own safety, please observe the tow
bracket manufacturer's instructions.
CAUTION
If the pow
er socket is incorrectly installed,
this could cause damage to the vehicle elec-
trical system.
Note
SEAT r
ecommends that the towing hooks
be fitted at a specialised workshop. In certain
versions this may entail fitting a heat insulat-
ing plate, which is why it is recommended
that you go to a SEAT Dealer. In the event that
the plate is not installed correctly, SEAT is ex-
empt from any liability.
Due to the specific design of the exhaust,
the fitting of a conventional towing hook is
not recommended for some sportier versions.
Plea
se consult your Technical Service.
189
Technical dataAdviceOperationEmergenciesSafety
background
Advice
Advice
C
ar
e and m
aintenance
Accessories and modifications
to the vehicle
Accessories, replacement of parts and
modifications
Your vehicle is designed to offer a high
s
t
and
ard of active and passive safety.
Before purchasing accessories and parts,
and before making technical changes to your
vehicle, we recommend that you consult your
Technical Service.
SEAT dealerships will be happy to provide
you with the latest information about the
use, legal requirements and recommenda-
tions from the manufacturer regarding acces-
sories and spare parts.
We recommend you use only SEAT Approved
Accessories
®
and SEAT Approved Spare
Parts
®
. This way, SEAT can guarantee that
the product in question is suitable, reliable
and safe. SEAT Technical Services have the
necessary experience and facilities to ensure
that parts are correctly and professionally in-
stalled.
Despite a continuous observation of the mar-
ket, SEAT is not able to assess the reliability,
safety and suitability of parts that SEAT has
not approved. For this reason, SEAT cannot
assume responsibility for any non-genuine
parts used, even if these parts have been ap-
proved by an official testing agency or are
covered by an official approval certificate.
Any retro-fitted equipment which has a direct
impact on the driver's control of the vehicle,
such as a cruise control system or electroni-
cally-controlled suspension, must be ap-
proved by SEAT for use in your vehicle and
bear the e mark (the European Union's au-
thorisation symbol).
If any additional electrical devices are fitted
which do not serve to control the vehicle it-
self, such as refrigerator boxes, laptops or
ventilator fans, they must bear the CE mark
(European Union manufacturer conformity
declaration).
WARNING
Accessories, for example telephone holders
or cup hol
ders, should never be fitted on the
covers, or within the working range, of the
airbags. Otherwise, there is a danger of in-
jury if the airbag is triggered in an accident.
Modifications
Modifications must always be carried out ac-
cordin
g to our specifications. Unauthorised
modifications to the electronic components
or software in the vehicle may cause malfunc-
tions. Due to the way the electronic compo-
nents are linked together in networks, other
indirect systems may be affected by the
faults. This can seriously impair safety, lead
to excessive wear of components, and also
invalidate your vehicle registration docu-
ments.
SEAT Technical Services cannot be held liable
for any damage caused by modifications
and/or work incorrectly performed. For this
reason, we recommend having all work per-
formed by a SEAT Technical Service using
SEAT
®
Original Spare Parts.
WARNING
Any type of work or modification performed
incorrectly
on your vehicle can lead to mal-
functions and can cause accidents.
Roof aerial*
The vehicle can be fitted with a foldable* and
anti-thef
t* r
oof
aerial which can be folded
backwards, for example when going through
an automatic car wash.
190
background
Care and maintenance
To fold
Un
s
c
rew the aerial rod, tilting it backwards
into a horizontal position and then screw in
again.
To return to working position
Continue in the reverse order to the previous
instruction.
CAUTION
If an automatic car wash tunnel is used, be-
fore ent
ering the tunnel, put the aerial down
parallel to the roof and do not tighten to
avoid damage.
Mobile phones and two-way radios
SEAT has approved for your vehicle the use of
mo
b
i
le telephones and two-way radios pro-
viding under the following conditions:
The external aerial should be correctly in-
stalled.
The transmitting power should be a maxi-
mum 10 watts.
The optimal reach of the equipment is only
achieved with an external aerial.
First consult your Technical Service if you
wish to use a mobile telephone or a two-way
radio with a transmitting power output in ex-
cess of 10 watts. Here you will receive infor-
mation concerning the technical possibilities
for retrofitting this equipment.
Mobile telephones and two-way radios
should be only fitted by a specialised work-
shop, for example a SEAT dealership.
WARNING
Alwa
ys concentrate primarily on driving. If
you are distracted while driving you could
have an accident.
Never attach the telephone mountings to
the surfaces covering the airbag units or
within the range of the airbags. There is a
high danger of injury if the airbag is trig-
gered.
Using your mobile telephones or two-way
radios in the vehicle without an external aer-
ial, electromagnetic radiation in the vehicle
could exceed authorised limits. This also may
occur to external aerials that have not been
correctly installed.
CAUTION
Failure to consider the above-mentioned con-
ditions c
ould cause the electronics to mal-
function. The most common causes of faults
are:
no external aerial,
external aerial incorrectly installed,
transmitting power output in excess of 10
watts.
Note
Please observe the operating instructions of
your mob
ile telephone/two-way radio.
Care and cleaning
General
notes
Vehicle maintenance
Regu
lar care and washing help to maintain
the value of the vehicle. This may also be one
of the requirements for acknowledging war-
ranty claims in the event of bodywork corro-
sion or paint defects.
The best way to protect your vehicle against
the harmful effects of the environment is
through correct maintenance and frequent
washing. The longer substances such as in-
sect remains, bird droppings, resinous tree
sap, road dirt, industrial deposits, tar, soot or
road salt and other aggressive materials re-
main on the vehicle, the more damage they
do to the paintwork. High temperatures, for
instance in strong sunlight, further intensify
the corrosive effect.
After winter, a period when salt is put on the
roads, it is important to have the underside
of the vehicle washed thoroughly.
»
191
Technical dataAdviceOperationEmergenciesSafety
background
Advice
Products for vehicle maintenance
C
ar
-c
are products are available in your Tech-
nical Services. Keep the product instructions
until you have used them up.
WARNING
Car-c
are products can be toxic. Because of
this, they must always be kept closed in their
original container. Keep them out of the reach
of children. Failure to comply could result in
poisoning.
Always read and observe the instructions
and warnings on the package before using
car-care products. Improper use could cause
health problems or damage the vehicle. The
use of certain products may produce noxious
vapours; they should be used in well ventila-
ted areas.
Never use fuel, turpentine, engine oil, nail
varnish remover or other volatile fluids.
These are toxic and highly flammable. Risk of
fire and explosion.
Before washing your vehicle, or carrying
out any maintenance, switch the engine off,
apply the handbrake firmly and remove the
key from the ignition.
CAUTION
Never attempt to remove dirt, mud or dust if
the surf
ace of the vehicle is dry. Never use a
dry cloth or sponge for cleaning purposes.
This could damage the paintwork or the win-
dows of your vehicle. Soak dirt, mud or dust
with plenty of water.
For the sake of the environment
When purc
hasing car care products, try to
select ones that are not harmful to the envi-
ronment.
The waste from car-care products should
not be disposed of with ordinary household
waste. Observe the disposal information on
the package.
Care of the vehicle exterior
Automatic
car wash tunnel
The vehicle paintwork is so durable that the
v
ehic
l
e can normally be washed without
problems in an automatic car wash tunnel.
However, the paintwork wear depends to a
large extent on the kind of the car wash tun-
nel, the brushes used, its water filtering and
the type of cleaning and preservative prod-
ucts.
Before going through a car wash, be sure to
take the usual precautions such as closing
the windows and sunroof. There is nothing to
note apart from that.
If the vehicle has special accessories such as
spoilers or a roof rack or two-way radio aerial,
etc., it is advisable to consult the car wash
tunnel operator first.
After washing, the brakes could take some
time to respond as the brake discs and pads
could be wet, or even frozen in winter. “Dry”
the brakes by braking several times.
WARNING
Water, ice and salt on the brake system can
reduce br
aking effectiveness. Risk of acci-
dent.
CAUTION
Before putting the vehicle through the car
wash, do not
tighten the aerial if it is folded
because it can be damaged.
Hand-washing
Vehicle washing
First soften the dirt and rinse it off with wa-
t
er
.
C
lean your vehicle from top to bottom with
a soft sponge, a glove or a brush. Use very
light pressure.
Rinse the sponge or glove often with clean
water.
Special car shampoo should only be used
for very stubborn dirt.
Leave the wheels, sill panels etc. until last,
using a different sponge or glove.
192
background
Care and maintenance
Rin
se the
v
ehicle thoroughly with water.
Dry the vehicle surface gently with a cha-
mois leather.
In cold temperature, dry the rubber seals
and their surfaces to prevent them from
freezing. Apply silicone spray to the rubber
seals.
After washing the vehicle
After washing, avoid sudden and sharp
braking. “Dry” the brakes by braking sever-
al times.
WARNING
Wash
your vehicle with the ignition switch-
ed off.
Protect your hands and arms from cuts on
sharp metal edges when cleaning the under-
body, the inside of the wheel housings etc.
Risk of injury.
Water, ice and salt on the brake system can
reduce braking effectiveness. Risk of acci-
dent.
CAUTION
Never remo
ve dirt, mud or dust if the vehi-
cle surface is dry. Never use a dry cloth or
sponge for cleaning purposes. This could
scratch the paintwork or glass on your vehi-
cle.
Washin
g the vehicle in low temperatures:
when washing the vehicle with a hose, do not
direct water into the lock cylinders or the
gaps around the doors, rear lid, or sunroof.
Risk of freezing.
For the sake of the environment
To protect the environment, the vehicle
shou
ld be w
ashed only in specially provided
wash bays, to prevent toxic, oil-laden waste
water from entering the sewer system. In
some places, washing vehicles outside wash
bays is prohibited.
Note
Do not wash the vehicle in direct sunlight.
Washing the vehicle with a high pres-
s
ur
e c
leaner
Be particularly careful when using a high
pr
e
s
sure cleaner!
Always observe the instructions for the
high-pressure cleaner, particularly those
concerning the pressure and the spraying
distance.
Increase the spraying distance for soft ma-
terials and painted bumpers.
Do not use a high pressure cleaner to re-
move ice or snow from windows
page 194.
Never use concentrated jet nozzles (“rotat-
ing jets”)
.
After washing, avoid sudden and sharp
br
ak
in
g. “Dry” the brakes by braking sever-
al times page 156.
WARNING
Never wa
sh tyres with a concentrated jet
(“rotating nozzle”). Even at large spraying
distances and short cleaning times, damage
can occur to the tyres. This may cause an ac-
cident.
Water, ice and salt on the brake system can
reduce braking effectiveness. Risk of acci-
dent.
CAUTION
Do not use w
ater hotter than +60°C
(+140°F). This could damage the vehicle.
To avoid damage to the vehicle, keep a suf-
ficient distance from sensitive materials such
as flexible hoses, plastic, soundproofing ma-
terial, etc. This also applies to bumpers pain-
ted in the colour of the bodywork. The closer
the nozzle is to the surface, the greater the
wear on the material.
193
Technical dataAdviceOperationEmergenciesSafety
background
Advice
Sensors and camera lenses
Use a small brush to remove snow and a
de-icer spr
ay to remove ice.
Clean the sensors with a solvent-free prod-
uct and a soft, dry cloth.
Moisten the camera lens using a standard
alcohol-based glass cleaning agent and
clean the lens with a dry cloth.
CAUTION
When you c
lean the vehicle with a pressure
washer:
Stay a suitable distance from the sensors
on the front and rear bumpers.
Do not clean the camera lenses or sur-
rounding area with the pressure washer.
Never use warm or hot water to remove
snow and ice from the reverse camera lens,
as it could crack the lens.
Never use abrasive cleaning agents on the
lens.
Vehicle paint maintenance
Regular waxing protects the paintwork.
Y
ou need t
o ap
ply wax to your vehicle if water
does not form small drops and run off the
paintwork when it is clean.
Good quality hard wax products are available
at your Technical Service.
Regular wax applications help to protect the
paintwork from environmental contaminants
page 191. It is also effective in protecting
against minor scratches.
Even if a wax solution is used regularly in the
vehicle washing tunnel, it is advisable to pro-
tect the paint with a hard wax coating at least
twice a year.
Polishing the paintwork
Polishing is only necessary if the paint has
lo
s
t
its shine, and the gloss cannot be
brought back by applying wax. Polishing
products can be purchased in your Technical
Service.
The vehicle must be waxed after polishing if
the polish used does not contain wax com-
pounds to seal the paint page 194, Vehicle
paint maintenance.
CAUTION
To prevent damage to the paintwork:
Do not use polishes and hard wax on pain-
ted par
ts with a matt finish or on plastic
parts.
Do not polish your vehicle in a sandy or
dusty environment.
Caring for plastic parts
If normal washing fails to clean plastic parts,
cle
an them with approved solvent-free plas-
tic cleaning and care products.
CAUTION
The use of li
quid air freshener directly over
the air vents of the vehicle may damage the
plastic parts if the liquid is accidentally spil-
led.
Cleaning products which contain solvents
will damage the material.
Cleaning of windows and mirrors
Cleaning windows
Moisten the windows with commercially
av
ai
l
able, alcohol based glass cleaner.
Dry the windows with a clean chamois
leather or a lint-free cloth.
Removing snow
Use a small brush to remove snow from the
windows and mirrors.
Removing ice
Use a de-icer spray.
Use a clean cloth or chamois leather to dry
the windows. The chamois leathers used on
194
background
Care and maintenance
painted surfaces are not suitable to clean
w
indo
w
s because they are soiled with wax
deposits which could smear the windows.
If possible, use a de-icing spray to remove
ice. If you use an ice scraper, push it in one
direction only without swinging it.
Use window cleaner or a silicone remover to
clean rubber, oil, grease and silicone depos-
its off.
Wax deposits can only be removed with a
special cleaner available at your Technical
Service. Wax deposits on the windscreen
could cause the wiper blades to judder. Add-
ing a window cleaner that dissolves wax to
the windscreen washer fluid prevents wiper
blades from juddering, but wax deposits are
not removed.
CAUTION
Never use w
arm or hot water to remove
snow and ice from windows and mirrors. This
could cause the glass to crack!
The heating element for the rear window is
located on the inner side of the window. To
prevent damage, do not put stickers over the
heating elements on the inside of the win-
dow.
Cleaning windscreen wiper blades
Clean wiper blades improve visibility.
1. Use a soft cloth to remove dust and dirt
fr
om the w
ind
screen wiper blades.
2. Use window cleaner to clean the wind-
screen wiper blades. Use a sponge or a
cloth to remove stubborn dirt.
Care of rubber seals
If rubber seals are well looked after, they will
not freez
e so quickly.
1. Use a soft cloth to remove dust and dirt
from the rubber seal
s.
2. Apply a specialist care product to the rub-
ber seals.
The rubber strips on the doors, windows, etc.
will remain pliable and last longer if they are
treated with a suitable rubber care product
from time to time (for example silicone
spray).
Caring for rubber seals will also prevent pre-
mature ageing and leaks. The doors will be
easier to open. If rubber seals are well looked
after, they will not freeze so quickly in winter.
Door lock cylinder
The door lock cylinders can freeze up in win-
t
er
.
T
o de-ice the lock cylinders you should only
use spray with lubricating and anti-corrosive
properties.
Cleaning chrome parts
1. Clean chrome parts with a damp cloth.
2. Polish chrome parts with a soft, dry cloth.
If this
does not provide satisfying results, use
a specialist chrome cleaning product.
Chrome cleaning products will remove stains
from the surface.
CAUTION
To prevent scratching chrome surfaces:
Never use an abrasive cleaning product on
chrome.
Do not
clean or polish chrome parts in a
sandy or dusty environment.
Steel wheel rims
Clean steel wheel rims regularly using a
sep
ar
at
e sponge.
Use an industrial cleaner to remove brake
dust. Any damage to the paint on steel wheel
rims should be repaired before starting to
rust.
»
195
Technical dataAdviceOperationEmergenciesSafety
background
Advice
WARNING
Never wa
sh tyres with a cylindrical jet. Even
at large spraying distances and short clean-
ing times, damage can occur to the tyres.
This may cause an accident.
Water, ice and salt on the brake system can
reduce braking effectiveness. Risk of acci-
dent. Directly after washing, avoid sudden
and sharp braking. “Dry” the brakes by brak-
ing several times ››page 156, Braking ca-
pacity and braking distance.
Alloy wheel rims
Every two weeks
Wash salt and brake dust from alloy
wheel
s.
U
se an ac
id free detergent to clean the
wheel rims.
Every 3 months
Apply a hard wax compound to the wheels.
Alloy wheels require regular attention to pre-
serve their appearance. If road salt and brake
dust are not often removed, the aluminium
finish will be impaired.
Always use an acid-free detergent for alloy
wheel rims.
Car polish or other abrasive agents should
not be used for maintaining the rims. If the
protective coating is damaged, e.g. by flying
stones, the damaged area should be re-
paired immediately.
WARNING
Observe the safety warnings ››
in Steel
wheel rims on p
age 196.
Vehicle underbody protection
The vehicle underbody is coated to protect it
from chemic
al and mechanical damage.
The protective coating can be damaged when
driving. We recommend that you check the
protective coating under the body and on the
running gear, and retouch it if necessary, be-
fore and after the winter season.
We recommend that you go to your Technical
Service to carry out repair work and addition-
al anti-corrosion work.
WARNING
Do not apply underseal or anti-corrosion
coatin
gs to the exhaust pipes, catalytic con-
verter or the heat shields on the exhaust sys-
tem. The heat of the exhaust system or the
engine could cause them to ignite. Risk of
fire.
Cleaning engine compartment
Take special care when cleaning the engine
compar
tment.
Anti-corrosion treatment
The engine compartment and the surface of
the power unit are given anti-corrosion treat-
ment at the factory.
Good corrosion protection is particularly im-
portant in winter when the vehicle is fre-
quently driven on salted roads. To prevent
the salt corroding the vehicle, the entire en-
gine compartment should be thoroughly
cleaned before and after winter.
Technical Services have the proper products
for cleaning and preservation as well as the
necessary workshop equipment. For this rea-
son, we recommend having this work per-
formed by them.
The anti-corrosion protection is usually re-
moved if the engine compartment is cleaned
with grease removing solutions, or if you
have the engine cleaned. On commissioning
this work, ensure that all surfaces, seams,
joints and components in the engine com-
partment are given anti-corrosion treatment.
WARNING
When workin
g in the engine compartment,
always observe the safety warnings
page 201.
196
background
Care and maintenance
Befor
e opening the bonnet, switch the en-
gine off, apply the handbrake firmly and al-
ways remove the key from the ignition.
Allow the engine to cool before you clean
the engine compartment.
Do not clean, for example, the vehicle un-
derbody, wheel arches or wheel trims without
protecting your hands and arms. You may cut
yourself on sharp-edged metal parts. Failure
to comply could result in injury.
Moisture, ice and salt on the brake system
may affect braking effectiveness. Risk of acci-
dent. Directly after washing, avoid sudden
and sharp braking.
Never touch the radiator fan. It is tempera-
ture-controlled and could start automatically,
even when the key is removed from the igni-
tion!
For the sake of the environment
Fuel, grease and oil deposits can be removed
when the engine is
washed. The polluted wa-
ter must be cleaned in an oil separator. For
this reason, engine washing should be car-
ried out only by a specialised workshop or a
petrol station.
Caring for the vehicle interior
C
l
e
aning plastic parts and the dash
panel
Use a clean, damp cloth to clean plastic
parts
and the dash panel.
If this does not provide satisfactory results,
use a special solvent-free plastic cleaning
product.
WARNING
Never clean the dash panel and the airbag
module s
urface with cleaners containing sol-
vents. Solvents cause the surface to become
porous. If the airbag triggered, plastic parts
could become detached and cause injuries.
CAUTION
Cleaning products which contain solvents will
damag
e the material.
Cleaning wooden trim*
Clean the wooden trim with a water-mois-
t
ened c
l
ean cloth.
If this does not provide satisfactory results,
use a gentle soap solution.
CAUTION
Cleaning products which contain solvents will
damag
e the material.
Cleaning upholstery and fabric trim
Cloth seat covers and fabric trim on the
doors, hea
dlining etc. can be cleaned with a
special interior cleaner or with dry foam and
a soft brush.
Cleaning the radio and climate con-
trol
s
To clean the radio and/or climate controls,
u
se a sof
t
damp cloth. For more resistant dirt,
a neutral soap solution may be used.
Cleaning leather*
Normal cleaning
Moisten a cotton or woollen cloth with wa-
t
er and w
ipe o
ver the leather surfaces.
Cleaning stubborn stains
More stubborn dirt can be removed using a
mild soap solution (pure liquid soap; two
tablespoons diluted in one litre of water)
and a cloth.
»
197
Technical dataAdviceOperationEmergenciesSafety
background
Advice
Do not
l
et
the water soak through the leath-
er or soak into the seams.
Then wipe off with a soft, dry cloth.
Leather maintenance
The leather should be treated twice a year
with a special leather-care product, availa-
ble at Technical Services.
Apply these products very sparingly.
Then wipe off with a soft, dry cloth.
SEAT does everything possible to preserve
the genuine qualities of this natural product.
Due to the natural properties of the specially
selected hides employed, the finished leath-
er has a certain sensitivity to grease and dirt,
etc. so a degree of care is required in every-
day use and when looking after the leather.
Dust and grit in the pores and seams can
scratch and damage the surface. If the vehi-
cle is under solar radiation for long periods,
the leather should be protected to prevent it
from fading. However, slight colour variations
in high-quality natural leather are normal.
CAUTION
Do not use so
lvents, wax polish, shoe
cream, spot removers or similar products on
leather.
To avoid damage, stubborn stains should
be removed by a specialised workshop.
Seat belt cleaning
A dirty belt may not work properly. Check all
seat belts
regularly and keep them clean.
Seat belts cleaning
Pull the dirty seat belt right out and unroll
it.
Clean dirty seat belts with a gentle soap
solution.
Allow it to dry.
Do not roll the seat belt up until it is dry.
If lar
ge stains form on the belts, the automat-
ic belt retractor will not work correctly.
WARNING
Do not use c
hemical cleaning agents on the
seat belts, as this can impair the strength of
the webbing. Ensure that seat belts do not
come into contact with corrosive fluids.
Check the condition of the seat belts at reg-
ular intervals. If you notice that the belt web-
bing, fittings, retractor mechanism or buckle
of any of the belts is damaged, the belt must
be replaced by a specialised workshop.
Do not attempt to repair a damaged seat
belt yourself. The seat belts must not be re-
moved or modified in any way.
CAUTION
After cleaning, allow seat belts to dry com-
plet
ely before rolling them up. Otherwise, the
belt retractors could become damaged.
198
background
Checking and refilling levels
Checking and refilling levels
F
uel
R
ef
uelling
Read the additional information carefully
page 41
The tank flap is released manually and is lo-
cated at the rear of the vehicle on the right.
The tank holds approximately 45 litres.
Opening the fuel tank cap
Lift the lid.
Hold the cap firmly with one hand, then in-
sert the k
ey into the lock and rotate 180° to
the left.
Unscrew the cap, turning it anticlockwise.
Closing the fuel tank cap
Screw the tank cap to the right until it
“clicks”.
Turn the key in the lock, without releasing
the cap, clockwise through 180°.
Remove the key and close the flap until it
clicks into place. The tank cap is secured
with an anti-loss attachment
If the automatic filler nozzle is operated cor-
rectly, it will switch itself off as soon as the
tank is “full”. Never attempt to fill beyond
this point, as this will fill the expansion
chamber. Fuel may leak out if ambient condi-
tions are warm.
The correct fuel grade for your vehicle is giv-
en on a sticker on the inside of the fuel tank
flap.
WARNING
Fuel i
s highly flammable and can cause se-
rious burns and other injuries.
Never smoke or come into contact with
sparks when filling the fuel tank of the
vehicle or a spare fuel canister with fuel.
This is an explosion hazard.
Follow legal requirements for the use of
spare fuel canisters.
For safety reasons we do not recommend
carrying a spare fuel canister in the vehi-
cle. The canister could be damaged in an
accident and leak.
If, in exceptional circumstances, you have
to carry a spare fuel canister, please observe
the following:
Never fill the spare fuel canister inside
the vehicle or on it. An electrostatic
charge could build up during filling, caus-
ing the fuel fumes to ignite. This could
cause an explosion. Always place the
canister on the ground to fill it.
Insert the fuel nozzle into the mouth of
the canister as far as possible.
If the sp
are fuel canister is made of met-
al, the filling nozzle must be in contact
with the canister during filling. This
helps prevent an electrostatic charge
building up.
Never spill fuel in the vehicle or in the
luggage compartment. Fuel vapours are
explosive. Danger of death.
CAUTION
F
uel s
pills should be removed from the
paintwork immediately.
Never run the tank completely dry. Irregular
fuel supply can cause misfiring. As a result,
unburnt fuel could enter the catalytic convert-
er and cause damage.
When filling the fuel tank after having run it
completely dry on a vehicle with a diesel en-
gine the ignition must be switched on for at
least 30 seconds before starting the engine.
Subsequently, when you start the engine it
may take longer than normal to start firing
(up to one minute). This is due to the fact that
the fuel system has to purge itself of air be-
fore starting.
For the sake of the environment
Do not try to put in more fuel after the auto-
matic fi
ller nozzle has switched off, this may
cause the fuel to overflow if it becomes warm.
199
Technical dataAdviceOperationEmergenciesSafety
background
Advice
Petrol
P
etr
o
l types
The correct petrol types are listed on a sticker
inside the f
uel tank flap.
Only unleaded petrol conforming to standard
DIN EN 228 may be used for vehicles with
catalytic converters (EN = “European Stand-
ard”).
Types of petrol differ from each other accord-
ing to the octane rating, for example: 91, 95,
98 RON (RON = “Research Octane Number”,
unit for determining the knock resistance of
petrol). You may use petrol with a higher oc-
tane number than the one recommended for
your engine. However, this has no advantage
in terms of fuel consumption and engine
power.
CAUTION
Even one t
ankful of leaded fuel would per-
manently impair the efficiency of the catalyt-
ic converter.
High engine speed and full throttle can
damage the engine when using petrol with an
octane rating lower than the correct grade for
the engine.
For the sake of the environment
Just one full tank of leaded fuel would seri-
ously
impair the efficiency of the catalytic
converter.
Additives for petrol
The quality of the fuel influences the behav-
iour, pow
er and service life of the engine.
This is why the petrol you use should carry
suitable additives already included by the
petrol industry, free of metals. These addi-
tives will help to prevent corrosion, keep the
fuel system clean and prevent deposits from
building up in the engine.
If good-quality petrol with metal-free addi-
tives is not available or engine problems
arise, the necessary additives must be added
when refuelling.
Not all petrol additives have been shown to
be effective. The use of unsuitable petrol ad-
ditives may cause significant damage to the
engine and the catalytic converter. Metal ad-
ditives should never be used. Metal additives
may also be contained in petrol additives for
improving anti-detonation ratings or octane
ratings.
SEAT recommends “genuine Volkswagen
Group fuel
additives for petrol engines”.
These additives can be bought at SEAT deal-
ers, where information on how to use them
can also be obtained.
CAUTION
Do not refuel if the filler indicates that the
fuel c
ontains metal. LRP (lead replacement
petrol) fuels contain high concentrations of
metal additives. Using them may damage the
engine!
Diesel
Die
sel
Diesel fuel mu
s
t
conform to DIN EN 590 (EN =
“European Standard”). It must have a cetane
number (CN) of at least 51. The cetane num-
ber indicates the ignition quality of the diesel
fuel.
Notes on refuelling
page 199.
Water in the fuel filter
1)
If your vehicle has a diesel engine and is
equipped with a fuel filter with a water sepa-
rator, the instrument panel may display the
following warning:
1)
Depending on the market.
200
background
Checking and refilling levels
Water in the fuel filter.
If this
is the case, take the vehicle to a speci-
alised workshop so that they can drain the
fuel filter.
Biodiesel*
CAUTION
Your v
ehicle is not designed to use biodie-
sel fuel. Never, under any circumstances re-
fuel with biodiesel. The use of biodiesel fuel
could damage the engine and the fuel sys-
tem. The addition of biodiesel to diesel fuel
by the diesel manufacturer in accordance
with standard EN 590 or DIN 51628 is author-
ised and will not cause damage to the engine
or the fuel system.
The diesel engine has been designed to be
used exclusively with diesel fuel conforming
to standard EN 590. Never refuel or use pet-
rol, kerosene, fuel oil or any other type of
fuel. If you accidentally fill up the vehicle
with the wrong type of fuel, do not start the
engine. Seek assistance from specialised per-
sonnel. The composition of these fuels may
severely damage the fuel system and the en-
gine.
Winter operation
Winter-grade diesel
When usin
g “summer-grade diesel fuel”, dif-
ficulties may be experienced at temperatures
below 0°C (+32°F) because the fuel thickens
due to wax separation. For this reason, “win-
ter-grade diesel fuel” is available in some
countries during the cold months. It can be
used at temperatures as low as -22°C (-8°F).
In countries with different climatic conditions
the diesel fuel generally sold has different
temperature characteristics. Check with the
Technical Services or filling stations in the
country concerned regarding the type of die-
sel fuels available.
Filter pre-heater
Your vehicle is fitted with a fuel filter glow
plug system, making it well equipped for op-
eration in winter. This ensures that the fuel
system remains operational to approx. -24°C
(-11°F), provided you use winter-grade diesel
which is safe to -15°C (+5°F).
However, if the fuel has waxed to such an ex-
tent that the engine will not start at tempera-
tures of under -24°C (-11°F), simply place the
vehicle in a warm place for a while.
CAUTION
Do not mix fuel additives, the so-called “thin-
ners”, or simi
lar additives with diesel fuel.
Working in the engine compart-
ment
s
af
ety
notes for work in the engine
compartment
Read the additional information carefully
page 10
Before starting any work on the engine or in
the engine compartment:
1. Switch off the engine and remove the key
from the ignition.
2. Ap
ply the handbrake.
3. Move the gear lever to neutral or the selec-
tor lever to position P.
4. Wait for the engine to cool down.
5. Keep children away from the vehicle.
6. Raise the bonnet
page 203.
You should not do any work in the engine
compartment unless you know exactly how to
carry out the jobs and have the correct tools!
Have the work carried out by a specialised
workshop if you are uncertain.
All service fluids and consumables, e.g. cool-
ant, engine oil, spark plugs and batteries,
are under constant development. SEAT pro-
vides a constant flow of information to Tech-
nical Services concerning modifications. For
this reason, we recommend you have service
»
201
Technical dataAdviceOperationEmergenciesSafety
background
Advice
fluids and consumables replaced by a Techni-
c
al
Service. Please observe the relevant in-
structions page 190. The engine compart-
ment of the vehicle is a hazardous area
.
WARNING
All work on the engine or in the engine com-
partment, e.
g. checking and refilling fluids,
involves the danger of injury and burns, acci-
dents and even fire.
Never open the bonnet if you see steam,
smoke or coolant escaping from the engine
compartment. Otherwise, there is a risk of
sustaining burns. Wait until no more steam or
coolant is emitted, then allow the engine to
cool before carefully opening the bonnet.
Switch off the engine and remove the key
from the ignition.
Apply the handbrake and move the gear
lever to neutral or selector lever to position P.
Keep children away from the vehicle.
Never touch hot engine parts. There is a
risk of burns.
Never spill liquids on a hot engine or on a
hot exhaust gas system. This is a fire hazard.
Avoid causing short-circuits in the electri-
cal system, particularly at the points where
the jump leads are attached ››
page 52.
The battery could explode.
Never touch the radiator fan. It is tempera-
ture controlled and could start automatically,
even when the engine has been switched off
and the key removed from the ignition!
Never co
ver the engine with additional in-
sulating materials such as a blanket. Risk of
fire!
Do not unscrew the cap on the coolant ex-
pansion tank when the engine is hot. If the
coolant is hot, the cooling system will be
pressurised!
Protect face, hands and arms by covering
the cap with a large, thick cloth to protect
against escaping coolant and steam.
Always make sure you have not left any ob-
jects, such as cleaning cloths or tools, in the
engine compartment.
If you have to work underneath the vehicle,
you must use suitable stands additionally to
support the vehicle, there is a risk of acci-
dent!. A hydraulic jack is insufficient for se-
curing the vehicle and there is a risk of injury.
If any work has to be performed when the
engine is started or with the engine running,
there is an additional, potentially fatal, safety
risk from the rotating parts, such as the drive
belts, alternator, radiator fan, etc., and from
the high-voltage ignition system. You should
also observe the following:
Never touch the electrical wiring of the
ignition system.
Ensure that jewellery, loose clothing and
long hair do not get trapped in rotating
engine parts. Danger of death. Before
starting any work remove jewellery, tie
back and cover hair, and wear tight-fit-
ting clothes.
Never acc
elerate with a gear engaged
without taking the necessary precau-
tions. The vehicle could move, even if the
handbrake is applied. Danger of death.
If work has to be carried out on the fuel
system or on electrical components, you
must observe the following safety notes in
addition to the above warnings:
Always disconnect the battery from the
on-board network. The vehicle must be
unlocked when this is done, otherwise
the alarm will be triggered.
Do not smoke.
Never work near naked flames.
Always have a fire extinguisher on hand.
WARNING
If the bonnet is not correctly closed, it could
sudden
ly open while driving leaving the driv-
er without visibility. This could result in a se-
rious accident.
After closing the bonnet, always check that
it is properly secured by the locking mecha-
nism in the lock carrier piece. The bonnet
must be flush with the surrounding body pan-
els.
While driving, if you notice that the bonnet
is not correctly closed then stop immediately
and close it correctly.
Only open and close the bonnet when there
is nobody within its range.
202
background
Checking and refilling levels
CAUTION
When topping up service fluids, make sure
not to mi
stake them. Using the wrong fluids
could cause serious malfunctions and engine
damage!
For the sake of the environment
Service fluids leaks are harmful to the envi-
ronment. F
or this reason you should make
regular checks on the ground underneath
your vehicle. If you find spots of oil or other
fluids, have your vehicle inspected in a speci-
alised workshop.
Opening the bonnet
Read the additional information carefully
page 10
The bonnet is released from inside the vehi-
cle.
Before opening the bonnet ensure that the
windscreen wipers are in rest position.
WARNING
Hot coolant can scald!
Never open the bonnet if you see steam,
smoke or coo
lant escaping from the engine
compartment.
Wait u
ntil no more steam, smoke or coolant
is emitted from the bonnet, then carefully
open the bonnet.
When working in the engine compartment,
always observe the safety warnings
page 201.
Closing the bonnet
Slightly lift the bonnet.
Release the bonnet stay and replace it in its
s
up
por
t.
At a height of approximately 30 cm let it fall
so it locks.
If the bonnet does not close, do not press
downwards. Open it again and let it fall as
mentioned above.
WARNING
If the bonnet is not closed properly, it could
open while
you are driving and completely
obscure your view of the road. Risk of acci-
dent.
After closing the bonnet, always check that
it is properly secured. The bonnet must be
flush with the surrounding body panels.
If you notice that the bonnet latch is not se-
cured when the vehicle is moving, stop the
vehicle immediately and close the bonnet
properly. Risk of accident.
203
Technical dataAdviceOperationEmergenciesSafety
background
Advice
Checking levels
Fig. 185 Diagram for the location of the various elements.
Fig. 186 For vehicles with the battery in the
luggag
e compartment.
From time to time, the levels of the different
fluid
s
in the
vehicle must be checked. Never
fill with incorrect fluids, otherwise serious
damage to the engine may be caused.
Coolant expansion tank
Engine oil level dipstick
Engine oil filler cap
Brake fluid reservoir
Vehicle battery
Windscreen washer reservoir
The checking and refilling of service fluids
are carried out on the components men-
tioned above. These operations are descri-
bed in page 201.
Overview
You will find further explanations, instruc-
tions and restrictions on the technical speci-
fications as of page 217.
1
2
3
4
5
6
Note
The layout of parts may vary depending on
the engine.
Engine oil
General
notes
The engine comes with a special, multi-grade
oil th
at can be used all year round.
Because the use of high-quality oil is essen-
tial for the correct operation of the engine
and its long useful life, when topping up or
changing oil, use only those oils that comply
with VW standards.
204
background
Checking and refilling levels
The specifications (VW standards) set out in
the f
o
l
lowing page should appear on the con-
tainer of the service oil; when the container
displays the specific standards for petrol and
diesel engines together, it means that the oil
can be used for both types of engines.
We recommend that the oil change indicated
in the Maintenance Programme, be per-
formed by a technical service or specialised
workshop.
The correct oil specifications for your engine
are listed in the
page 41.
Service intervals
Service intervals can be flexible (LongLife
service) or fixed (dependent on time/dis-
tance travelled).
If the PR code that appears on the back of the
Maintenance Programme booklet is PR QI6,
this means that your vehicle has the LongLife
service program. If it lists the codes QI1, QI2,
QI3, QI4 or QI7, the interval service is de-
pendent on the time/distance travelled.
Flexible service intervals (LongLife service
intervals*)
Special oils and processes have been devel-
oped which, depending on the characteris-
tics and individual driving profiles, enable
the extension of the oil change service (Long-
Life service intervals).
Because this oil is essential for extending the
service intervals, it must only be used ob-
serving the following indications:
Avoid mixing it with oil for fixed service in-
tervals.
Only in exceptional circumstances, if the
engine oil level is too low page 206 and
LongLife oil is not available, it is permitted to
top up (once) with oil for fixed service inter-
vals
page 41 (up to a maximum of 0.5
litres).
Fixed service intervals*
If your vehicle does not have the “LongLife
service interval” or it has been disabled (by
request), you may use oils for fixed service
intervals, which also appear in
page 41. In this case, your vehicle
must be serviced after a fixed interval of 1
year/15,000 km (10,000 miles)(whatever
comes first) ›› Booklet Maintenance Pro-
gramme.
In exceptional circumstances, if the engine
oil level is too low page 206 and you can-
not obtain the oil specified for your vehicle,
you can add a small quantity of oil conform-
ing to the specification ACEA A2 or ACEA A3
(petrol engines) or ACEA B3 or ACEA B4 (die-
sel engines) (up to 0.5 l).
Vehicles with diesel particulate filter*
The Maintenance Programme states whether
your vehicle is fitted with a diesel particulate
filter.
Only VW 507 00 engine oil, with reduced ash
formation, may be used in diesel engines
equipped with particulate filter. Using other
types of oil will cause a higher soot concen-
tration and reduce the life of the DPF. There-
fore:
Avoid mixing this oil with other engine oils.
Only in exceptional circumstances, if the
engine oil level is too low page 206 and
you cannot obtain the oil specified for your
vehicle, you can use a small quantity of oil
(once) conforming to the VW 506 00,
VW 506 01, VW 505 00, VW 505 01 or
ACEA B3/ACEA B4 specification. (up to 0.5 l).
Note
Before a long trip, we recommend finding an
engine oil
that conforms to the correspond-
ing VW specifications and recommend keep-
ing it in the vehicle. This way, the correct en-
gine oil will always be available for a top-up if
needed.
205
Technical dataAdviceOperationEmergenciesSafety
background
Advice
Check engine oil level
Fig. 187 Engine oil dipstick.
Read the additional information carefully
page 41
Checking oil level
Park the vehicle in a horizontal position.
Briefly run the engine at idle speed until
the operating temperature is reached and
then stop.
Wait for about two minutes.
Pull out the dipstick. Wipe the dipstick with
a clean cloth and insert it again, pushing it
in as far as it will go.
Then pull it out again and check the oil lev-
el. Top up with engine oil if necessary.
Depending on how you drive and the condi-
tions in which the vehicle is used, oil con-
sumption can be up to 0.5 l/1000 km. Oil
consumption is likely to be higher for the first
5,000 km. For this reason the engine oil level
must be checked at regular intervals, prefera-
bly when filling the tank and before a jour-
ney.
WARNING
Any work carried out in the engine compart-
ment or on the engine mu
st be carried out
cautiously.
When working in the engine compartment,
always observe the safety warnings
page 201.
CAUTION
If the oil level is above the area
A
do not
star
t the engine. This could result in damage
to the engine and catalytic converter. Contact
a Technical Service.
Topping up engine oil
Read the additional information carefully
page 41
Before opening the bonnet, read and observe
the warnings
in safety notes for work in
the en
gine c
omp
artment on page 201.
The position of the oil filler opening is shown
in the corresponding engine compartment il-
lustration
page 204.
Engine oil specification
page 41.
WARNING
Oil is highly inflammable! Ensure that no oil
comes
into contact with hot engine compo-
nents when topping up.
CAUTION
If the oil level is above the area
A
do not
star
t the engine. This could result in damage
to the engine and catalytic converter. Contact
a specialised workshop.
For the sake of the environment
The oil level must never be above area
A
.
Otherwi
se oil can be drawn in through the
crankcase breather and escape into the at-
mosphere via the exhaust system.
Changing engine oil
Read the additional information carefully
page 41
The engine oil must be changed at the inter-
vals given in the service schedule.
We recommend that you have the engine oil
changed by a Technical Service.
The oil change intervals are shown in the
Maintenance Programme.
206
background
Checking and refilling levels
WARNING
Only change the engine oil yourself if you
have the s
pecialist knowledge required!
Before opening the bonnet, read and ob-
serve the warnings page 201, safety notes
for work in the engine compartment.
Wait for the engine to cool down. Hot oil
may cause burn injuries.
Wear eye protection to avoid injuries, such
as acid burns, caused by splashes of oil.
When removing the oil drain plug with your
fingers, keep your arm horizontal to help pre-
vent oil from running down your arm.
Wash your skin thoroughly if it comes into
contact with engine oil.
Engine oil is poisonous! Used oil must be
stored in a safe place out of the reach of chil-
dren.
CAUTION
No additives should be used with engine oil.
This c
ould result in engine damage. Any dam-
age caused by the use of such additives
would not be covered by the factory warranty.
For the sake of the environment
Becau
se of disposal problems and the spe-
cial tools and specialist knowledge required,
we recommend that you have the engine oil
and filter changed by a Technical Service.
Never pour oil
down drains or into the
ground.
Use a suitable container when draining the
used oil. It must be large enough to hold all
the engine oil.
Cooling system
Toppin
g up coolant
Read the additional information carefully
page 42
Top up coolant when the level is below the
MIN (minimum) mark.
Checking coolant level
Park the vehicle in a horizontal position.
Switch the ignition off.
Read off the coolant level on coolant ex-
pansion tank. When the engine is cold, the
coolant level should be between the marks.
When the engine is hot, it may be slightly
above the upper mark.
Topping up coolant
Wait for the engine to cool down.
Cover the coolant expansion tank cap with
a cloth and carefully unscrew it to the left
.
T
op up the c
oo
lant only if there is still cool-
ant in the expansion tank, otherwise you
could damage the engine. If there is no
coolant in the expansion tank, do not con-
tinue driving. You should obtain professio-
nal assistance
.
If there is still some coolant in the expan-
s
ion t
ank, t
op up to the upper mark.
Top up with coolant until the level becomes
stable.
Screw the cap back on correctly.
Any loss of coolant fluid normally indicates a
leak in the cooling system. Take the vehicle
straight to a specialised workshop to have
the cooling system examined. If there are no
leaks in the engine cooling system, a loss of
coolant can only occur if the coolant boils
and is forced out of the system as a result of
overheating.
WARNING
The coolin
g system is under pressure. Do
not unscrew the cap on the coolant expan-
sion tank when the engine is hot: risk of
burns!
The antifreeze and coolant fluid can be a
health hazard. Therefore, the antifreeze
should be stored in the original container in a
safe place out of reach of children. Failure to
comply could result in poisoning.
»
207
Technical dataAdviceOperationEmergenciesSafety
background
Advice
If work
ing inside the engine compartment,
remember that, even when the ignition is
switched off, the radiator fan may start up au-
tomatically, and therefore there is a risk of in-
jury.
WARNING
If there is not enough anti-freeze in the cool-
ant
sys
tem, the engine may fail leading to se-
rious damage.
Please make sure that the percentage of
additive is correct with respect to the lowest
expected ambient temperature in the zone in
which the vehicle is to be used.
When the outside temperature is very low,
the coolant could freeze and the vehicle
would be immobilised. In this case, the heat-
ing would not work either and inadequately
dressed passengers could die of cold.
CAUTION
Do not top up the expansion tank with cool-
ant fluid if it
is empty! Air could enter the
cooling system. In this case, stop driving.
Seek specialist assistance. Otherwise, there
is a risk of engine damage.
CAUTION
The original additives should never be mixed
with coo
lants which are not approved by
SEAT. Otherwise, you run the risk of causing
severe damage to the engine and the engine
coolin
g system.
If the fluid in the expansion tank is not pur-
ple but is, for example, brown, this indicates
that the G13 additive has been mixed with an
inadequate coolant. The coolant must be
changed as soon as possible if this is the
case! This could result in serious faults and
engine damage.
For the sake of the environment
Coolants and additives can contaminate the
en
vir
onment. If any fluids are spilled, they
should be collected and correctly disposed
of, with respect to the environment.
Brake fluid
Chec
k
in
g the brake fluid level
Read the additional information carefully
page 43
The position of the brake fluid reservoir is
shown in the corresponding engine compart-
ment illustration page 204. The brake fluid
reservoir has a black and yellow cap.
The brake fluid level drops slightly when the
vehicle is being used as the brake pads are
automatically adjusted as they wear.
However, if the level goes down noticeably in
a short time, or drops below the “MIN” mark,
there may be a leak in the brake system. A
display on the instrument panel will warn you
if the brake fluid level is too low page 100.
WARNING
Before opening the bonnet to check the brake
fluid level, r
ead and observe the warnings
page 201.
Changing the brake fluid
The Maintenance Programme indicates brake
fluid c
h
an
ge intervals.
We recommend that you have the brake fluid
changed by a Technical Service.
Before opening the bonnet, please read and
follow the warnings
in safety notes for
w
ork
in the en
gine compartment on
page 201 in section “Safety notes for work-
ing in the engine compartment”.
In the course of time, brake fluid becomes
hygroscopic and absorbs water from the am-
bient air. If the water content in the brake flu-
id is too high, the brake system could cor-
rode. This also considerably reduces the boil-
ing point of the brake fluid. Heavy use of the
brakes may then cause a vapour lock which
could impair the braking effect.
208
background
Checking and refilling levels
Be sure to always use the correct brake fluid.
On
ly
u
se brake fluid that expressly meets the
VW 501 14 standard.
You can buy VW 501 14 standard brake fluid
in a SEAT dealership or a SEAT Official Serv-
ice. If none is available, use only high-quality
brake fluid that meets DIN ISO 4925 CLASS 4
standards, or USA Standards FMVSS 116 DOT
4.
Using any other kind of brake fluid or one
that is not of a high quality may affect opera-
tion of the brake system and reduce its effec-
tiveness. Never use a brake fluid if the con-
tainer does not state that it complies with VW
501 14, DIN ISO 4925 CLASS 4 standards, or
USA standards FMVSS 116 DOT 4.
WARNING
Brake fluid is poisonous. Old brake fluid im-
pairs
the braking effect.
Before opening the bonnet to check the
brake fluid level, read and observe the warn-
ings page 201.
Brake fluid should be stored in the closed
original container in a safe place out of reach
of children. There is a toxic risk.
Perform the brake fluid change according to
the Maintenance Programme. Heavy use of
the brakes may cause a vapour lock if the
brake fluid is left in the brake system for too
long. This would seriously affect the effec-
tiveness of the brakes and the safety of the
vehicle. This may cause an accident.
CAUTION
Brake fluid damages the vehicle paintwork.
Wipe off an
y brake fluid from the paintwork
immediately.
For the sake of the environment
The brake pads and brake fluid must be col-
lected and di
sposed of according the applica-
ble regulations. The SEAT Technical Service
network has the necessary equipment and
qualified personnel for collecting and dispos-
ing of this waste material.
Windscreen washer reservoir
T
op
pin
g up the windscreen washer
reservoir water
Read the additional information carefully
page 43
The windscreen washer and the headlight
washers are supplied with fluid from the
windscreen washer fluid container in the en-
gine compartment. The container holds ap-
prox. 3 litres; in vehicles with headlight
washers* it holds approx. 4.5 litres.
The tank is in the engine compartment.
Plain water is not enough to clean the wind-
screen and headlights. We recommend that
you always add a product to the windscreen
washer fluid. Approved windscreen cleaning
products exist on the market with high deter-
gent and anti-freeze properties, these may be
added all-year-round. Please follow the dilu-
tion instructions on the packaging.
WARNING
Any work carried out in the engine compart-
ment or on the engine mu
st be carried out
cautiously.
When working in the engine compartment,
always observe the safety warnings
page 201.
CAUTION
Never put
radiator anti-freeze or other addi-
tives into the windscreen washer fluid.
Always use approved windscreen cleansing
products diluted as per instructions. If you
use other washer fluids or soap solutions,
the tiny holes in the fan-shaped nozzles
could become blocked.
Vehicle battery
S
ymbo
l
s and warnings on handling
the battery
Read the additional information carefully
page 43
»
209
Technical dataAdviceOperationEmergenciesSafety
background
Advice
Wear eye protection
Battery acid is extremely corrosive. Wear protec-
tive gloves and eye protection!
Fires, sparks, open flames and smoking are pro-
hibited!
A highly explosive mixture of gases is released
when the battery is under charge.
Keep children away from acid and batteries!
WARNING
Always be aware of the danger of injury and
chemica
l burns as well as the risk of accident
or fire when working on the battery and the
electrical system:
Wear eye protection. Protect your eyes,
skin and clothing from acid and particles con-
taining lead.
Battery acid is extremely corrosive. Wear
protective gloves and eye protection. Do not
tilt the batteries. This could spill acid through
the vents.
Rinse battery acid from eyes immediately
for several minutes with clear water. Then
seek medical care immediately. Neutralise
any acid splashes on the skin or clothing
with a soapy solution, and rinse off with plen-
ty of water. If acid is swallowed by mistake,
consult a doctor immediately.
Fires, sparks, open flames and smoking are
prohibited. When handling cables and electri-
cal equipment, avoid causing sparks and
electrostatic charge. Never short the battery
termina
ls. High-energy sparks can cause in-
jury.
A highly explosive mixture of gases is re-
leased when the battery is under charge. The
batteries should be charged in a well-ventila-
ted room only.
Keep children away from acid and batteries.
Before working on the electrical system,
you must switch off the engine, the ignition
and all electrical devices. The negative cable
on the battery must be disconnected. When a
light bulb is changed, you need only switch
off the light.
Deactivate the anti-theft alarm by unlock-
ing the vehicle before you disconnect the bat-
tery! The alarm will otherwise be triggered.
When disconnecting the battery from the
vehicle on-board network, disconnect first
the negative cable and then the positive ca-
ble.
Switch off all electrical devices before re-
connecting the battery. Reconnect first the
positive cable and then the negative cable.
Never reverse the polarity of the connections.
This could cause an electrical fire.
Never charge a frozen battery, or one which
has thawed. This could result in explosions
and chemical burns. Always replace a battery
which has frozen. A flat battery can also
freeze at temperatures close to 0°C (+32°F).
Ensure that the vent hose is always connec-
ted to the battery.
Never use a def
ective battery. This could
cause an explosion. Replace a damaged bat-
tery immediately.
For vehicles with the battery in the luggage
compartment: Check that the battery gas
ventilation hose is securely attached.
CAUTION
Nev
er dis
connect the battery if the ignition
is switched on or if the engine is running.
This could damage the electrical system or
electronic components.
Do not expose the battery to direct sunlight
over a long period of time, as the intense ul-
traviolet radiation can damage the battery
housing.
If the vehicle is left standing in cold condi-
tions for a long period, protect the battery
from “freezing”. If it freezes it will be dam-
aged.
Checking the battery electrolyte level
The electrolyte level should be checked regu-
l
arly
in high-mi
leage vehicles, in hot coun-
tries and in older batteries.
Open the bonnet and open the battery cov-
er at the front
in safety notes for work
in the en
gine c
omp
artment on page 202
in Symbols and warnings on handling
the b
att
er
y on page 210. For vehicles with
the battery under the spare wheel, open
210
background
Checking and refilling levels
the rear lid and lift the floor covering. The
b
att
er
y is located next to the spare wheel.
Check the colour display in the "magic eye"
on the top of the battery.
If there are air bubbles in the window, tap
the window gently until they disperse.
The position of the battery is shown in the
corresponding engine compartment diagram
page 204. The location of the battery in
the luggage compartment can be seen in
Fig. 186.
The “magic eye” indicator, located on the top
of the battery changes colour, depending on
the charge state and electrolyte level of the
battery.
There are two different colours:
Black: correct charge status.
Transparent/clear yellow: the battery must
be replaced. Contact a specialised workshop.
Charging or changing the battery
The battery is maintenance-free and is
c
hec
k
ed during the inspection service. All
work on the vehicle battery requires special-
ist knowledge.
If you often drive short distances or if the ve-
hicle is not driven for long periods, the bat-
tery should be checked by a specialised
workshop between the scheduled services.
If the battery has discharged and you have
problems starting the vehicle, the battery
might be damaged. If this happens, we rec-
ommend you have the vehicle battery
checked by a Technical Service where it will
be re-charged or replaced.
Charging the battery
The vehicle battery should be charged by a
specialised workshop only, as batteries us-
ing special technology have been installed
and they must be charged in a controlled en-
vironment.
Replacing a vehicle battery
The battery has been developed to suit the
conditions of its location and has special
safety features.
Genuine SEAT batteries meet the mainte-
nance, performance and safety specifications
of your vehicle.
WARNING
We rec
ommend you use only maintenance-
free or cycle free leak-proof batteries which
comply with standards T 825 06 and
VW 7 50 73. This standard applies as of
2001.
Before starting any work on the batteries,
you must read and observe the warnings
in Symbols and warnings on handling
the batter
y on page 210.
For the sake of the environment
Batteries contain toxic substances such as
s
ulphuric
acid and lead. They must be dis-
posed of appropriately and must not be dis-
posed of with ordinary household waste.
211
Technical dataAdviceOperationEmergenciesSafety
background
Advice
Wheels
Wheel
s
and ty
res
General notes
Avoiding damage
If you have to drive over a kerb or similar
obs
tacle, drive very slowly and at a right
angle.
Keep grease, oil and fuel off the tyres.
Inspect the tyres regularly for damage
(cuts, cr
acks or blisters, etc.). Remove any
foreign objects embedded in the treads.
Storing tyres
When you remove the tyres, mark them in
order to maintain the same direction of ro-
tation when they are installed again.
When removed, the wheels and/or tyres
should be stored in a cool, dry and prefera-
bly dark location.
Store tyres in a vertical position, if they are
not fitted on wheel rims.
New tyres
New tyres must be run in
page 165.
The tread depth of new tyres may vary, ac-
cording to the type and make of tyre and the
tread pattern.
Concealed damage
Damage to tyres and rims is often not readily
visible. If you notice unusual vibrations or the
vehicle pulling to one side, this may indicate
that one of the tyres is damaged. They
should be checked immediately by a Techni-
cal Service.
Tyres with directional tread pattern
An arrow on the tyre sidewall indicates the di-
rection of rotation on tyres with directional
tread. Always observe the direction of rota-
tion indicated when fitting the wheel. This
guarantees optimum grip and helps to avoid
aquaplaning, excessive noise and wear.
WARNING
New tyre
s do not have maximum grip dur-
ing the first 500 km. Drive particularly care-
fully to avoid possible accidents.
Never drive with damaged tyres. This may
cause an accident.
If you notice unusual vibrations or if the ve-
hicle pulls to one side when driving, stop the
vehicle immediately and check the tyres for
damage.
Tyre pressure monitoring system
Fig. 188 Location of the tyre pressure sticker.
The correct tyre pressure can be seen on the
s
tic
k
er on the inside of the fuel tank flap
Fig. 188.
1. Read the required tyre inflation pressure
from the sticker. The values refer to Sum-
mer tyres.
2. The tyre pressures should only be checked
when the tyres are cold. The slightly raised
pressures of warm tyres must not be re-
duced.
3. Adjust the tyre pressure to the load you
are carrying.
212
background
Wheels
Tyre pressure
The c
orr
ect
tyre pressure is especially impor-
tant at high speeds. The pressure should
therefore be checked at least once a month
and before starting a journey.
Depending on the vehicle, tyre pressure can
be adjusted to medium load to improve driv-
ing comfort (“comfort” tyre pressure). When
driving with comfort tyre pressure fuel con-
sumption may increase slightly.
WARNING
A tyre can easily burst if the pressure is too
low, c
ausing an accident!
At continuously high speeds, a tyre with in-
sufficient pressure flexes more. In this way it
becomes too hot, and this can cause tread
separation and tyre blow-out. Always observe
the recommended tyre pressures.
If the tyre pressure is too low or too high,
the tyres will wear prematurely and the vehi-
cle will not handle well. Risk of accident!
For the sake of the environment
Under-inflated tyres will increase fuel con-
sumption.
Tyre useful life
Fig. 189 Tyre tread wear indicators.
Fig. 190 Diagram for changing wheels
The useful life of tyres is dependent on tyre
pr
e
s
sure, driving style and fitting.
Wear indicators
The original tyres on your vehicle have
1.6 mm high “tread wear indicators”
Fig. 189, running across the tread. De-
pending on the make, there will be 6 to 8 of
them evenly spaced around the tyre. Mark-
ings on the tyre sidewall (for instance the let-
ters “TWI” or other symbols) indicate the po-
sitions of the tread wear indicators. The mini-
mum tread depth required by law is 1.6 mm
(measured in the tread grooves next to the
tread wear indicators). Worn tyres must be re-
placed. Different figures may apply in export
countries ››
.
T
y
r
e pressure
Incorrect tyre pressure causes premature
wear and could cause tyre blow-out. For this
reason, the tyre pressure should be checked
at least once per month page 212.
Driving style
Fast cornering, heavy acceleration and hard
braking all increase tyre wear.
Changing wheels around
If the front tyres are worn considerably more
than the rear ones it is advisable to change
them around as shown ›› Fig. 190. The use-
ful life of all the tyres will then be about the
same time.
Wheel balance
The wheels on new vehicles are balanced.
However, various factors encountered in nor-
mal driving can cause them to become unbal-
anced, which results in steering vibration.
»
213
Technical dataAdviceOperationEmergenciesSafety
background
Advice
Unbalanced wheels should be rebalanced, as
they
other
w
ise cause excessive wear on
steering, suspension and tyres. A wheel must
also be rebalanced when a new tyre is fitted.
Incorrect wheel alignment
Incorrect wheel alignment causes excessive
tyre wear, impairing the safety of the vehicle.
If tyres show excessive wear, you should
have the wheel alignment checked by a Tech-
nical Service.
WARNING
There is a serious danger of accidents if a tyre
burs
ts during driving!
The tyres must be replaced at the latest
when the tread wear indicators are worn
page 213. Failure to follow this instruction
could result in an accident. Worn tyres do not
grip well at high speeds on wet roads. There
is also a greater risk of “aquaplaning”.
At continuously high speeds, a tyre with in-
sufficient pressure flexes more. This causes it
to overheat. This can cause tread separation
and tyre blow-out. Risk of accident. Always
observe the recommended tyre pressures.
If tyres show excessive wear, you should
have the running gear checked by a Technical
Service.
Keep chemicals such as oil, fuel and brake
fluid away from tyres.
Damaged wheels and tyres must be re-
placed immediately!
For the sake of the environment
Under-inflated tyres will increase fuel con-
sumption.
New tyres and wheels
New tyres and wheels have to be run in.
The tyre
s and wheel rims are an essential
part of the vehicle's design. Those approved
by SEAT are specially matched to the charac-
teristics of the vehicle and make a major con-
tribution to good road-holding and safe han-
dling
.
T
y
r
es should be replaced at least in pairs and
not individually (i.e. both front tyres or both
rear tyres together). A knowledge of tyre des-
ignations makes it easier to choose the cor-
rect tyres. Radial tyres have the tyre designa-
tions marked on the sidewall, for example:
195/65 R15 91T
This contains the following information:
Tyre width in mm
Height/width ratio in %
Tyre construction: Radial
Rim diameter in inches
Load rating code
Speed rating
195
65
R
15
91
T
The tyres could also have the following infor-
mation:
A direction of rotation symbol
“Reinforced” denotes heavy-duty tyres.
The manufacturing date is also indicated on
the tyre sidewall (possibly only on the inner
side of the wheel).
“DOT ... 1103 ...” means, for example, that
the tyre was produced in the 11th week of
2003.
We recommend that work on tyres and
wheels be carried out by a Technical Service.
They are familiar with the procedure and
have the necessary special tools and spare
parts as well as the proper facilities for dis-
posing of the old tyres.
Any technical service has full information on
the technical requirements when installing or
changing tyres, wheels or wheel trims.
Note for Italy: A SEAT Service Centre should
be consulted whether different sized wheels
or tyres to those originally fitted by SEAT may
be fitted, as well as the combinations al-
lowed between the front axle (axle 1) and
back axle (axle 2).
WARNING
We rec
ommend that you use only wheels
and tyres which have been approved by SEAT
214
background
Wheels
for your model. Failure to do so could impair
vehicl
e handling. Risk of accident.
Avoid running the vehicle on tyres that are
more than 6 years old. If you have no alterna-
tive, you should drive slowly and with extra
care at all times.
Never use old tyres or those with an un-
known “history of use”.
If wheel trims are retrofitted, you must en-
sure that the flow of air to the brakes is not
restricted. This could cause the brake system
to overheat.
All four wheels must be fitted with radial
tyres of the same type, size (rolling circumfer-
ence) and the same tread pattern.
For the sake of the environment
Old tyres must be disposed of according to
the law
s in the country concerned.
Note
For tec
hnical reasons, it is not generally
possible to use the wheels from other vehi-
cles. This can also apply to wheels of the
same model. The use of wheels or tyres
which have not been approved by SEAT for
use with your model may invalidate the vehi-
cle's type approval for use on public roads.
If the spare tyre is not the same as the
tyres that are mounted on the vehicle (e.g.
winter tyres) you should only use the spare
tyre for a short period of time and drive with
extra care. Refit the normal road wheel as
soon as po
ssible.
Wheel bolts
The design of wheel bolts is matched to the
rims. If differ
ent wheel rims are fitted, the
correct wheel bolts with the right length and
correctly shaped bolt heads must be used.
This ensures that wheels are fitted securely
and that the brake system functions correctly.
In certain circumstances, you should not use
wheel bolts from a different vehicle, even if it
is the same model ›› page 190.
WARNING
If the wheel bolts are not tightened correctly,
the wheel cou
ld become loose while driving.
Risk of accident.
The wheel bolts must be clean and turn
easily. Never apply grease or oil to them.
Use only wheel bolts which belong to the
wheel.
If the prescribed torque of the wheel bolts
is too low, they could loosen whilst the vehi-
cle is in motion. Risk of accident! If the tight-
ening torque is too high, the wheel bolts and
threads can be damaged.
CAUTION
The prescribed tightening torque for wheel
bolts
for steel and alloy wheels is 120 Nm.
Winter service
Winter ty
res
In winter conditions winter tyres will consid-
erably
improve the vehicle's handling. The
design of summer tyres (width, rubber com-
pound, tread pattern) gives less grip on ice
and snow.
Winter tyres must be inflated to a pressure of
0.2 bar (2.9 psi/20 kPa) higher than the pres-
sures specified for summer tyres (see sticker
on fuel tank flap).
Winter tyres must be fitted on all four wheels.
Information on permitted winter tyre sizes
can be found in the vehicle's registration
documentation. Use only radial winter tyres.
All tyre sizes listed in the vehicle documenta-
tion also apply to winter tyres.
Winter tyres lose their effectiveness when the
tread is worn down to a depth of 4 mm.
The speed rating code
page 214, New
tyres and wheels determines the following
speed limits for winter tyres:
max. 160 km/h (99 mph)
»
Q
215
Technical dataAdviceOperationEmergenciesSafety
background
Advice
max. 180 km/h (112 mph)
m
ax. 190 km/h (118 mph)
m
ax. 210 km/h (130 mph)
In some c
ountries, vehicles which can exceed
the speed rating of the fitted tyre must have
an appropriate sticker in the driver's field of
view. These stickers are available from your
technical service. The legal requirements of
each country must be followed.
Do not have winter tyres fitted for unnecessa-
rily long periods. Vehicles with summer tyres
handle better when the roads are free of
snow and ice.
If you have a flat tyre, please refer to the
notes on the spare wheel ›› page 214, New
tyres and wheels.
WARNING
The maximum speed for the winter tyres must
not be ex
ceeded. Otherwise, this could lead
to damage and risk of accident.
For the sake of the environment
Fit your summer tyres again as soon as possi-
ble.
They are quieter, do not wear so quickly
and reduce fuel consumption.
S
T
H
216
background
Technical specifications
Technical data
T
ec
hnic
al specifications
Important information
Important
The information in the vehicle documentation
alway
s takes precedence over the informa-
tion in this Instruction Manual.
All technical specifications provided in this
documentation are valid for the standard
model in Spain. The vehicle data card inclu-
ded in the Maintenance Programme or the
vehicle registration documents shows which
engine is installed in the vehicle.
The figures may be different depending
whether additional equipment is fitted, for
different models, for special vehicles and for
other countries.
Abbreviations used in the technical specifi-
cations
section
kW Kilowatt, engine power measurement.
PS
Pferdestärke (horsepower), formerly
used to denote engine power.
rpm Revolutions per minute - engine speed.
Nm Newton metres, unit of engine torque.
litres per
100 km
Fuel consumption in litres per 100 km
(70 miles).
g/km
Carbon dioxide emissions in grams per
km (mile) travelled.
CO
2
Carbon dioxide
CN
Cetane number, indication of the diesel
combustion power.
RON
Research octane number, indication of
the knock resistance of petrol.
Vehicle identification data
Fig. 191 Vehicle data sticker (boot).
Fig. 192 Chassis number.
»
217
Technical dataAdviceOperationEmergenciesSafety
background
Technical data
Vehicles for certain export countries do not
h
av
e an identific
ation plate.
Identification plate
The identification plate is located on the right
rib inside the engine compartment.
Vehicle data sticker
The data sticker is placed on the inside of the
spare wheel well, in the boot and on the rear
cover of the Maintenance Programme.
The following information is provided on the
vehicle data sticker: Fig. 191
Vehicle identification number (chassis
number)
Vehicle type, model, capacity, engine
type, finish, engine power and gearbox
type
Engine code, gearbox code, external
paint code and internal equipment code
Optional extras and PR numbers
Consumption (l/100 km) and CO
2
emis-
sions (g/km)
A
Urban cycle consumption
B
Out-of-town consumption
C
Combined consumption and CO
2
emi
s
s
ions
1
2
3
4
5
Chassis number
The
v
ehic
le identification number can be
read from outside the vehicle through a view-
er in the windscreen ›› Fig. 192. The viewer is
located near the lower corner of the wind-
screen. The chassis number is printed on the
right water drain channel. The water drain
channel is located between the suspension
turret and the fender. To access the chassis
number, open the bonnet page 201.
Information on fuel consump-
tion
Fuel consumption and CO
2
emissions
The consumption and emission details
sho
wn on the
v
ehicle data sticker differ from
one vehicle to another.
Vehicle fuel consumption and CO
2
emissions
appear on the vehicle data sticker in the
spare wheel well, inside the boot and on the
rear cover of the Maintenance Programme.
The fuel consumption and CO
2
emission val-
ues refer to the weight category assigned to
your vehicle according to the engine and
gearbox combination, as well as the specific
equipment fitted, and is only used to com-
pare between the different models.
The fuel consumption and CO
2
emissions do
not depend only on the performance of the
vehicle, they can also differ from the estab-
lished values depending on other factors
such as driving style, road conditions, traffic
conditions, environmental conditions, load
and number of passengers.
Calculation of fuel consumption
The consumption values have been calcula-
ted based on measurements performed or
supervised by certified CE laboratories ac-
cording to the latest version of directives
715/2007/EC and 80/1268/CEE (for more in-
formation consult the European Union Publi-
cations Office at EUR-Lex: © European Union,
http://eur-lex.europa.eu/en/index.htm) and
are valid for the kerb weight indicated for the
vehicle.
Note
In practice, and considering all the factors
mentioned here, con
sumption values can dif-
fer from those calculated in the current Euro-
pean regulations.
Weights
Kerb weight refers to the basic model with a
f
uel
t
ank filled to 90% capacity and without
optional extras. The figure quoted includes
75 kg to allow for the weight of the driver.
218
background
Technical specifications
Special versions, optional equipment fittings
or r
etr
o-fittin
g accessories will increase the
weight of the vehicle
.
WARNING
Plea
se note that the centre of gravity may
shift when transporting heavy objects; this
may affect vehicle handling and lead to an ac-
cident. Always adjust your speed and driving
style to suit road conditions and require-
ments.
Never exceed the gross axle weight rating
or the gross vehicle weight rating. If the per-
missible axle load or the permissible total
weight is exceeded, the driving characteris-
tics of the vehicle may change, leading to ac-
cidents, injuries and damage to the vehicle.
Driving with a trailer
T
r
ai
ler weights
Trailer weight
The tr
ai
l
er weights and drawbar loads ap-
proved are selected in intensive trials accord-
ing to precisely defined criteria. The ap-
proved trailer weights are valid for vehicles in
the EU for maximum speeds of 80 km/h (50
mph) (in certain circumstances up to 100
km/h (62 mph)). The figures may be different
in other countries. All data in the official vehi-
cle documentation takes precedence over
these data at all times
.
Dr
a
wb
ar loads
The maximum permitted drawbar load on the
ball joint of the towing bracket must not ex-
ceed 75 kg.
In the interest of road safety, we recommend
that you always tow approaching the maxi-
mum drawbar load. The response of the trail-
er on the road will be poor, if the drawbar
load is too small.
If the maximum permissible drawbar load
cannot be met (e.g. with small, empty and
light-weight single axle trailers or tandem
axle trailers with a wheelbase of less than 1
metre), a minimum of 4% of the actual trailer
weight is legally required for the drawbar
load.
WARNING
For saf
ety reasons, you should not drive at
speeds above 80 km/h (50 mph) when towing
a trailer. This also applies in countries where
higher speeds are permitted.
Never exceed the maximum trailer weights
or the drawbar load. If the permissible axle
load or the permissible total weight is excee-
ded, the driving characteristics of the vehicle
may change, leading to accidents, injuries
and damage to the vehicle.
Wheels
T
y
r
e pressure, snow chains, wheel
bolts
Tyre pressures
The stick
er with the tyre pressure values can
be found on the inside of the fuel tank flap.
The tyre pressure values given there are for
cold tyres. Do not reduce the slightly raised
pressures of warm tyres
.
The pres
sure for winter tyres is 0.2 bar higher
than that of summer tyres (2.9 psi / 20 kPa).
Snow chains
Snow chains may be fitted only to the front
wheels, and only for the following tyres:
175/70R14
185/60R15
Chains with links not exceeding 15 mm
(including the chain closure)
215/45R16 Chains with links not exceeding 9 mm
(including the chain closure)
215/40R17 Chains with links not exceeding 7 mm
(including the chain closure)
Wheel bolts
Af
t
er the wheel
s have been changed, the
tightening torque of the wheel bolts should
be checked as soon as possible with a torque
wrench
. The tightening torque for steel
and al
lo
y
wheels is 120 Nm.
»
219
Technical dataAdviceOperationEmergenciesSafety
background
Technical data
WARNING
Check the ty
re pressure at least once per
month. Checking the tyre pressure is very im-
portant. If the tyre pressure is too high or too
low, there is an increased danger of accidents
- particularly at high speeds.
If the tightening torque of the wheel bolts
is too low, they could loosen while the vehi-
cle is in motion. Risk of accident! If the tight-
ening torque is too high, the wheel bolts and
threads can be damaged.
Note
We recommend that you ask your Technical
Servic
e for information about appropriate
wheel, tyre and snow chain size.
220
background
Technical specifications
Engine data
P
etr
o
l engine 1.0 MPI 55 kW (75 PS)
Power output in kW (PS) at rpm Maximum torque (Nm at rpm) No. of cylinders/displacement (cm
3
) Fuel
55 (75)/6,200 95/3,000-4,300 3/999 Super 95 RON/Normal 91 RON
a)
a)
Slight power loss.
Performance IBIZA
IBIZA
Start-Stop
IBIZA SC
IBIZA SC
Start-Stop
IBIZA ST
IBIZA ST
Start-Stop
Top speed (km/h) 172 172 172 172 172 172
Acceleration from 0-80 km/h (seconds) 9.5 9.5 9.5 9.5 9.9 9.9
Acceleration from 0-100 km/h (seconds) 14.3 14.3 14.3 14.3 14.8 14.8
Weights (in kg)
Gross vehicle weight 1,530 1,540 1,530 1,540 1,570 1,570
Weight in running order (with driver) 1,043 1,049 1,043 1,049 1,093 1,099
Gross front axle weight 790 800 790 800 790 800
Gross rear axle weight 790 790 790 790 830 820
Permitted roof load 75 75 75 75 75 75
Maximum trailer weights (in kg)
Trailer without brakes 520 520 520 520 540 540
Trailer with brakes, gradients up to 8% 1,000 1,000 1,000 1,000 1,000 1,000
Trailer with brakes, gradients up to 12% 800 800 800 800 800 800
221
Technical dataAdviceOperationEmergenciesSafety
background
Technical data
Petrol engine 1.2 TSI 66 kW (90 PS)
Power output in kW (PS) at rpm Maximum torque (Nm at rpm) No. of cylinders/displacement (cm
3
) Fuel
66 (90)/4,400-5,400 160/1,400-3,500 4/1,197 Super 95 RON/Normal 91 RON
a)
a)
Slight power loss.
Performance IBIZA IBIZA SC IBIZA ST
Top speed (km/h) 184 184 184
Acceleration from 0-80 km/h (seconds) 7.0 7.0 7.3
Acceleration from 0-100 km/h (seconds) 10.7 10.7 11.1
Weights (in kg)
Gross vehicle weight 1,580 1,580 1,620
Weight in running order (with driver) 1,089 1,089 1,139
Gross front axle weight 840 840 840
Gross rear axle weight 790 790 830
Permitted roof load 75 75 75
Maximum trailer weights (in kg)
Trailer without brakes 540 540 560
Trailer with brakes, gradients up to 8% 1,100 1,100 1,100
Trailer with brakes, gradients up to 12% 1,000 1,000 1,000
222
background
Technical specifications
Petrol engine 1.6 MPI 66 kW (90 PS)
Power output in kW (PS) at rpm Maximum torque (Nm at rpm) No. of cylinders/displacement (cm
3
) Fuel
66 (90)/4,250-6,000 155/3,800-4,000 4/1,598 Super 95 RON/Normal 91 RON
a)
a)
Slight power loss.
Performance IBIZA IBIZA SC IBIZA ST
Top speed (km/h) 185 185 185
Acceleration from 0-80 km/h (seconds) 7.0 7.0 7.0
Acceleration from 0-100 km/h (seconds) 10.6 10.6 11
Weights (in kg)
Gross vehicle weight 1,570 1,570 1,610
Weight in running order (with driver) 1,079 1,079 1,129
Gross front axle weight 830 830 830
Gross rear axle weight 790 790 830
Permitted roof load 75 75 75
Maximum trailer weights (in kg)
Trailer without brakes 530 530 560
Trailer with brakes, gradients up to 8% 1,000 1,000 1,000
Trailer with brakes, gradients up to 12% 1,000 1,000 1,000
223
Technical dataAdviceOperationEmergenciesSafety
background
Technical data
Petrol engine 1.0 EcoTSI 70 kW (95 CV) Start-Stop
Power output in kW (PS) at rpm Maximum torque (Nm at rpm) No. of cylinders/displacement (cm
3
) Fuel
70 (95)/5,000-5,500 160/1,500-3,500 3/999 Super 95 RON/Normal 91 RON
a)
a)
Slight power loss.
Performance IBIZA
IBIZA
ecomotive
IBIZA SC
IBIZA SC
ecomotive
IBIZA ST
IBIZA ST
ecomotive
Top speed (km/h) 187 191 187 191 187 181
Acceleration from 0-80 km/h (seconds) 6.9 6.9 6.9 6.9 7.2 7.2
Acceleration from 0-100 km/h (seconds) 10.4 10.4 10.4 10.4 10.8 10.8
Weights (in kg)
Gross vehicle weight 1,590 1,590 1,590 1,590 1,630 1,630
Weight in running order (with driver) 1,095 1,095 1,095 1,095 1,145 1,145
Gross front axle weight 850 850 850 850 850 850
Gross rear axle weight 790 790 790 790 830 830
Permitted roof load 75 75 75 75 75 75
Maximum trailer weights (in kg)
Trailer without brakes 540 500 540 500 570 500
Trailer with brakes, gradients up to 8% 1000 500 1000 500 1000 500
Trailer with brakes, gradients up to 12% 900 500 900 500 900 500
224
background
Technical specifications
Petrol engine 1.0 EcoTSI 81 kW (110 CV) Start-Stop
Power output in kW (PS) at rpm Maximum torque (Nm at rpm) No. of cylinders/displacement (cm
3
) Fuel
81 (110)/5,000-5,500 200/2,000-3,500 3/999 Super 95 RON/Normal 91 RON
a)
a)
Slight power loss.
Performance
IBIZA
Manual
IBIZA
Automatic
IBIZA SC
Manual
IBIZA SC
Automatic
IBIZA ST
Manual
IBIZA ST
Automatic
Top speed (km/h) 196 197 196 197 196 197
Acceleration from 0-80 km/h (seconds) 6.3 6.2 6.3 6.2 6.5 6.4
Acceleration from 0-100 km/h (seconds) 9.2 9.3 9.2 9.3 9.6 9.5
Weights (in kg)
Gross vehicle weight 1,600 1,630 1,600 1,630 1,640 1,670
Weight in running order (with driver) 1,109 1,140 1,109 1,140 1,155 1,165
Gross front axle weight 860 900 860 900 860 900
Gross rear axle weight 790 780 790 780 830 820
Permitted roof load 75 75 75 75 75 75
Maximum trailer weights (in kg)
Trailer without brakes 550 570 550 570 570 580
Trailer with brakes, gradients up to 8% 1,100 1,100 1,100 1,100 1,100 1,100
Trailer with brakes, gradients up to 12% 1,000 1,000 1,000 1,000 1,000 1,000
225
Technical dataAdviceOperationEmergenciesSafety
background
Technical data
Petrol engine 1.2 TSI 81 kW (110 PS)
Power output in kW (PS) at rpm Maximum torque (Nm at rpm) No. of cylinders/displacement (cm
3
) Fuel
81 (110)/4,600-5,600 175/1,400-4,000 4/1,197 Super 95 RON/Normal 91 RON
a)
a)
Slight power loss.
Performance IBIZA IBIZA SC IBIZA ST
Top speed (km/h) 197 197 197
Acceleration from 0-80 km/h (seconds) 6.2 6.2 6.5
Acceleration from 0-100 km/h (seconds) 9.1 9.1 9.7
Weights (in kg)
Gross vehicle weight 1,590 1,590 1,630
Weight in running order (with driver) 1,102 1,102 1,152
Gross front axle weight 860 860 850
Gross rear axle weight 780 780 830
Permitted roof load 75 75 75
Maximum trailer weights (in kg)
Trailer without brakes 550 550 570
Trailer with brakes, gradients up to 8% 1,100 1,100 1,100
Trailer with brakes, gradients up to 12% 1,100 1,000 1,100
226
background
Technical specifications
Petrol engine 1.6 MPI 81 kW (110 PS)
Power output in kW (PS) at rpm Maximum torque (Nm at rpm) No. of cylinders/displacement (cm
3
) Fuel
81 (110)/5,800 155/3,800-4,000 4/1,598 Super 95 RON/Normal 91 RON
a)
a)
Slight power loss.
Performance
IBIZA
Manual
IBIZA
Automatic
IBIZA SC
Manual
IBIZA SC
Automatic
IBIZA ST
Manual
IBIZA ST
Automatic
Top speed (km/h) 196 197 196 197 196 197
Acceleration from 0-80 km/h (seconds) 6.4
a)
6.4
a)
7.0
a)
Acceleration from 0-100 km/h (seconds) 9.8
a)
9.8
a)
10.1
a)
Weights (in kg)
Gross vehicle weight 1,580 1,620 1,580 1,620 1,620 1,660
Weight in running order (with driver) 1,085 1,126 1,085 1,126 1,135 1,176
Gross front axle weight 840 890 840 890 840 880
Gross rear axle weight 790 780 790 780 830 830
Permitted roof load 75 75 75 75 75 75
Maximum trailer weights (in kg)
Trailer without brakes 540 560 540 560 560 580
Trailer with brakes, gradients up to 8% 1,100 1,100 1,100 1,100 1,100 1,100
Trailer with brakes, gradients up to 12% 1,100 1,100 1,100 1,100 1,100 1,100
a)
Data not available as this edition goes to print.
227
Technical dataAdviceOperationEmergenciesSafety
background
Technical data
Petrol engine 1.4 EcoTSI ACT 110 kW (150 CV) Start-Stop
Power output in kW (PS) at rpm Maximum torque (Nm at rpm) No. of cylinders/displacement (cm
3
) Fuel
110 (150)/5,000-6,000 250/1,500-3,500 4/1,395 Super 95 RON/Normal 91 RON
a)
a)
Slight power loss.
Performance IBIZA IBIZA SC IBIZA ST
Top speed (km/h) 220 220 220
Acceleration from 0-80 km/h (seconds) 5.3 5.3 5.5
Acceleration from 0-100 km/h (seconds) 7.6 7.6 7.8
Weights (in kg)
Gross vehicle weight 1,630 1,630 1,670
Weight in running order (with driver) 1,143 1,143 1,165
Gross front axle weight
a) a) a)
Gross rear axle weight
a) a) a)
Permitted roof load 75 75 75
Maximum trailer weights (in kg)
Trailer without brakes 570 570 580
Trailer with brakes, gradients up to 8% 1,200 1,200 1,200
Trailer with brakes, gradients up to 12% 1,200 1,200 1,200
a)
Data not available as this edition goes to print.
228
background
Technical specifications
Petrol engine 1.8 TSI 141 kW (192 PS) Start-Stop
Power output in kW (PS) at rpm Maximum torque (Nm at rpm) No. of cylinders/displacement (cm
3
) Fuel
141 (192)/4,300-6,200 320/1,450-4,200 4/1,798 Super 95 RON/Normal 91 RON
a)
a)
Slight power loss.
Performance IBIZA SC
Top speed (km/h) 235
Acceleration from 0-80 km/h (seconds) 5.1
Acceleration from 0-100 km/h (seconds) 6.7
Weights (in kg)
Gross vehicle weight 1,700
Weight in running order (with driver) 1,263
Gross front axle weight
a)
Gross rear axle weight
a)
Permitted roof load 75
Maximum trailer weights (in kg)
Trailer without brakes
Trailer with brakes, gradients up to 8%
Trailer with brakes, gradients up to 12%
a)
Data not available as this edition goes to print.
229
Technical dataAdviceOperationEmergenciesSafety
background
Technical data
Diesel engine 1.4 TDI 55 kW (75 PS)
Power output in kW (PS) at rpm Maximum torque (Nm at rpm) No. of cylinders/displacement (cm
3
) Fuel
55 (75)/3,000-3,750 210/1,500-2,000 3/1,422 Min, diesel acc. to DIN EN 590 51 CN
Performance IBIZA
IBIZA
Start-Stop
IBIZA SC
IBIZA SC
Start-Stop
IBIZA ST
IBIZA ST
Start-Stop
Top speed (km/h) 173 171 173 171 173 171
Acceleration from 0-80 km/h (seconds) 8.6 8.5 8.6 8.5 9.3 8.8
Acceleration from 0-100 km/h (seconds) 12.9 13.0 12.9 13.0 14.3 13.5
Weights (in kg)
Gross vehicle weight 1,640 1,630 1,640 1,640 1,680 1,680
Weight in running order (with driver) 1,150 1,155 1,150 1,155 1,200 1,205
Gross front axle weight 900 910 900 910 900 910
Gross rear axle weight 790 770 790 770 830 820
Permitted roof load 75 75 75 75 75 75
Maximum trailer weights (in kg)
Trailer without brakes 570 570 570 570 600 600
Trailer with brakes, gradients up to 8% 1,100 1,100 1,100 1,100 1,100 1,100
Trailer with brakes, gradients up to 12% 1,000 1,000 1,000 1,000 1,000 1,000
230
background
Technical specifications
Diesel engine 1.4 TDI 66 kW (90 PS)
Power output in kW (PS) at rpm Maximum torque (Nm at rpm) No. of cylinders/displacement (cm
3
) Fuel
66 (90)/2,750-3,500 230/1,500-2,500 3/1,422 Min, diesel acc. to DIN EN 590 51 CN
Performance IBIZA
IBIZA
Start-Stop
IBIZA
Automatic
IBIZA SC
IBIZA SC
Start-Stop
IBIZA SC
Automatic
IBIZA ST
IBIZA ST
Start-Stop
IBIZA ST
Automatic
Top speed (km/h) 182 182 182 182 182 182 182 182 182
Acceleration from 0-80 km/h (sec-
onds)
7.4 7.4 7.4 7.4 7.4 7.4 7.6 7.6 7.7
Acceleration from 0-100 km/h
(seconds)
10.9 10.9 10.9 10.9 10.9 10.9 11.3 11.3 11.4
Weights (in kg)
Gross vehicle weight 1,640 1,640 1,670 1,640 1,640 1,670 1,680 1,680 1,710
Weight in running order (with driv-
er)
1,150 1,155 1,165 1,150 1,155 1,165 1,200 1,205 1,233
Gross front axle weight 900 910
a)
900 910
a)
900 910
a)
Gross rear axle weight 790 780
a)
790 780
a)
830 820
a)
Permitted roof load 75 75 75 75 75 75 75 75 75
Maximum trailer weights (in kg)
Trailer without brakes 570 570 580 570 570 580 600 600 610
Trailer with brakes, gradients up
to 8%
1,200 1,200 1,200 1,200 1,200 1,200 1,200 1,200 1,200
Trailer with brakes, gradients up
to 12%
1,100 1,100 1,100 1,100 1,100 1,100 1,100 1,100 1,100
a)
Data not available as this edition goes to print.
231
Technical dataAdviceOperationEmergenciesSafety
background
Technical data
Diesel engine 1.4 TDI 77 kW (105 PS) Start-Stop
Power output in kW (PS) at rpm Maximum torque (Nm at rpm) No. of cylinders/displacement (cm
3
) Fuel
77 (105)/3,500-3,750 250/1,750-2,500 3/1,422 Min, diesel acc. to DIN EN 590 51 CN
Performance IBIZA IBIZA SC IBIZA ST
Top speed (km/h) 192 192 192
Acceleration from 0-80 km/h (seconds) 6.9 6.9 7.2
Acceleration from 0-100 km/h (seconds) 9.9 9.9 10.3
Weights (in kg)
Gross vehicle weight 1,650 1,650 1,690
Weight in running order (with driver) 1,161 1,161 1,211
Gross front axle weight 920 920 910
Gross rear axle weight 780 780 830
Permitted roof load 75 75 75
Maximum trailer weights (in kg)
Trailer without brakes 580 580 600
Trailer with brakes, gradients up to 8% 1,200 1,200 1,200
Trailer with brakes, gradients up to 12% 1,100 1,100 1,100
232
background
Technical specifications
Dimensions
Fig. 193 Dimensions
IBIZA IBIZA SC IBIZA ST
A/B Front and rear projections (mm) 857/735 857/717 857/910
C Wheelbase (mm) 2,469 2,469 2,469
D Length (mm) 4,061 4,043 4,236
E/F Front/rear
a)
track width (mm) 1,465/1,457 1,465/1,457 1,465/1,457
G Width (mm) 1,693 1,693 1,693
H Height at kerb weight (mm) 1,445 1,428 1,445
Turning radius (m) 10.7 10.7 10.7
a)
This data will change depending on the type of wheel rim.
233
Technical dataAdviceOperationEmergenciesSafety
background
background
Index
Index
A
ABS
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 171
c
ontr
ol lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102
Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 190
Additional electrical appliances (efficiency pro-
gramme) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31
Adjusting
front head restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 133
lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125
rear head restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60
Adjusting the front seats
adjusting the lumbar support . . . . . . . . . . . . . 132
Adjusting the head restraints
front head restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 133
rear head restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60
Adjusting the seat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 132
Adjustment
CAR menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 107
front head restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60
seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 57
AFS headlight bulbs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 87
Airbag covers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14
Airbag system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14, 66
activation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68
control lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68
deactivation of front airbag . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70
description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 67
front airbags . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14, 69
functioning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68
head-protection airbags . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15
side airbags . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15
Air conditioning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39, 148
Climatronic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 150
controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 148
General notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 144
manual air conditioning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40
Air outlets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 146
Air recirculation
air conditioning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 149
heating and fresh air . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 147
Alarm system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 118
Switching off . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119
Alloy wheel rims . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 196
Alternator
warning lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 106
Ambient lighting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 128
Anti-freeze . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42
Anti-lock brake system . . . . . . . . . . . . 103, 169, 171
control lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102
Anti-puncture kit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46, 76, 77
check after 10 minutes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 78
Anti-theft alarm system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 118
Switching off . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119
Aquaplaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 214
Aspects to note before setting off . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56
ASR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 172
control lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 103
Assistance systems
parking aid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 176, 177
Assistance Systems
tiredness detection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 175
Assisted starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52
Audible warning signal
seat belt not fastened . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62
warning and indication lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100
Automatic car wash tunnel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 192
Automatic gearbox . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 159
driving programmes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 159
Driving tips . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 163
kick-down device . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 164
manual release of selector lever . . . . . . . . . . . . 38
selecting gears with Tiptronic . . . . . . . . . . . . . 162
selector lever lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 161
selector lever positions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 160
tiptronic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 159
Automatic lighting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124
AUX-IN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 112
B
Back seat
folding down and raising the back seat back-
rest . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 135
Ball coupling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 188
Battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117
Before setting off . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56
Belt pretensioners . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 65
Biodiesel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 201
Bonnet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10, 201, 204
closing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 203
opening . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 203
Boot hatch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120
Boot lid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120
Brake assist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 103
Brake fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43, 208
Changing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 208
Brake pads . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 156, 165
Brakes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 208
brake fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 208
new Brake pads . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 156
warning lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 104
Brake servo . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 156, 173
Braking
brake assist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 103
Braking distance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 156
Bulbs
changing a bulb . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 83
Buzzer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 126
235
background
Index
C
C
ap
ac
ities . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40
fuel tank . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100
Car care
Exterior . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 192
Catalytic converter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 166
CCS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34
Central locking
anti-theft alarm . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 118
automatic speed-dependent locking . . . . . . . 114
central locking button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 115
electric windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122
key by remote control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117
Selective unlocking system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113
self-locking system to prevent involuntary un-
locking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114
unlocking system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114
Central locking system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 112
Safe security system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 112
Cetane number . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 200
Changing a
DRL light bulb . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 84
Changing a bulb
additional brake light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 92
AFS headlight bulbs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 87
fog light bulbs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88
general notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 83
interior light and reading light . . . . . . . . . . . . . 92
luggage compartment light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 93
number plate light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 92
tail light bulb on the rear lid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 91
tail light bulb on the side panel . . . . . . . . . . . . 90
tail light bulbs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 89
turn signal light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 87
Turn signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 91
Changing a double headlight bulb
dipped beam headlights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 86
double headlight bulbs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 85
Changing an AFS headlight bulb . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 87
turn signal light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 87
xenon light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 87
Changing a single headlight bulb
side light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 85
single headlight bulbs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 84
turn signal light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 84
Changing a wheel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47
subsequent work . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50
Changing double headlight bulb
side light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 86
Changing settings
CAR menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24
Changing the blades . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 78
Changing the double headlight bulb
main beam . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 86
Changing the single headlight bulbs
dipped/main beam . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 85
Charging the battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52
Checking levels
engine compartment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 204
Child-proof locking
electric windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120
Child seat
Categorisation in groups . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 73
Child seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16, 73
ISOFIX system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18
safety instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16, 72
Securing with the seat belt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17
Top Tether system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18, 20
Chrome parts
cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 195
Cigarette lighter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 138
Cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 191
alloy wheel rims . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 196
chrome parts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 195
cleaning of windows and exterior mirrors . . . . 194
engine compartment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 196
fabric . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 197
high pressure cleaners . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 193
leather . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 197
plastic parts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 194, 197
radio and climate controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 197
rubber seals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 195
seat belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 198
steel wheel rims . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 195
upholstery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 197
washing the vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 192
windscreen wiper blades . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 195
wooden trim . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 197
Climatronic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39
adjusting the temperature . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 151
air recirculation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 152
automatic mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 151
blower selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 152
controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 150
general notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 144
windscreen defrost . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 152
Closing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 112
bonnet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 203
tilting panoramic sunroof . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122
windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120
Coming Home Function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 126
Contact key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 153
Controls and displays
general instrument panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95
Controls on the steering wheel
operating the audio system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109
operating the audio system and telephone . . 110
236
background
Index
Convenience closing
ti
ltin
g p
anoramic sunroof . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123
windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122
Convenience opening
windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122
Coolant
checking level . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 207
Coolant level
control lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 106
Coolant temperature
control lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 106
Safety instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 106
Cooling system
checking coolant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 207
Coolant temperature gauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99
topping up coolant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 207
Correct position . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 57
Correct sitting position
front passenger . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58
rear seat passengers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 59
Cruise control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34, 184
adjusting the stored speed . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 184
complete deactivation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 185
control lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 184
temporary deactivation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 185
Cruise control system
control lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 104
Cruise speed
control lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 104
Current . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 138
D
Dangers in not using the seat belt . . . . . . . . . . . . 63
Dash panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35
Data sticker . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 217
Deactivating the front passenger front airbag . . . 14
Deactivation of front airbag . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70
Diesel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 200
Diesel engine
Winter operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 201
Diesel engine particulate filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 166
Differential lock fault (EDS)
control lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 103
Digital clock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 96
Dimensions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 233
Direction of rotation
tyres . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49
Display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 96, 97
Disposal
Seat belt tensioners . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 66
Door handle
de-icing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 195
Door lock
de-icing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 195
Door lock cylinder
de-icing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 195
Door release lever . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95
Doors
Childproof locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 115
opening and closing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9
Double headlight bulbs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 85
Driver
see Correct sitting position . . . . . . . . . 57, 58, 59
Driver information system
additional electrical appliances . . . . . . . . . . . . 31
assist systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29
bonnet, rear lid and doors open . . . . . . . . . . . . 28
engine oil temperature . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31
gear-change indicator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28
journey data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29
menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27
operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25
outside temperature . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27
saving tips . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31
service intervals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33
speed warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32
timer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31
warning and information messages . . . . . . . . . 29
Driving
driving abroad . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 168
with a trailer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 187, 188, 219
Driving abroad
Headlights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 169
petrol . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 168
Driving assistance systems
cruise control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 184
Driving safety . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56
Driving with a trailer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 187
DSG . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 159
Duplicate keys . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116
Dust and pollen filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 144
Dynamic headlight range control . . . . . . . . . . . . 125
E
Easy Connect . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24, 107
Economic
driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 167
EDL
see Electronic differential lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . 170
EDS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 170
Efficiency programme
additional electrical appliances . . . . . . . . . . . . 31
saving tips . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31
Electrical power socket . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 138
Electric windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11, 120
convenience opening/closing . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122
Electrolyte . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 210
Electronic differential lock . . . . . . . . . 103, 169, 170
control lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102, 103
Electronic differential lock (XDS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 173
Electronic immobiliser . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 107, 154
237
background
Index
Electronic Stability Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 170
El
ectr
onic
Stability Control (ESC) . . . . . . . 103, 169
Emergencies . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75
bulbs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45
changing a wheel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47
changing the battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 211
emergency towing of the vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . 51
emergency warning triangle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75
fire extinguisher . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75
first-aid kit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75
fuses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44
hazard warning lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 127
Jump leads . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52
panoramic/tilting sunroof . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11
puncture . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45
replacing a blown fuse . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44
Spare wheel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 76
vehicle tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75
Emergency operation
selector lever . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38
Emergency warning triangle . . . . . . . . . . . . 75, 127
Emission control system
control lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 106
Emissions data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 217
Engine
assisted starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52
Running in . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 165
Start-Stop system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 173
Engine compartment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10, 201, 204
battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 209
brake fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 208
closing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 203
coolant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 207
engine oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 206
opening . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 203
safety notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 201
windscreen washer liquid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 209
Engine coolant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42
checking level . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 207
G12 plus-plus . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42
G13 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42
specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42
Engine data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 221
Engine fault
control lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 101
Engine management
control lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 101
Engine oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41, 204
changing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 204, 206
check oil level . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 206
consumption . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 206
diesel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 204
engine oil dipstick . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 206
inspection service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 204
maintenance intervals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 204
oil properties . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41
Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 204
temperature display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31
topping up . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 206
Engine oil pressure
warning lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102
Environment
ecological driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 167
Environmental compatibility . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 165
Environmental tips
refuelling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 199
Equipment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 190
ESC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 103, 170
electronic stability control . . . . . . . . . . . 103, 169
Sport Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 169
see also Electronic Stability Control (ESC) . . . 170
Exhaust gas emission control system . . . . . . . . . 166
Extending
the luggage compartment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 135
Exterior lighting
changing a bulb . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 83
Exterior mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 131
adjusting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13
control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 131
folding in electrically . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 132
folding in manually . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 131
heated . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 132
Exterior view . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5, 6
F
Fabric: cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 197
Fastening rings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 140
Faulty bulbs
changing a bulb . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 83
Filling the tank . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 199
fuel gauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100
Fire extinguisher . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75
First-aid kit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75
Floor mats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61
Fog-light bulb
FR version . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88
Fog light bulb . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88
Front
headrests . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60
Front airbags . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14, 69
safety instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69
Front ashtray . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 138
Front drink holder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 137
Front passenger front airbag
control lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68
deactivation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14
Front seat
manual adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12
Front seat backrest
folding . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 133
lifting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 133
238
background
Index
Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41
b
iodie
sel
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 201
consumption . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 218
Diesel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 200
fuel gauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100
Petrol . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 200
saving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 167
Fuel consumption . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 167
Fuel reserve . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 105
Fuel tank
see Fuel reserve . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 105
Fuel tank cap
opening and closing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41
Fuel tank flap
opening and closing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41
Fuses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44, 81
fuse box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 81
identifying blown fuses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45
Identifying by colours . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44
Preparation before replacing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44
replacing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44
G
Gear-change indicator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28, 159
Gearbox lever . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37
Gear change . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37
automatic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38
changing gears (manual gearbox) . . . . . . . . . 159
manual . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37
manual gear change . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 159
Gear engaged . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37
Gear recommendation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28
General instrument panel
controls and displays . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95
turn signal and main beam lever . . . . . . . . . . . 125
warning and indication lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35
General overview of the engine compartment . . 204
Glass
removing ice . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 194
Glove compartment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 136
Glow plug system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 155
H
Handbrake . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 156, 157
warning lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 157
Hazard warning lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22, 127
HBA . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 171
Head-on collisions and the laws of physics . . . . . 63
Head-protection airbags
description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15
safety instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15
Headlight range control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125
Headlights
Driving abroad . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 169
fog lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123
Headlight washer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 130
Head restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12
Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 133
Front head restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60
Rear head restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60
Headrests . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12
adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 133
Heated rear window
heating element wires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 195
switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 128
Heating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 147
Defrosting the windscreen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 147
Demisting the windscreen and side windows 148
Heating and fresh air . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40, 146
controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 146
Heating system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 147
Hill driving assistant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 158
Horn . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95
How to jump start . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52
description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52
Hydraulic Brake Assist
automatic hazard warning lights activation . . 171
I
Identification plate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 218
Identifying letters on engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 217
Ignition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20
Ignition lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20, 153
Incorrect sitting position . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 59
Indications on the display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 97
assist systems submenu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29
compass . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98
distance travelled . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 97
doors, bonnet and rear lid open . . . . . . . . . . . . 28
Driver information system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25
ECO . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98
journey data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29
MKB . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98
outside temperature . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27
recommended gear . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98
SEAT Drive Profile . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 186
second speed display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98
selector lever position . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98
selector lever positions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 160
service intervals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33
speed warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98
Start-Stop . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98
time . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98
warning and information messages . . . . . . . . . 29
Infotainment system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24
Inspection service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 204
Instrument cluster . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 96
Instrument panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 96
display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 96, 97
instruments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 96
239
background
Index
odometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99
ser
v
ic
e interval indication . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33
warning and indication lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100
Interior lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22
Interior mirror . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 131
anti-dazzle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 131
Interior view
left guide . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7
right-hand drive . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8
ISOFIX system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18, 19
J
Jack . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47
mounting points . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48
Journey data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25
data summary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30
memory . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29
Jump leads . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52
K
Key-operated switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70
Key by remote control
unlocking and locking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117
Keys
replacing the battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117
spare key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116
synchronise . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117
unlocking and locking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117
vehicle key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116
Kick-down
automatic gearbox . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 164
L
Lamp fault
control lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102
Leaving Home Function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 126
Level control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40
Lifting the vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48
Lighting of the instrument panel, . . . . . . . . . . . . 125
Lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21, 123
adaptive headlights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 127
additional brake light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 92
automatic lighting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124
changing a bulb . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 83
coming home . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 126
Daytime running lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124
fog lights with cornering function . . . . . . . . . . 127
headlight range control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125
interior light and front reading lights . . . . . . . . 92
interior lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 128
leaving home . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 126
lighting of the instrument panel . . . . . . . . . . . 125
light switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123
luggage compartment light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 93
main beam lever . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125
main beams . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22
number plate light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 92
parking lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125
reading lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 128
turn signal lever . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125
turn signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 91
Light switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21
Load compartment in the luggage compartment
see Loading the luggage compartment . . . . . 139
Loading the luggage compartment . . . . . . . . . . . 139
Loading the vehicle
fastening rings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 140
luggage compartment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9
roof luggage rack . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 142
Locking and unlocking
with the central lock button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 115
Luggage compartment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9, 139
luggage compartment lighting . . . . . . . . . . . . 128
store the rear shelf . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 141
stretched luggage net . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 141
Unlocking manually . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10
see also Loading the luggage compartment . 139
Luggage compartment lid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10
M
Main beam headlights
control lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 105
Main beam lever . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125
Maintenance and cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 190
Maintenance intervals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 204
Malfunction
gearbox . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 164
Manual gearbox . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 159
Mobile phones . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 191
Modifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 190
Multimedia . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 112
N
Noises
tyres . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49
Number of seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61
O
Octane number . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 200
Odometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99
Reset button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99
total . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 96
Trip recorder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 96
Oil change . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 206
Oil properties . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41
One-touch opening and closing
electric windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 121
Open and close . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 112
rear lid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120
240
background
Index
Opening . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 112
bonnet
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10
f
uel
tank flap . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 199
tilting panoramic sunroof . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122
windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120
Opening and closing
bonnet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10
by remote control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117
fuel tank flap . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 199
in the lock cylinder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9
rear lid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120
rear lid of the luggage compartment . . . . . . . . . 9
tilting panoramic sunroof . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122
windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120
with the central lock button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 115
Outside temperature . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27
P
Parking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 157
Parking aid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 176
adjusting the display and audible warnings . 180
automatic activation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 179
fault . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 180
parking system plus . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 178
rear parking aid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 177
sensors and camera: cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . 194
towing bracket . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 181
visual indication . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 180
Parking aid system
see Parking aid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 176, 178
Parking distance warning system
see Parking aid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 176, 178
Parking (automatic gearbox) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 163
ParkPilot
see Parking aid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 176, 178
Parts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 190
Passenger
see Correct sitting position . . . . . . . . . 57, 58, 59
Pedals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61
Petrol . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 200
additives . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 200
Plastic parts: cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 194, 197
Pollution filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 144
Positioning seat belts
during pregnancy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 65
seat belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 65
Power-assisted steering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 153
Power socket
in the luggage compartment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 139
Power steering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 152
Pre-heating system
control lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 101
Products for vehicle maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . 191
Puncture
action . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45
R
Radio frequency remote control. . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117
Raising the vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48
Rear
headrests . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60
Rear Assist system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 181
instructions for use . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 182
parking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 183
screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 182
special features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 182
Rear drink holder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 137
Rear fog light
control lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102, 123
Rear lid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9, 10
Rear seat passengers
see Correct sitting position . . . . . . . . . 57, 58, 59
Rear shelf
storage compartments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 142
store . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 141
Rear View Camera . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 181
Rear view mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 131
Rear window automatic wiper-washer . . . . . . . . 130
Rear window wiper . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 129, 130
Rear window wiper blade
changing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 54
cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 54
Refuelling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 199
Opening fuel tank flap . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 199
Repair work . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 190
Replacement
parts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 190
Replacement keys . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116
Replacement parts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 190
Replacing the battery
of the vehicle key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117
Reset the trip recorder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99
Rev counter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 96, 97
Rims
Changing a wheel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47
Roll-back function
tilting panoramic sunroof . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123
windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 121
Roof aerial . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 190
Roof carrier system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 142
Roof luggage rack . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 142
attach the cross bars . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 143
Roof rack . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 142
Rubber seals
Care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 195
Running-in . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 212
brake pads . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 165
tyres . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 165
241
background
Index
Running in
En
gine
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 165
S
s
afe
driving safe . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56
Safe . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113
Safe Security system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113
Safety . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56
child safety . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72
child seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72
deactivating the front passenger airbag . . . . . . 14
Safe driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56
Safety equipment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56
Safety instructions
Coolant temperature . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 106
front airbags . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69
head-protection airbags . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15
side airbags . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69
using child seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16, 72
Safety notes
Seat belt tensioners . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 66
Using seat belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 63
Saving tips (efficiency programme) . . . . . . . . . . . 31
Seat
heating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 134
Seat belt position
for pregnant women . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12
seat belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12
Seat belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61
adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12, 64
control lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62
protective function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62
purpose . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61, 66
Safety notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 63
unfastened . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 63
Seat belt tensioners . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13
control lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68
SEAT Drive Profile System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 185
indications on the display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 186
Seat heating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 134
Selective opening . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113
Selector lever (automatic gearbox)
manual release . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38
positions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 160
Service intervals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33
Service notification: read . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34
Side airbags
description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15
safety instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69
Side and interior bulbs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 91
Signal lever . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22
Single headlight bulbs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 84
Sitting position
driver . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 57
Snow chains . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50, 219
Spanner symbol . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33
Spare wheel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 76
Speed limiter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 184
Speed selector lever lock
control lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 105
Speed warning device . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32
Sport Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 169
Start-Stop
Activating and deactivating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 174
function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 173
Start-Stop System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 173
Starting the engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 154, 155
after the fuel tank has been run dry . . . . . . . . 155
diesel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 155
petrol . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 154
Starting the vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20
Steel wheel rims
cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 195
Steering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58, 153
control lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 105
electromechanical . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 153
power . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 153
power-assisted steering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 153
steering column lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 153
Steering wheel
adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13
Steering wheel controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108
Steering wheel height adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . 58
Storage compartments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 136, 142
glove compartment lighting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 128
of front door panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 137
on the driver side . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 136
on the front passenger side . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 136
right front seat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 136
storage pocket in the seat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 137
Stretched luggage net . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 141
Sun visors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 129
Sliding/tilting sunroof . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122
Switch
hazard warning lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 127
Switching off the engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 156
Switching off the lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123
Switching on the lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123
Switching the ignition on and off . . . . . . . . 20, 153
System Easy Connect . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 107
T
Tail light bulbs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 89
Tail lights
access . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 89
change . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 89
summary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 89
Taking care of your vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 191
242
background
Index
Technical specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 217
T
emper
at
ure display
engine oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31
outside temperature . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27
Tightening the belt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 65
Tightening torque of wheel bolts . . . . . . . . . . . . 219
Tilting panoramic sunroof . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11, 122
closing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122
convenience closing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123
opening . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122
roll-back function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123
Timer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31
lap times . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31
menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31
statistics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31
Tiptronic (automatic gearbox) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 159
Tiredness detection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 175
Top speed . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32
Top Tether system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18, 20
Tow-starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52, 79
Towing bracket
ball coupling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 188
retrofitting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 188
Towing bracket device . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 187
Towing the vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51, 79
Towline anchorages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51, 80
front . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80
rear . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80
Traction control system . . . . . . . . . . . 103, 169, 172
control lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 103
Trailer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 187
parking aid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 181
Trailer turn signals
control lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 126
Trailer weights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 219
Transporting children . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72
Transporting objects
fastening rings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 140
roof carrier system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 142
roof luggage rack . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 142
Turn signal lever . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125
Turn signals
control lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 106, 126
Two-way radios . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 191
Tyre mobility set . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46, 76
Components . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 77
Inflating a tyre . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 77
Sealing a tyre . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 77
Tyre pressure monitoring system . . . . . . . . . . . . 213
Tyre pressures . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 219
Tyre profile . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 213
Tyres . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 212
changing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47
new tyres . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 214
pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 104, 212, 213
useful life . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 213
wear indicators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 213
with directional tread . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49, 212
Tyre tread depth . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 213
Tyre wear . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 213
U
Unfastening the seat belt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12, 64
Unlocking and locking
by remote control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117
Unlocking manually
rear lid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10
Upholstery: cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 197
USB/AUX-IN input . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 112
V
Vanity mirror . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 129
Vehicle
chassis number . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 217
data sticker . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 217
identification data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 217
identification number . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 217
raising . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48
Vehicle battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43, 209
assisted starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52
changing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 211
charging . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 211
connecting and disconnecting . . . . . . . . 34, 209
electrolyte level . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 210
winter conditions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 209
Vehicle care
windscreen wipers service position . . . . . . . . . 54
Vehicle interior heating or cooling system . . . . . 149
Vehicle interior monitoring and anti-tow system
Activation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119
Vehicle paint
code . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 217
Vehicle paintwork
Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 194
polishing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 194
Products for vehicle maintenance . . . . . . . . . . 192
Vehicle seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61
Vehicle tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47
housing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75
Vehicle underbody
protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 196
Vehicle wallet compartment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 136
Vehicle washing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 192
Ventilation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 147
Ventilation slits . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 140
W
Warning and control lamp
cruise control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 184
243
background
Index
Warning and indication lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100
ABS
Anti-loc
k
brake system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102
airbags . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70
Alternator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 106
applying the brake . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 105
ASR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 103
audible warning signal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100
brake system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 104
coolant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 106
diesel particulate filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 101
EDS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 103
emission control system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 106
engine management . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 101
engine oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102
engine pre-heating/fault system . . . . . . . . . . . 101
ESC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 103
Fuel reserve . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 105
GRA Cruise control system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 104
instrument panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35, 36, 37
lamp fault . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102
main beam headlights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 105
rear fog light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102
seat belt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62
steering column lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 105
tyres . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 104
windscreen washer fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102
Warning messages
Red . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100
Yellow . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100
Warning symbols . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100
see also Warning and indication lamps . . . . . 100
Washing
care of the vehicle exterior . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 192
Washing the vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 192
high pressure cleaners . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 193
Weights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 218
Wheel balance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 213
Wheel bolts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 219
anti-theft . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48
caps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47
loosening . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48
tightening torque . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 215
Wheel cover . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47
removing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47
Wheels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 212, 219
anti-theft bolts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48
chains . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 219
changing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47
new wheels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 214
removing and fitting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49
snow chains . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50
wheel cover . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47
Windows
electric . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11, 120
removing ice . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 194
Window wiper blade . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23
Windscreen and rear window wiper blades . . . . . 78
Windscreen defrosting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 147
Windscreen washer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43, 129
Windscreen washer fluid
control lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102
Windscreen washer water
check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 209
filling amounts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 209
Topping up . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 209
Windscreen wiper blades
cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 195
Windscreen wipers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23, 129
lifting the wiper blades . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 54
replacing the wiper blades . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 54
service position . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 54
Winter conditions
Battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 209
snow chains . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50
thawing windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 194
tyres . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 215
Winter operation
Diesel engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 201
Winter tyres
sizes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 215
X
XDS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 173
244
background
SEAT S.A. is permanently concerned about continuous development of its types and models. For this reason we ask you to under-
stand, that at any given time, changes regarding shape, equipment and technique may take place on the car delivered. For this reason
no right at all may derive based on the data, drawings and descriptions in this current handbook.
All texts, illustrations and standards in this handbook are based on the status of information at the time of printing. Except for error
or omission, the information included in the current handbook is valid as of the date of closing print.
Re-printing, copying or translating, whether total or partial is not allowed unless SEAT allows it in written form.
SEAT reserves all rights in accordance with the “Copyright” Act.
All rights on changes are reserved.
This paper has been manufactured using bleached non-chlorine cellulose.
© SEAT S.A. - Reprint: 15.11.15
About this manual
This manual contains a description of the
equipment supplied with the vehicle at the
time this manual was published. Some of the
units described herein will not be available
until a later date or are only available in cer-
tain markets.
Because this is a general manual for the IBIZA
range, some of the equipment and functions
that are described in this manual are not in-
cluded in all types or variants of the model;
they may vary or be modified depending on
the technical requirements and on the mar-
ket; this is in no way deceptive advertising.
The illustrations are intended as a general
guide and may vary from the equipment fitted
in your vehicle in some details.
The steering indications (left, right, forward,
reverse) appearing in this manual refer to the
normal driving movements of the vehicle ex-
cept when otherwise indicated.
The audiovisual material only is intended to
help users to understand certain car function-
alities better. It does not replace the instruc-
tion manual. Please use the instruction manu-
al to obtain more comprehensive information
and indications.
The equipment marked with an aster-
isk* is fitted as standard only in certain
versions, and is only supplied as op-
tional extras for some versions, or are
only offered in certain countries.
® All registered marks are indicated with
®. Although the copyright symbol does
not appear, it is a copyrighted mark.
>> The section is continued on the follow-
ing page.
Important warnings on a given page
Detailed contents on a given page
General information on a given page
Emergency information on a given page
Audiovisual material on a given page
WARNING
Texts preceded by this symbol contain infor-
mation on safety. They warn you about possi-
ble dangers of accident or injury.
CAUTION
Texts with this symbol draw your attention to
potential sources of damage to your vehicle.
For the sake of the environment
Texts preceded by this symbol contain rele-
vant information concerning environmental
protection.
Note
Texts preceded by this symbol contain additio-
nal information.
This manual is divided into six large parts,
which are:
1. The essentials
2. Safety
3. Emergencies
4. Operation
5. Tips
6. Technical data
At the end of this manual, there is a detailed
alphabetical index that will help you quickly
find the information you require.
background
OWNERS
MANUAL
Ibiza
6P0012720BB
Inglés
6P0012720BB (11.15) (GT9)
Ibiza Inglés (11.15)
SEAT recommends
SEAT GENUINE OIL
SEAT recommends
Castrol EDGE Professional

Specifications

Indexed Terms: Hatchback, 5-door

Seat IBIZA 5D 2015 Questions and Answers

Questions and Answers

Related Products